Quarterlytics / Financial Services / Banks - Regional / Investar Holding Corporation

Investar Holding Corporation

istr · NASDAQ Financial Services
Claim this profile
Ticker istr
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Financial Services
Industry Banks - Regional
Employees 329
← All annual reports
FY2023 Annual Report · Investar Holding Corporation
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
2023

Annual Report

H O L D I N G C O R P O R AT I O N

Dear Shareholders: 

Although 2023 presented unique challenges and disruptions to the banking industry, I am proud of how Investar responded and 
remained focused on meeting the needs of our clients and communities through extraordinary customer service. We spent the 
year focusing on strategic initiatives to position Investar to add long-term value for our shareholders, and we are pleased with 
the progress we have made. 

As the Federal Reserve continued its tightening cycle in 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy 
to a focus on consistent, quality earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. In an effort to improve the composition 
of our loan portfolio, we purchased variable-rate, commercial and industrial lines of credit totaling $163 million, or approximately 
8%  of  the  loan  portfolio,  and  proactively  exited  the  consumer  mortgage  origination business  to  transition  away  from  longer 
duration assets with a lower risk-adjusted return profile. Our credit quality remained exceptional at 0.26% of total loans at the 
end of 2023 as we continued to originate high quality loans and allowed higher risk credit relationships to run off. 

Due to our diligent workout process, we reached resolution on two key relationships. During 2023, we recognized net recoveries 
of $2.3 million primarily attributable to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of 
Hurricane Ida. Additionally, we recognized interest recoveries of $1.5 million, the majority of which were attributable to one 
commercial and industrial oil and gas relationship. 

Our 2023 financial results are highlighted by net income of $16.7 million, diluted earnings per share of $1.69, return on average 
assets  of  0.60%  and  return  on  average  equity  of  7.63%.  We  controlled  noninterest  expense  and  continued  to  make  progress 
towards our strategic priorities including optimization of our physical branch and ATM footprint and our digital transformation. 
We sold two branches in our south Texas market, closed one branch in our Louisiana market, and ceased the operation of 14 
automated  teller  machines.  As  we  strategically  transition  into  a  more  digital  banking  environment,  we  are  evaluating  more 
opportunities to improve our branch network efficiency, further reduce costs, and improve our core metrics. Our Annual Report 
on Form 10-K, which follows this letter, provides a detailed discussion of our financial performance for 2023. 

We  continued  our  strong  track  record  of  returning  capital  to  shareholders.  Investar  has  an  uninterrupted  history  of  paying 
quarterly dividends to common shareholders since 2011. Due to our strong financial performance, we returned approximately 
$3.8  million  to  shareholders  through  quarterly  cash  dividends  totaling $0.395 per  share for  2023,  an  8%  increase  from  total 
quarterly cash dividends in 2022, and repurchased 222,448 shares of our common stock during 2023 at an average price of $13.47 
per share. As of December 31, 2023, we had repurchased 2,535,734 shares of our common stock at an average price of $18.82 
per share since the inception of our stock repurchase program in 2015, and we had  514,266 remaining shares authorized for 
repurchase under our current stock repurchase plan.  

Our goal is to build a fortress balance sheet that is less interest rate sensitive and responsibly build capital levels through organic 
earnings growth and a disciplined pace of share repurchases. As we move into 2024, we believe the strategic achievements noted 
above have positioned us to continue to withstand further economic uncertainty while remaining poised to capitalize on future 
easing in the interest rate environment. 

To our  loyal  customers  and dedicated  employees  –  thank  you for  working  together  to overcome  the  adversity  we faced  and 
making 2023 another successful year. To our shareholders – thank you for your support of and investment in Investar.  

Sincerely, 

John J. D’Angelo  
President & Chief Executive Officer 

   
 
         
 
 
 
UNITED STATES 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION 
Washington, D.C. 20549 
_____________________________________ 

FORM 10-K 
_____________________________________ 

(Mark One) 
☑ 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 

☐ 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2023 
or 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 
For the transition period from                      to                      
Commission File Number: 001-36522 
____________________________________________________ 

Investar Holding Corporation 
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) 
____________________________________________________ 

Louisiana 
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) 

27-1560715 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 

10500 Coursey Blvd., Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70816 
(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code) 
(225) 227-2222 
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code) 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: 

Title of each class 
Common stock, $1.00 par value per share 

Trading Symbol(s) 
ISTR 

Name of each exchange on which registered 
The Nasdaq Global Market 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes  ☐    No  ☑ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes  ☐    No  ☑ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during 
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for 
the past 90 days.    Yes  ☑    No  ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation 
S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).    Yes  ☑    No  ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company, or an emerging 
growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-
2 of the Exchange Act: 
Large accelerated filer 
Non-accelerated filer 

☐ 
☐ 

Accelerated filer 
Smaller reporting company 
Emerging growth company 

☑ 
☑ 
☐ 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or 
revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over 
financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit 
report. ☑ 
If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing 
reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by 
any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ☐    No  ☑ 
The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the closing price of the common stock as of 
June 30, 2023, was approximately $112.0 million. 
The number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date, is as follows: Common stock, $1.00 par 
value per share, 9,781,946 shares outstanding as of March 4, 2024. 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE 
Portions of the Definitive Proxy Statement relating to the 2024 Annual Meeting of Shareholders of Investar Holding Corporation are incorporated by reference 
into Part III of the Form 10-K. Such Definitive Proxy Statement will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the end of the 
registrant’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2023. 

 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS 

PART I 

Item 1. 
Business ............................................................................................................................................................ 
Item 1A.  Risk Factors ...................................................................................................................................................... 
Item 1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments ............................................................................................................................ 
Item 1C.   Cybersecurity ................................................................................................................................................... 
Properties .......................................................................................................................................................... 
Item 2. 
Legal Proceedings ............................................................................................................................................ 
Item 3. 
Item 4.  Mine Safety Disclosures ................................................................................................................................... 

PART II 

Item 5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity 

Securities ...................................................................................................................................................... 
Item 6. 
[Reserved] ........................................................................................................................................................ 
Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ........................... 
Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk ........................................................................... 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data ................................................................................................ 
Item 8. 
Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure .......................... 
Item 9. 
Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures ................................................................................................................................... 
Item 9B.  Other Information ............................................................................................................................................. 
Item 9C.  Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections .............................................................. 

PART III 

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance ............................................................................... 
Item 11.  Executive Compensation .................................................................................................................................. 
Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters ......... 
Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Directors Independence ................................................ 
Item 14.  Principal Accountant Fees and Services ........................................................................................................... 

Item 15.  Exhibit and Financial Statement Schedules ...................................................................................................... 
Item 16.  Form 10-K Summary........................................................................................................................................ 

PART IV 

Page 

1
15
29
29
30
31
31

32
34
35
68
69
130
130
130
130

131
131
131
132
132

132
135

i 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
This page intentionally left blank

Item 1. Business 

General 

PART I 

Investar Holding Corporation, a Louisiana corporation incorporated in 2009, is a financial holding company headquartered in 
Baton Rouge, Louisiana that conducts its operations primarily through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National 
Association (the “Bank,” together with Investar Holding Corporation, the “Company,” “we,” “our,” or “us,”), a national bank 
chartered by the Office of the Comptroller of Currency (“OCC”). The Bank was originally chartered as a Louisiana commercial 
bank in 2006 and converted to a national bank in July 2019. Through the Bank, the Company offers a wide range of commercial 
banking products tailored to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses. Our primary 
areas of operation are south Louisiana, including Baton Rouge, New Orleans, Lafayette, Lake Charles, and their surrounding 
areas;  southeast  Texas,  primarily  Houston  and  its  surrounding  area;  and  Alabama,  including  York  and  Oxford  and  their 
surrounding areas. These markets are served from our executive and operations center located in Baton Rouge and from 28 full 
service branches located throughout our market areas. We have experienced significant growth since the Bank was chartered, 
completing seven whole-bank acquisitions and establishing additional branches in our market areas. 

As of December 31, 2023, on a consolidated basis, the Company had total assets of $2.8 billion, net loans of $2.2 billion, total 
deposits of $2.3 billion, and stockholders’ equity of $226.8 million. 

During 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from  primarily  a growth  strategy  to primarily  a  focus on  consistent, quality 
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. Our long-term strategy includes organic growth through high quality 
loans and growth through acquisitions, including whole-bank acquisitions, strategic branch acquisitions and asset acquisitions. 
In order to improve efficiencies and leverage our digital initiatives, during the last three fiscal years we closed five branches, 
sold three tracts of land held for future branch locations, and completed the sale of two branches. In January 2024, we closed a 
branch in our Alabama market. Consistent with our current strategy, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business in 
the  third  quarter  of  2023.  Over  time,  management  believes  that  we  have significant  opportunities  for  growth  and  franchise 
expansion, both organically and through strategic acquisitions. Although the financial services industry is rapidly changing and 
intensely competitive, and likely to remain so, we believe that the Bank competes effectively as a local community bank and 
possesses the  availability  of  local  access  and  responsive  customer  service,  coupled  with  competitively-priced  products  and 
services, necessary to successfully compete with other financial institutions for individual and small to medium-sized business 
customers. 

All  cross-references  to  the “Notes”  in  this  Form  10-K  refer  to  the Notes  to  Consolidated  Financial  Statements  contained  in 
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.  

The information set forth in this Annual Report on Form 10-K is as of March 7, 2024, unless otherwise indicated herein. 

Operations 

General. We offer a full range of commercial and retail lending products throughout our market areas, including business loans 
to  small  to  medium-sized  businesses  as  well  as  loans  to  individuals.  Our  business  lending  products  include  owner-occupied 
commercial real estate loans, construction loans and commercial and industrial loans, such as term loans, equipment financing 
and lines of credit, while our loans to individuals include first and second mortgage loans, installment loans, and lines of credit. 
For business customers, we target small to medium-sized businesses and professional organizations such as law firms, accounting 
firms and medical practices. 

Management considers all of our operations to be aggregated in one reportable operating segment, and accordingly, no separate 
segment disclosures are presented in this report. 

Lending Activities. Income generated by our lending activities represents a substantial portion of our total revenue. For the years 
ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, income from our lending activities comprised 84%, 76%, and 84%, respectively, of 
our total revenue. Over the last three fiscal years, we have increased our focus on commercial real estate loans and commercial 
and industrial loans. 

1 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Lending to Businesses. Our lending to small to medium-sized businesses falls into three general categories: 

•   Commercial real estate loans. Approximately 48% of our total loans at December 31, 2023 were commercial real estate
loans, which include multifamily, farmland and commercial real estate loans, with owner-occupied loans comprising 
approximately 43% of the commercial real estate loan portfolio. Commercial real estate loan terms generally are 10
years  or  less,  although  payments  may  be  structured  on  a  longer  amortization  basis.  Interest  rates  may  be  fixed  or
adjustable, although rates typically will not be fixed for a period exceeding 120 months, and we generally charge an
origination fee.  Risks  associated with  commercial  real  estate  loans  include,  among other  things, fluctuations  in  the
value of real estate, new job creation trends, tenant vacancy rates, and the quality of the borrower’s management. We
attempt  to  limit  risk  by  analyzing  a  borrower’s  cash  flow  and  collateral  value  on  an  ongoing  basis.  The  loans  are
primarily secured by commercial real estate. Also, we typically require personal guarantees from the principal owners 
of the property, supported by a review of their personal financial statements, as an additional means of mitigating our
risk. We also manage risk by avoiding concentrations in any one business or industry. 

•   Commercial and industrial loans. Commercial and industrial loans primarily consist of working capital lines of credit
and  equipment  loans.  The  terms  of  these  loans  vary  by  purpose  and  by  type  of  underlying  collateral.  We  make
equipment loans for a term of five years or less at fixed or variable rates, with the loan fully amortized over the term
and secured by the relevant piece of equipment. Loans to support working capital typically have terms not exceeding
one year, and such loans are secured by accounts receivable or inventory. Fixed rate loans are priced based on collateral,
term and amortization. The interest rate for floating rate loans is typically tied to the prime rate published in The Wall 
Street Journal. Commercial and Industrial loans include variable-rate loans to consumer finance lending companies.
Loans to consumer finance lending companies accounted for approximately 8% of our total loans at December 31,
2023. Commercial and industrial loans also include public finance loans made to governmental entities, which can be 
taxable or tax-exempt, for purposes including debt refinancing, economic development, quality of life projects, short-
term cash-flow needs, and infrastructure enhancements, among other things. Public finance loans are generally repaid 
using  pledged  revenue  sources  including  income  tax,  property  tax,  sales  tax,  and  utility  revenue,  among  other
sources. Public  finance  loans  comprise less  than  5%  of  our  loan  portfolio  at December  31,  2023.  Commercial  and 
industrial loans accounted for approximately 25% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. 

Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those associated with commercial real estate lending or 
construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by equipment or other business assets (including 
real estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness 
and  projected  cash  flow  of  the  borrower  (and  any  guarantors).  Thus,  the  general  business  conditions  of  the  local 
economy and the borrower’s ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to 
repay  us  under  the  agreed  upon  terms  and  conditions,  are  the  chief  considerations  when  assessing  the  risk  of  a 
commercial loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment 
and other business assets may, among other things, be obsolete or of limited resale value. We actively monitor certain 
financial  measures  of  the  borrower,  including  advance  rate,  cash  flow,  collateral  value  and  other  appropriate  credit 
factors. We also manage risk by avoiding concentrations in any one business or industry. 

•   Construction and development loans. Construction and development loans, which consist of loans for the construction
of  commercial  projects,  single  family  residential  properties  and  multifamily  properties,  accounted  for
approximately 9% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. Our construction and development loans are made on both
a “pre-sold” basis and on a “speculative” basis. Construction and development loans are generally made with a term of
6 to 18 months, with interest accruing at either a fixed or floating rate and paid monthly. These loans are secured by
the  underlying  project  being  built.  For  construction  loans,  loan  to  value  ratios  range  from  70%  to  80%  of  the
developed/completed value, while for development loans our loan to value ratios typically will not exceed 70% to 75% 
of such value. Speculative loans are based on the borrower’s financial strength and cash flow position, and we disburse
funds  in  installments  based  on  the  percentage  of  completion  and  only  after  the  project  has  been  inspected  by  an 
experienced construction lender or third-party inspector. 

Construction lending entails significant additional risks compared to commercial real estate or residential real estate 
lending due to the dynamics of construction projects, changes in interest rates, the long-term financing market, and state 
and local government regulations. One such risk is that loan funds are advanced upon the security of the property under 
construction, which is of uncertain value prior to the completion of construction. Thus, it is more difficult to accurately 
evaluate the total loan funds required to complete a project and to calculate related loan-to-value ratios. We attempt to 
minimize the risks associated with construction lending by limiting loan-to-value ratios as described above. In addition, 
as to speculative development loans, we generally make such loans only to borrowers that have a positive pre-existing 
relationship with us. We also manage risk by using specific underwriting policies and procedures for these types of 
loans and by avoiding excessive concentrations in any one business or industry. 

2 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Lending to Individuals. We make the following types of loans to our individual customers: 

•   Residential  real  estate.  1-4  family  residential  real  estate  loans,  including  second  mortgage  loans,  comprised
approximately 19% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. Second mortgage loans in this category include only loans
we make to cover the gap between the purchase price of a residence and the amount of the first mortgage; all other
second mortgage loans are considered consumer loans. Loan to value ratios do not typically exceed 80%, although
some of the mortgage loans that we retain in our portfolio may have higher loan to value ratios. We use an independent
appraiser to establish collateral values. We generate residential real estate mortgage loans through Bank referrals and
contacts with real estate agents in our markets. We do not originate subprime residential real estate loans. In the third 
quarter of 2023, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business. At December 31, 2023, the consumer mortgage
portfolio was approximately $261.6 million, substantially all of which is included in the 1-4 family residential real
estate loan category. The remaining loans in the category consisted primarily of second mortgages, home equity loans,
home equity lines of credit, and business purpose loans secured by 1-4 family residential real estate. 

•   Consumer loans. Consumer loans represented less than 1% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. We make these
loans (which are normally fixed-rate loans) to individuals for a variety of personal, family and household purposes, and
secured and unsecured installment and term loans. Because many consumer loans are secured by depreciable assets
such as cars, boats and trailers, the loans are amortized over the useful life of the asset. The amortization of second
mortgages generally does not exceed 15 years and the rates generally are not fixed for more than 60 months. As a
general matter, in underwriting these loans, our credit analysts review a borrower’s past credit history, credit scores,
past income level, debt history and, when applicable, cash flow, debt to income ratio, and payment to income, and
determine the impact of all these factors on the ability of the borrower to make future payments as agreed. A comparison
of the value of the collateral, if any, to the proposed loan amount, is also a consideration in the underwriting process. 
Repayment  of  consumer  loans  depends  upon  key  consumer  economic  measures  and  upon  the  borrower’s  financial
stability and is more likely to be adversely affected by divorce, job loss, illness and personal hardships than repayment 
of other loans. A shortfall in the value of any collateral also may pose a risk of loss to us for these types of loans. 

Deposits.  We  offer  a  broad  base  of  deposit  products  and  services  to  our  individual  and  business  clients,  including  savings, 
checking, and money market accounts, as well as a variety of certificates of deposit and individual retirement accounts. We also 
offer a reciprocal deposit product, Assured Checking, that allows customers to deposit funds in excess of the Federal Deposit 
Insurance  Corporation’s  (“FDIC”)  $250,000  insurance  limit  and  have  the  funds  insured  by  the  FDIC. We  offer  debit  cards, 
internet banking, mobile banking with smartphone deposit capability as well as debit card protection settings. For our business 
clients,  we  offer  a  competitive  suite  of  treasury  management  products  which  include,  but  are  not  limited  to,  remote  deposit 
capture,  lockbox  payment  processing,  virtual  vaults, positive  pay,  ACH  origination,  credit  card  processing,  wire  transfer, 
investment sweep accounts, and enhanced business internet banking. 

Other  Banking  Services.  The  Bank’s  other  banking  services  include  cashiers’  checks,  direct  deposit  of  payroll  and  Social 
Security checks, night depository, bank-by-mail, automated teller machines with deposit automation, debit cards, corporate credit 
cards, mobile wallet payment options, electronic statements, electronic banking for consumer and business customers, and Zelle® 
for consumers, a fast and easy way to send money directly between almost any bank account in the United States (“U.S.”). In 
addition, the Bank has options for contactless banking including interactive teller machines (“ITMs”), online account opening, 
and video banking. ITMs are an upgrade on traditional automated teller machine (“ATM”) technology that allow customers to 
virtually interact directly with Bank staff. Online account opening allows a consumer to open a number of available checking, 
savings, and certificate of deposit accounts online. Video banking lets customers communicate with Bank staff from a mobile 
device or computer without visiting a branch. The Bank does not offer trust services or insurance products. 

Acquisition Activity 

General.  From  time  to  time we  evaluate  potential  acquisition  opportunities  including  whole-bank  acquisitions  and  strategic 
branch acquisitions. We believe there are many banking institutions that continue to face credit challenges, capital constraints 
and  liquidity  issues  and  that  lack  the  scale  and  management  expertise  to  manage  the  increasing  regulatory  burden.  Our 
management team has a long history of identifying targets, assessing and pricing risk and executing acquisitions in a creative, 
yet disciplined, manner. We seek acquisitions that provide meaningful financial benefits, long-term organic growth opportunities 
and  expense  reductions,  without  compromising  our  risk  profile.  Additionally,  we  seek  banking  markets  with  favorable 
competitive dynamics and potential consolidation opportunities.  

Recent Acquisitions. All of our acquisition activity is evaluated and overseen by a standing Mergers and Acquisitions Committee 
of our board of directors. A discussion of acquisitions completed since January 1, 2020, is set forth under the heading “Certain 
Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Acquisitions” in Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial 
Condition and Results of Operations. 

3 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Divestiture and Sale or Closure Activity 

Sale of two branches to First Community Bank. On January 27, 2023, the Bank sold certain assets, deposits and other liabilities 
associated with its Alice and Victoria, Texas locations to First Community Bank, a Texas state bank located in Corpus Christi, 
Texas. The Bank sold approximately $13.9 million in loans and $14.5 million in deposits. 

Branch closures and land sales. During the last three fiscal years, we closed five branches and sold three tracts of land held for 
future branch locations. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that resulted 
in significant cost savings. In January 2024, we closed a branch in our Alabama market. We continue to evaluate opportunities 
to reduce our physical branch footprint and further improve efficiency through digital initiatives. 

De Novo Branches or Conversion Activity 

During our  last  three  fiscal years,  we  have not  opened  any de novo  branches. In  the  third quarter  of  2023, we  converted  an 
existing loan and deposit production office in our Alabama market to a cashless branch designed to provide a digital banking 
experience. We do not expect to open de novo branches in 2024. 

Competition 

We face  competition  in  all major  product and  geographic  areas  in which we  conduct  our operations.  Through  the  Bank, we 
compete for available loans and deposits with state, regional and national banks, as well as savings and loan associations, credit 
unions, finance companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, brokerage firms and investment companies. All of these 
institutions compete in the delivery of services and products through availability, quality and pricing, both with respect to interest 
rates on loans and deposits and fees charged for banking services. Many of our competitors are larger and have substantially 
greater resources than we do, including higher total assets and capitalization, greater access to capital markets, and a broader 
offering of financial services. As larger institutions, many of our competitors can offer more attractive pricing than we can offer 
and have more extensive branch networks from which they can offer their financial services products. 

While we continually strive to offer competitive pricing for our banking products, we believe that our community bank approach 
to customers, focusing on quality customer service, and maintaining strong customer relationships affords us the best opportunity 
to successfully compete with other institutions. In addition, as a smaller institution, we think we can be flexible in developing 
and implementing new products and services. Further, in recent years there has been consolidation activity involving banks with 
a presence in our markets. In our view, mergers and other business combinations within our markets provide us with growth 
opportunities. Many acquisitions, especially when local institutions are acquired by institutions based outside our markets, result 
not  only  in  customer  disruption,  but  also  in  a  loss  of  market  knowledge  and  relationships  that  we  believe  provide  us  the 
opportunity to acquire customers seeking a personalized approach to banking. Furthermore, acquisition activity typically creates 
opportunities to hire talented personnel from the combining institutions. 

The following table sets forth certain information about our total deposits, and our share of total deposits, in specified locations, 
and is shown as of June 30, 2023, which is the latest date for which such information is available. 

Location 

Baton Rouge, Louisiana 
New Orleans, Louisiana 
Lafayette, Louisiana 
Evangeline Parish, Louisiana(1) 
East and West Feliciana Parishes, Louisiana(1) 
Calcasieu Parish, Louisiana(1) 
Houston, Texas 
Sumter County, Alabama(1) 
Calhoun County, Alabama(1) 

Investar Total 
Deposits 
(in millions) 

Investar Share 
of Deposits 

  $ 

979      
280      
279      
165      
129      
27      
127      
92      
231      

3.7%
0.6  
3.3  
22.1  
20.9  
0.5  
0.0  
33.8  
9.3  

  (1)  Evangeline Parish, East and West Feliciana Parishes, Calcasieu Parish, Sumter County, and Calhoun County are not included 
in Metropolitan Statistical Areas but are included in this table to reflect the deposit balances of our branches in these parishes 
and counties. 

4 

  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
      
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
 
 
Supervision and Regulation 

General. Banking is highly regulated under federal and state law. The following is a brief summary of certain aspects of that 
regulation which are material to us and does not purport to be a complete description of all regulations that affect us or all aspects 
of those regulations. To the extent particular statutory and regulatory provisions are described, the description is qualified in its 
entirety by reference to the particular statute or regulation. 

We are a financial holding company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and are subject to 
supervision, regulation and examination by the Federal Reserve. The Bank is a national bank chartered under the laws of the U.S. 
by the OCC and is subject to supervision, regulation and examination by the OCC. This system of supervision and regulation 
establishes a comprehensive framework for our operations and, consequently, can have a material impact on our growth and 
earnings performance. 

The primary goals of the bank regulatory scheme are to maintain a safe and sound banking system and to facilitate the conduct 
of sound monetary policy.  This  system  is  intended  primarily  for  the protection of  the  FDIC’s deposit  insurance funds, bank 
depositors, and the public, rather than our shareholders and creditors. The banking agencies have broad enforcement power over 
bank holding companies and banks, including the authority, among other things, to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, require 
affirmative action to correct any violation or practice, issue administrative orders that can be judicially enforced, direct increases 
in capital, direct the sale of subsidiaries or other assets, limit dividends and distributions, restrict growth, assess civil monetary 
penalties,  remove  officers  and  directors,  and,  with  respect  to  banks,  terminate  deposit  insurance  or  place  the  bank  into 
conservatorship or receivership. In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of laws and regulations or 
unsafe or unsound practices. 

The Dodd-Frank Act. The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted on July 21, 2010, aims to restore responsibility and accountability to the 
financial  system  by  significantly  altering  the  regulation  of  financial  institutions  and  the  financial  services  industry.  Full 
implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act has required many new rules to be issued by federal regulatory agencies, and it will 
continue to profoundly affect how financial institutions will be regulated in the future. 

The Dodd-Frank Act, among other things: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

established  the  Consumer  Financial  Protection  Bureau  (“CFPB”  or  “Bureau”),  an  independent  bureau  within  the
Federal Reserve System with centralized responsibility for promulgating and enforcing federal consumer protection 
laws applicable to all entities offering consumer financial products or services; 

established the Financial Stability Oversight Council, tasked with the authority to identify and monitor institutions and
systems that pose a systemic risk to the financial system; 

changed the assessment base for federal deposit insurance from the amount of insured deposits held by the depository
institution to the institution’s average total consolidated assets less tangible equity; 

increased the minimum reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15% to 1.35%; 

permanently increased the deposit insurance coverage amount from $100,000 to $250,000; 

required  the  federal  banking  agencies  to  make  their  capital  requirements  for  insured  depository  institutions
countercyclical, so that capital requirements increase in times of economic expansion and decrease in times of economic
contraction; 

directed  the  Federal  Reserve  to  establish  interchange  fees  for  debit  cards  under  a  restrictive  “reasonable  and
proportional cost” per transaction standard; 

limited the ability of banking organizations to sponsor or invest in private equity and hedge funds and to engage in
proprietary trading; 

increased  regulation  of  consumer  protections  regarding  mortgage  originations,  including  originator  compensation,
minimum repayment standards, prepayment consideration, and mortgage servicing; 

restricted  the  preemption  of  select  state  laws  by  federal  banking  law  applicable  to  national  banks  and  disallowed
subsidiaries and affiliates of national banks from availing themselves of such preemption; 

authorized national and state banks to establish de novo branches in any state that would permit a bank chartered in
that state to open a branch at that location; and 

repealed  the  federal  prohibition  on  the  payment  of  interest  on  commercial  demand  deposits,  thereby  permitting
depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts. 

5 

  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Some  of  these  provisions  have  had  and  may  continue  to  have  the  consequence  of  increasing  our  expenses,  decreasing  our 
revenues, and changing the activities in which we choose to engage. Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to ongoing 
implementation (such as the recent final rulemaking discussed below on small business lending data collection); further, in the 
past certain provisions implemented by federal agencies have been legislatively revised or rescinded. Currently, the U.S. Supreme 
Court is considering a case challenging the constitutionality of the CFPB’s funding mechanism. If the Court rules that the CFPB’s 
funding mechanism is unconstitutional, it will likely have significant consequences for the regulations and decisions rendered by 
the CFPB. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their 
interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our financial condition and results of operations. 

Small Business Lending Data Collection and Reporting. On March 30, 2023, the CFPB issued a final rule implementing Section 
1071 of the Dodd-Frank Act. The final rule requires financial institutions to collect and report data to the CFPB on small business 
loan applicants, including demographic data, lending decisions and the price and terms of credit. The purpose of the rulemaking 
is to increase transparency and combat discrimination in small business lending. As of the date of this report, implementation 
and enforcement of the rule has been enjoined until the U.S. Supreme Court renders its decision on the constitutionality of the 
CFPB’s funding mechanism. 

Interchange Fees. As noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act directed the Federal Reserve to establish interchange fees for debit cards 
under a restrictive “reasonable and proportional cost” per transaction standard (known as the “Durbin Amendment”). The Federal 
Reserve  issued  final  rules  implementing  the  Durbin  Amendment  in  2011,  which  capped  interchange  fees  on  debit  cards.  In 
October 2023, the Federal Reserve requested comment on a proposal to significantly lower the maximum interchange fee that a 
debit card issuer can receive for a debit card transaction. The proposed rule also includes a process that would result in automatic 
revisions to the interchange fee cap every two years without public comment. While the current interchange fee cap on debit 
cards are, and the proposed rules would be only applicable to banks with over $10 billion in total assets, banks with under $10 
billion in total assets such as the Bank could potentially indirectly face fee pressure in operating debit card programs should the 
proposal be adopted in its current form. 

The Volcker Rule. On December 10, 2013, the Federal Reserve and the other federal banking regulators as well as the SEC each 
adopted a final rule implementing Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly referred to as the “Volcker Rule.” Generally 
speaking, the final rule prohibited a bank and its affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and from sponsoring certain 
“covered funds” or from acquiring or retaining any ownership interest in such covered funds. Most private equity, venture capital 
and  hedge  funds  are  considered  “covered  funds”  as  are  bank  trust  preferred  collateralized  debt  obligations.  The  final  rule 
required banking entities to divest disallowed securities by July 21, 2015, subject to extension upon application. The Economic 
Growth, Regulatory Relief, and Consumer Protection Act which was enacted in 2018 amended Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank 
Act to exempt from the Volcker Rule any insured depository institution that has $10.0 billion or less in total consolidated assets 
and whose total trading assets and trading liabilities are 5.0% or less of total consolidated assets; therefore, the Bank is currently 
exempt from the Volcker Rule. 

Regulatory Capital Requirements 

Capital Adequacy. The Federal Reserve Board monitors the capital adequacy of the Company, on a consolidated basis, and the 
OCC  monitors  the  capital  adequacy  of  the  Bank.  The  regulatory  agencies  use  a  combination  of  risk-based  guidelines  and  a 
leverage ratio to evaluate capital adequacy and consider these capital levels when taking action on various types of applications 
and when conducting supervisory activities related to safety and soundness. The risk-based capital standards are designed to 
make regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to differences in risk profiles among financial institutions and their holding 
companies,  to  account  for  off-balance  sheet  exposure,  and  to  minimize  disincentives  for  holding  liquid  assets.  A  financial 
institution’s assets and off-balance sheet items, such as letters of credit and unfunded loan commitments, are assigned to broad 
risk categories, each with appropriate risk weights. Regulatory capital, in turn, is classified in one of two tiers. “Tier 1” capital 
includes  two  components:  (1)  common  equity  Tier 1  capital  and  (2)  additional  Tier 1  capital.  Common  equity  Tier 1  capital 
consists solely of common stock (plus related surplus), retained earnings and limited amounts of minority interests that are in the 
form of common stock. Additional Tier 1 capital includes other perpetual instruments historically included in Tier 1 capital, such 
as non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock. “Tier 2” capital includes, among other things, qualifying subordinated debt and 
allowances for credit losses, subject to limitations. The resulting capital ratios represent capital as a percentage of total risk-
weighted assets and off-balance sheet items. Pursuant to the regulatory capital rules, the Company has made an election not to 
include unrealized gains and losses in the investment securities portfolio for purposes of calculating “Tier 1” capital and “Tier 
2” capital. 

6 

  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Under the current regulatory framework, we are required to maintain the following minimum regulatory capital ratios: 

•  A ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 4.5%; 

•  A ratio of Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 6.0%; 

•  A ratio of Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 8.0%; and 

•  A leverage ratio (Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets) of at least 4.0%. 

In addition to these minimum regulatory capital ratios, the regulations establish a capital conservation buffer with respect to the 
first three capital ratios listed above. Specifically, banking organizations must hold common equity Tier 1 capital in excess of 
their minimum risk-based capital ratios by at least 2.5% of risk-weighted assets in order to avoid limits on capital distributions 
(including dividend payments, discretionary payments on Tier 1 instruments, and stock buybacks) and certain discretionary bonus 
payments to executive officers. Thus, when including the 2.5% capital conservation buffer, a bank holding company and bank’s 
minimum ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets becomes 7%, its minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to 
total risk-weighted assets becomes 8.5%, and its minimum ratio of total capital to total risk-weighted assets becomes 10.5%. 

We were in compliance with all applicable minimum regulatory capital requirements, including the capital conservation buffer, as 
of December 31, 2023. 

The required capital ratios set forth above are minimums, and the Federal Reserve and the OCC may determine that a banking 
organization, based on its size, complexity or risk profile, must maintain a higher level of capital in order to operate in a safe and 
sound  manner.  Risks  such  as  concentration  of  credit  risks  and  the  risk  arising  from  non-traditional  activities,  as  well  as  the 
institution’s exposure to a decline in the economic value of its capital due to changes in interest rates, and an institution’s ability 
to manage those risks are important factors that are to be taken into account by the federal banking agencies in assessing an 
institution’s overall capital adequacy. 

The federal banking agencies finalized a rule in 2019 that allows bank holding companies and banks with less than $10.0 billion 
in total consolidated assets, limited amounts of certain assets and off-balance sheet exposures, and a leverage ratio of greater than 
9% to elect to use the Community Bank Leverage Ratio (“CBLR”) framework. A community banking organization electing to 
use the CBLR framework would have a simplified capital regime and would be considered well capitalized as long as it had a 
leverage ratio of greater than 9%. We have not elected to use the CBLR framework, and it is uncertain if we will elect to use the 
CBLR framework in the future. 

Furthermore, the U.S. federal banking agencies have finalized rules that permit bank holding companies and banks to phase-in, 
for regulatory capital purposes, the day-one impact of the new current expected credit loss accounting rule in retained earnings 
over a period of three years commencing with time of adoption of the new standard. We did not make the election to phase in 
the impact of CECL on our regulatory capital calculations because the adoption of CECL did not have a significant impact on 
our regulatory capital ratios. For further discussion of the new current expected credit loss accounting rule, see Note 1. Summary 
of Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023, and also see “Our allowance for credit losses may 
prove to be insufficient to absorb losses inherent in our loan portfolio, and we may be required to further increase our provision 
for credit losses. This risk may be heightened by our adoption of the Current Expected Credit Loss accounting standard effective 
January 1, 2023. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for credit losses, our net income will decrease.” in Item 1A. Risk 
Factors. 

Prompt Corrective Action Regulations. Under the prompt corrective action regulations, the OCC is required and authorized to 
take supervisory actions against undercapitalized banks. For this purpose, a bank is placed in one of the following five categories 
based  on  its  capital:  well  capitalized,  adequately  capitalized,  undercapitalized,  significantly  undercapitalized,  and  critically 
undercapitalized. Under the prompt corrective action regulations, as currently in effect, to be well capitalized, a bank must have 
a leverage capital ratio of at least 5%, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6.5%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at 
least 8%, and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10%, and must not be subject to any order or written agreement or directive 
by a federal banking agency to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure. 

Federal  banking  regulators  are  required  to  take  various  mandatory  supervisory  actions  and  are  authorized  to  take  other 
discretionary actions with respect to banks in the three undercapitalized categories that, if undertaken, could have a material 
adverse effect on the bank's operations or financial condition. The severity of the action depends upon the capital category in 
which the bank is placed. Generally, subject to a narrow exception, banking regulators must appoint a receiver or conservator for 
a bank that is critically undercapitalized. The federal banking agencies have specified by regulation the relevant capital level for 
each  category.  A bank  that  is  categorized as  undercapitalized,  significantly undercapitalized,  or  critically  undercapitalized  is 
required to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to its appropriate federal banking agency. An undercapitalized bank also 
7 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
is generally prohibited from increasing its average total assets, making acquisitions, establishing any branches or engaging in 
any new line of business, except under an accepted capital restoration plan or with OCC approval. The regulations also establish 
procedures for downgrading a bank to a lower capital category based on supervisory factors other than capital. Additionally, only 
a well-capitalized depository bank may accept or renew brokered deposits without prior regulatory approval. 

Furthermore, a bank holding company must guarantee that a subsidiary depository institution meets its capital restoration plan, 
subject to various limitations. The controlling holding company’s obligation to fund a capital restoration plan is limited to the 
lesser of 5% of an undercapitalized subsidiary’s assets at the time it became undercapitalized or the amount required to meet 
regulatory capital requirements. 

The  capital  classification  of  a  bank  affects  the  frequency  of  regulatory  examinations,  the  bank’s  ability  to  engage  in  certain 
activities, and the deposit insurance premiums paid by the bank. As of December 31, 2023, the Bank met the requirements to be 
categorized as well capitalized under the prompt corrective action framework as currently in effect. 

Acquisitions by Bank Holding Companies 

Federal laws, including the Bank Holding Company Act and the Change in Bank Control Act, impose additional prior notice or 
approval requirements and ongoing regulatory requirements on any investor that seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of 
an FDIC-insured depository institution or bank holding company. We must obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve 
before  (1) acquiring  more  than  5% of  the  voting  stock  of  any  bank  or  other  bank  holding  company,  (2) acquiring  all  or 
substantially all of the assets of any bank or bank holding company, or (3) merging or consolidating with any other bank holding 
company. The Federal Reserve may determine not to approve any of these transactions if it would result in or tend to create a 
monopoly or substantially lessen competition or otherwise function as a restraint of trade, unless the anti-competitive effects of 
the proposed transaction are clearly outweighed by the public interest in meeting the convenience and needs of the community 
to be served. The Federal Reserve is also required to consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the 
bank holding companies and banks concerned, the convenience and needs of the community to be served, and the record of a 
bank holding company and its subsidiary bank(s) in combating money laundering activities. In addition, a failure to implement 
and maintain  adequate  compliance  programs  could  cause the  Federal  Reserve or other banking  regulators not  to  approve  an 
acquisition when regulatory approval is required or to prohibit an acquisition even if approval is not required. 

If the Bank seeks to acquire another depository institution or branches of another depository institution, it is required to obtain 
the prior approval of the OCC. In reviewing the application, the OCC will consider, among other things, the Bank’s capital level, 
its financial and managerial resources and future prospects, the impact of the transaction on the Bank’s safety and soundness, the 
impact of the transaction on competition in the relevant geographic market, its record in combating money laundering activities, 
the impact on the convenience and needs of the communities served, and the Bank’s record of Community Reinvestment Act 
performance. 

Scope of Permissible Bank Holding Company Activities 

In  general,  the  Bank  Holding  Company  Act  limits  the  activities  permissible  for  bank  holding  companies  to  the  business  of 
banking, managing or controlling banks, and such other activities as the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related 
to banking as to be properly incident thereto. 

A  bank  holding  company  may  elect  to  be  treated  as  a  financial  holding  company  and  receive  expanded  powers  if  it  and  its 
depository institution subsidiaries are “well capitalized” and “well managed,” and its subsidiary banks controlled by it have at 
least a “satisfactory” Community Reinvestment Act rating. We have elected for the Company to be treated as a financial holding 
company. As a financial holding company, we may engage in a range of activities that are (1) financial in nature or incidental to 
such financial activity or (2) complementary to a financial activity and which do not pose a substantial risk to the safety and 
soundness of a depository institution or to the financial system generally. These activities include securities dealing, underwriting 
and  market  making,  insurance  underwriting  and  agency  activities,  merchant  banking  and  insurance  company  portfolio 
investments. Expanded financial activities of financial holding companies generally will be regulated according to the type of 
such  financial  activity:  banking  activities  by  banking  regulators;  securities  activities  by  securities  regulators;  and  insurance 
activities by insurance regulators. 

The Bank Holding Company Act does not place territorial limitations on permissible non-banking activities of bank holding 
companies. The Federal Reserve has the power to order any bank holding company or its subsidiaries to terminate any activity 
or  to  terminate  its  ownership  or  control  of  any  subsidiary  when  the  Federal  Reserve  has  reasonable  grounds  to  believe  that 
continuation of such activity or such ownership or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial soundness, safety or stability 
of any bank subsidiary of the bank holding company. 

8 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
Source of Strength Doctrine for Bank Holding Companies 

Under longstanding Federal Reserve policy which has been codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, we are expected to act as a source 
of financial strength to, and to commit resources to support, the Bank. This support may be required at times when we may not 
be inclined to provide it. In addition, any capital loans that we make to the Bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits 
and to certain other indebtedness of the Bank. In the event of our bankruptcy, any commitment by us to a federal bank regulatory 
agency to maintain the capital of the Bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment. 

Dividends 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to certain restrictions on dividends under applicable banking laws and regulations. 
The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement that provides that a bank holding company should not pay dividends unless: 
(1) its  net  income  over  the  last  four  quarters  (net  of  dividends  paid)  has  been  sufficient  to  fully  fund  the  dividends;  (2) the 
prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition 
of the bank holding company and its subsidiaries; and (3) the bank holding company will continue to meet minimum required 
capital adequacy ratios. Accordingly, a bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceed its net income or that 
can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company’s financial health, such as by borrowing. The Dodd-Frank 
Act  imposes,  and  Basel  III  effected,  additional  restrictions  on  the  ability  of  banking  institutions  to  pay  dividends  (including 
failure to maintain capital above the Basel III capital conservation buffer). The Federal Reserve may further restrict the payment 
of dividends by engaging in supervisory action to restrict dividends or by requiring us to maintain a higher level of capital than 
would otherwise be required under any applicable minimum capital requirements. 

Our ability to pay dividends depends in part upon the receipt of dividends from the Bank. The Bank is also subject to certain 
restrictions on dividends under federal laws, regulations and policies. In general, under OCC regulations, the Bank may pay 
dividends to us without the approval of the OCC only so long as the amount of the dividend does not exceed the Bank’s net 
income earned during the current year (net of dividends paid) combined with its retained net income (net of dividends paid) of 
the immediately preceding two years. The Bank must obtain the approval of the OCC for any amount in excess of this threshold. 
Further, a national bank may not pay a dividend in excess of its undivided profits. In addition, under federal law, the Bank may 
not pay any dividend to us if it is undercapitalized or the payment of the dividend would cause it to become undercapitalized. 
The OCC may further restrict the payment of dividends by requiring the Bank to maintain a higher level of capital than would 
otherwise be required to be adequately capitalized for regulatory purposes. Moreover, if, in the opinion of the OCC, the Bank is 
engaged in an unsound practice (which could include the payment of dividends even within the legal requirements noted above), 
the OCC may require the Bank to cease such practice. The OCC has indicated that paying dividends that deplete a depository 
institution’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe banking practice. 

Restrictions on Transactions with Affiliates and Loans to Insiders 

Federal law strictly limits the ability of banks to engage in transactions with their affiliates, including their parent bank holding 
companies. Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, and Federal Reserve Regulation W, impose quantitative limits, 
qualitative standards, and collateral requirements on certain transactions by a bank with, or for the benefit of, its affiliates, and 
generally require those transactions to be on terms at least as favorable to the bank as transactions with non-affiliates and to be 
consistent with safe and sound practices. The Dodd-Frank Act significantly expanded the coverage and scope of the limitations 
on  affiliate  transactions  within  a  banking  organization,  including  an  expansion  of  the  types  of  transactions  that  are  covered 
transactions to include credit exposures related to derivatives, repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements and an 
increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be satisfied. 

Federal law also limits a bank’s authority to extend credit to its directors, executive officers and 10% shareholders, as well as to 
entities controlled by such persons. Among other things, extensions of credit to insiders are required to be made on terms that 
are  substantially  the  same  as  and  follow  credit  underwriting  procedures  that  are  not  less  stringent  than those  prevailing  for 
comparable transactions with unaffiliated persons. Also, the terms of such extensions of credit may not involve more than the 
normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features and may not exceed certain limitations on the amount of credit 
extended to such persons, individually and in the aggregate, which limits are based, in part, on the amount of the bank’s capital. 

9 

  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
 
Incentive Compensation Guidance 

The federal banking agencies have issued comprehensive guidance on incentive compensation policies. This guidance is designed 
to ensure that a financial institution’s incentive compensation structure does not encourage imprudent risk taking, which may 
undermine  the  safety  and  soundness  of  the  institution.  The guidance, which  applies  to  all  employees  that  have  the ability  to 
materially affect an institution’s risk profile, either individually or as part of a group, is based upon three primary principles: (1) 
balanced  risk  taking  incentives;  (2)  compatibility  with  effective  controls  and  risk  management;  and  (3)  strong  corporate 
governance. 

An institution’s supervisory ratings will incorporate any identified deficiencies in an institution’s compensation practices, and it 
may be subject to an enforcement action if the incentive compensation arrangements pose a risk to the safety and soundness of 
the  institution.  Further, regulations  may  limit  discretionary bonus  payments  to  bank  executives  if the  institution’s  regulatory 
capital ratios fail to exceed certain thresholds. 

Deposit Insurance Assessments 

FDIC insured banks are required to pay deposit insurance assessments to the FDIC. The amount of the assessment is based on 
the size of the bank’s assessment base, which is equal to its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity, and 
its risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system. Institutions assigned to higher risk classifications (that is, 
institutions that pose a higher risk of loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund) pay assessments at higher rates than institutions that 
pose  a  lower  risk. An  institution’s risk  classification  is  assigned based  on  certain financial  data  and  the  level of  supervisory 
concern that the institution poses to the regulators. In addition, the FDIC can impose special assessments in certain instances. As 
noted  above,  the  Dodd-Frank  Act  changed  the  way  that  deposit  insurance  premiums  are  calculated.  Action  by  the  FDIC  to 
replenish the Deposit Insurance Fund when needed could result in higher assessment rates, which could reduce our profitability 
or  otherwise  negatively  impact  our  operations. The  FDIC  issued  a  final  rule  in  October  2022  increasing  deposit  insurance 
assessments beginning in the first quarterly assessment period of 2023. On November 16, 2023, the FDIC Board of Directors 
approved a final rule to implement a special assessment on banks with over $5 billion in total assets to recover the loss to the 
Deposit  Insurance  Fund  associated  with  protecting  uninsured  depositors  following  the  closures  of  Silicon  Valley  Bank  and 
Signature Bank. The Federal Deposit Insurance Act requires the FDIC to take this action in connection with the systemic risk 
determination announced on March 12, 2023. While we are not subject to this special assessment, we may be required to pay 
higher FDIC insurance premiums in the future if there are additional bank or financial institution failures or if the FDIC otherwise 
determines to increase assessment rates. 

Branching and Interstate Banking 

Under federal law, the Bank is permitted to establish additional branch offices within Louisiana, subject to the approval of the 
OCC. As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, the Bank may also establish additional branch offices outside of Louisiana, subject to 
prior regulatory approval, so long as the laws of the state where the branch is to be located would permit a state bank chartered 
in that state to establish a branch. The Bank may also establish offices in other states by merging with banks or by purchasing 
branches of other banks in other states, subject to certain restrictions. 

Community Reinvestment Act 

The Bank is required under the Community Reinvestment Act, or CRA, and related OCC regulations to help meet the credit 
needs of its communities, including low and moderate-income borrowers. In connection with its examination of the Bank, the 
OCC assesses our record of compliance with the CRA. The Bank’s failure to comply with the provisions of the CRA could, at a 
minimum, result in denial of certain corporate applications, such as branches or mergers, or in restrictions on its or the Company’s 
activities. The Bank received a “Satisfactory” CRA rating on its most recent CRA Performance Evaluation. The CRA requires 
all FDIC-insured institutions to publicly disclose their rating.  

On October 24, 2023, the federal banking agencies adopted a final rule to modernize the CRA regulations. Under the final rule, 
(1) the federal banking agencies will evaluate bank performance across the varied activities they conduct and communities in 
which  they  operate  in  order  to  encourage  banks  to  expand  access  to  credit,  investment,  and  banking  services  in  low-  and 
moderate-income communities, (2) the CRA regulations are updated to evaluate lending outside traditional assessment areas 
generated by the growth of non-branch delivery systems, such as online and mobile banking, branchless banking, and hybrid 
models, (3) a new metrics-based approach was adopted to evaluate bank retail lending and community development financing, 
using benchmarks based on peer and demographic data and (4) CRA evaluations and data collection are tailored according to 
bank size and type. In addition, the final rule exempts small and intermediate banks from new data requirements that apply to 
banks with assets of at least $2 billion and limits certain new data requirements to large banks with assets greater than $10 billion. 
Most of the rule’s requirements will be applicable beginning January 1, 2026. The remaining requirements, including the data 

10 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
reporting  requirements,  will  be  applicable  on  January  1,  2027.  We  continue  to  evaluate  the  new  rule  and  its  effects  on  our 
operations going forward. The new rules are complex and likely to increase our costs. 

Concentrated Commercial Real Estate Lending Regulations 

The  federal  bank  regulatory  agencies  have  promulgated  guidance  governing  financial  institutions  with  concentrations  in 
commercial real estate lending. The guidance provides that a bank has a concentration in commercial real estate lending if (i) total 
reported loans for construction, land development, and other land represent 100% or more of total capital or (ii) total reported 
loans secured by multifamily and nonfarm nonresidential properties and loans for construction, land development, and other land 
represent 300% or more of total capital and the bank’s commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased 50% or more during 
the prior 36 months. Owner-occupied loans are excluded from this second category. If a concentration is present, management 
must  employ  heightened  risk  management  practices  that  address,  among  other  things,  board  and  management  oversight  and 
strategic  planning,  portfolio  management,  development  of  underwriting  standards,  risk  assessment  and  monitoring  through 
market analysis and stress testing, and maintenance of increased capital levels as needed to support the level of commercial real 
estate lending. At December 31, 2023, the Company did not have a concentration in commercial real estate as defined by the 
regulatory guidance. 

Financial Privacy and Cybersecurity Requirements 

Federal law and regulations limit a financial institution’s ability to share consumer financial information with unaffiliated third 
parties. Specifically, these provisions require all financial institutions offering financial products or services to retail customers 
to provide such customers with the financial institution’s privacy policy and provide such customers the opportunity to “opt out” 
of the sharing of personal financial information with unaffiliated third parties. The sharing of information for marketing purposes 
is also subject to limitations. The Bank currently has a privacy protection policy in place. 

Federal law and regulations also establish certain information security guidelines that require each financial institution, under the 
supervision and ongoing oversight of its board of directors or an appropriate committee thereof, to develop, implement, and 
maintain a comprehensive written information security program designed to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer 
information, to protect against anticipated threats or hazards to the security or integrity of such information, and to protect against 
unauthorized access to or use of such information that could result in substantial harm or inconvenience to any customer. These 
federal guidelines require a financial institution to (i) identify reasonably foreseeable internal and external threats that could 
result in unauthorized disclosure, misuse, alteration, or destruction of customer information or customer information systems, 
(ii) assess the likelihood and potential damage of these threats, taking into consideration the sensitivity of customer information, 
and (iii) assess the sufficiency of policies, procedures, customer information systems, and other arrangements in place to control 
risks. Under the federal guidelines, financial institutions have to provide notice to affected customers of a data breach under 
certain circumstances. 

The  federal  guidelines  also  impose  requirements  on  financial  institutions  with  respect  to  overseeing  their  service  providers, 
including (i) exercising appropriate due diligence in selecting its service providers; (ii) requiring its service providers by contract 
to implement appropriate measures designed to meet the objectives of the federal guidelines; and (iii) where indicated by its risk 
assessment, monitor its service providers to confirm that they have satisfied their obligations as required by the guidelines. The 
federal banking regulations also require a bank to notify its primary Federal regulator within 36 hours of the occurrence of a 
computer-security incident that rises to the level of a “notification incident.” A “notification incident” is defined as a computer-
security incident that has materially disrupted or degraded, or is reasonably likely to materially disrupt or degrade, a banking 
organization’s (1) ability to carry out banking operations, activities, or processes, or deliver banking products and services to a 
material portion of its customer base, in the ordinary course of business; (2) business line(s), including associated operations, 
services, functions, and support, that upon failure would result in a material loss of revenue, profit, or franchise value; or (3) 
operations, including associated services, functions and support, as applicable, the failure or discontinuance of which would pose 
a threat to the financial stability of the U.S. A “computer-security incident” is defined as is an occurrence that results in actual 
harm to the confidentiality, integrity, or availability of an information system or the information that the system processes, stores, 
or transmits. 

Federal  banking  regulators  regularly  issue  guidance  regarding  cybersecurity  intended  to  enhance  cyber  risk  management.  A 
financial  institution  is  expected  to  implement  multiple  lines  of  defense  against  cyberattacks.  Financial  institutions  are  also 
expected to implement procedures designed to address the risks posed by potential cyber threats, and to allow the institution to 
respond and recover effectively after a cyberattack. The Company has adopted procedures designed to comply with the regulatory 
cybersecurity guidance. 

11 

   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Consumer Laws and Regulations 

The Bank is subject to numerous laws and regulations intended to protect consumers in transactions with the Bank, including, 
among others, laws regarding unfair, deceptive and abusive acts and practices, usury laws, and other federal consumer protection 
statutes. These federal laws include the Equal Credit Opportunity Act (the “ECOA”), the Electronic Fund Transfer Act, the Fair 
Credit Reporting Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act of 1974, the S.A.F.E. 
Mortgage Licensing Act of 2008, the Truth in Lending Act and the Truth in Savings Act, among others. Many states and local 
jurisdictions  have  consumer  protection  laws  analogous,  and  in  addition,  to  those  enacted  under  federal  law.  These  laws  and 
regulations  mandate  certain  disclosure  requirements  and  regulate  the  manner  in  which  financial  institutions  must  deal  with 
customers when taking deposits, making loans and conducting other types of transactions. Failure to comply with these laws and 
regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, customer rescission rights, action by state and local attorneys general and civil 
or criminal liability. 

In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act created the CFPB that has broad authority to regulate and supervise retail financial services 
activities of banks and various non-bank providers. The Bureau has authority to promulgate regulations, issue orders, guidance 
and  policy  statements,  conduct  examinations  and  bring  enforcement  actions  with  regard  to  consumer  financial  products  and 
services.  In  general,  however,  banks  with  assets  of  $10  billion  or  less,  such  as  the  Bank,  will  continue  to  be  examined  for 
consumer compliance by their primary federal bank regulator. In October 2022, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the 5th Circuit 
issued a decision ruling that the CFPB’s funding mechanism violates the separation-of-powers principles embodied in the U.S. 
Constitution’s Appropriations Clause. This ruling essentially called into question the validity of the Bureau’s authority to issue 
regulations  and  pursue  enforcement  actions. The  U.S.  Supreme  Court  agreed  to  review  the  case  and  held  oral  argument  on 
October  3,  2023.  The  Court  has  not  yet  issued  its  decision.  We  believe  that  the  banking  industry  generally  will  continue 
complying with the Bureau’s regulations until clarity is provided. 

There has been an enhanced focus by federal bank regulatory agencies with respect to industry practices relating to overdraft 
fees and non-sufficient funds fees. For example, the CFPB issued a Request for Information in January 2022 seeking public input 
with respect to financial institution practices relating to, among other areas, credit card fees, overdraft fees and non-sufficient 
funds  fees  and  stated  its  intent  to  reduce  these  types  of  fees  through  crafting  rules,  issuing  industry  guidance  and  focusing 
supervision and enforcement resources to achieve this goal. In October 2022, the Bureau issued guidance with respect to certain 
practices relating to overdraft fees and bounced check fees. The FDIC issued guidance in August 2022 with respect to bank 
practices involving charging multiple non-sufficient funds fees on the representment of items on a deposit account. In February 
2023, the Bureau issued a proposed rule that would restrict certain practices relating to credit card late fees. On April 26, 2023, 
the OCC issued guidance addressing risks associated with bank overdraft protection programs. On January 17, 2024, the Bureau 
issued a proposed rule that would require financial institutions with over $10 billion in total assets to treat overdraft loans like 
credit cards and other loans as well as to provide clear disclosures and other protections. On January 24, 2024, the Bureau issued 
a proposed rule that would prohibit non-sufficient funds fees on transactions that financial institutions decline in real time. These 
types  of  transactions  include  declined  debit  card  purchases  and  ATM  withdrawals,  as  well  as  some  declined  peer-to-peer 
payments. 

Mortgage Lending Rules 

The  Dodd-Frank  Act  authorized  the  Consumer  Financial  Protection  Bureau  to  establish  certain  minimum  standards  for  the 
origination of residential mortgages, including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, 
financial institutions may not make a residential mortgage loan unless they make a “reasonable and good faith determination” 
that the consumer has a “reasonable ability” to repay the loan. The Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to raise certain defenses to 
foreclosure but provides a full or partial safe harbor from such defenses for loans that are “qualified mortgages.” The Bureau’s 
rules, among other things, specify the types of income and assets that may be considered in the ability-to-repay determination, 
the permissible sources for verification, and the required methods of calculating the loan’s monthly payments. The rules extend 
the requirement that creditors verify and document a borrower’s income and assets to include all information that creditors rely 
on in determining repayment ability. The rules also provide further examples of third-party documents that may be relied on for 
such  verification,  such  as  government  records  and  check  cashing  or  funds  transfer  service  receipts.  The  rules  also  define 
“qualified mortgages,” imposing both underwriting standards and limits on the terms of their loans. Points and fees are subject 
to a relatively stringent cap, and the terms include a wide array of payments that may be made in the course of closing a loan. 
Certain loans, including interest-only loans and negative amortization loans, cannot be qualified mortgages. 

12 

  
  
  
   
  
  
 
 
Anti-Money Laundering and OFAC 

Under federal law (including the Bank Secrecy Act and the USA PATRIOT Act), financial institutions must maintain anti-money 
laundering programs  that  include:  established  internal policies,  procedures  and  controls;  a  designated  compliance officer;  an 
ongoing employee training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. Financial institutions are also 
prohibited from entering into specified financial transactions and account relationships and must meet enhanced standards for 
due diligence and customer identification in their dealings with foreign financial institutions and foreign customers. Financial 
institutions must take reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny of account relationships to guard against money laundering 
and  to  report  any  suspicious  transactions,  and  law  enforcement  authorities  have  been  granted  increased  access  to  financial 
information maintained by financial institutions. 

The  Office  of  Foreign  Assets  Control,  or  OFAC,  is  responsible  for  helping  to  ensure  that  U.S.  entities  do  not  engage  in 
transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC publishes lists 
of persons and organizations suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, known as Specially Designated Nationals 
and Blocked Persons. Generally, if the Bank identifies a transaction, account or wire transfer relating to a person or entity on an 
OFAC  list,  it  must  freeze  the  account  or  block  the  transaction,  file a  suspicious  activity  report  and  notify  the  appropriate 
authorities. 

Bank regulators  routinely  examine  institutions  for  compliance with  these  obligations  and  they  must  consider  an  institution’s 
compliance in connection with the regulatory review of applications, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions. 
Failure  of  a  financial  institution  to  maintain  and  implement  adequate  programs  to  combat  money  laundering  and  terrorist 
financing  and  comply  with  OFAC  sanctions,  or  to  comply  with  relevant  laws  and  regulations,  could  have  serious  legal, 
reputational and financial consequences for the institution. 

Safety and Soundness Standards 

Federal  bank  regulatory  agencies  have  adopted  guidelines  that  establish  general  standards  relating  to  internal  controls  and 
information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth and 
compensation,  fees  and  benefits.  Additionally,  the  agencies  have  adopted  regulations  that  provide  the  authority  to  order  an 
institution that has been given notice by an agency that it is not satisfying any of these safety and soundness standards to submit 
a compliance plan. If, after being so notified, an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material 
respect to implement an acceptable compliance plan, the agency must issue an order directing action to correct the deficiency 
and may issue an order directing other actions of the types to which an undercapitalized institution is subject under the “prompt 
corrective action” provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act. If an institution fails to comply with such an order, the agency 
may seek to enforce such order in judicial proceedings and to impose civil money penalties. 

Bank holding companies are also not permitted to engage in unsound banking practices. For example, the Federal Reserve’s 
Regulation Y requires a holding company to give the Federal Reserve prior notice of any redemption or repurchase of its own 
equity securities, if the consideration to be paid, together with the consideration paid for any repurchases in the preceding year, 
is equal to 10% or more of the company’s consolidated net worth. The Federal Reserve may oppose the transaction if it believes 
that the transaction would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice or would violate any law or regulation. As another example, 
a  holding  company  could  not  impair  its  subsidiary  bank’s  soundness  by  causing  it  to  make  funds  available  to  non-banking 
subsidiaries or their customers if the Federal Reserve believed it not prudent to do so. The Federal Reserve has broad authority 
to prohibit activities of bank holding companies and their nonbanking subsidiaries that represent unsafe and unsound banking 
practices or that constitute violations of laws or regulations. 

Effect of Governmental Monetary Policies 

The commercial banking business is affected not only by general economic conditions but also by U.S. fiscal policy and the 
monetary policies of the Federal Reserve. Some of the instruments of monetary policy available to the Federal Reserve include 
changes in the discount rate on member bank borrowings, the fluctuating availability of borrowings at the “discount window,” 
open market operations, the imposition of and changes in reserve requirements against member banks’ deposits and assets of 
foreign  branches,  and  the  imposition  of  and  changes  in  reserve  requirements  against  certain  borrowings  by  banks  and  their 
affiliates. These policies influence to a significant extent the overall growth of bank loans, investments, and deposits and the 
interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits. For example, during 2022 and in 2023 the Federal Open Market Committee 
of the Federal Reserve increased the target rate range for trading in the federal funds market (known as the federal funds target 
rate  or  the  federal  funds  rate)  multiple  times,  increasing  market  interest  rates.  The  federal  funds  rate  is  the  rate  at  which 
commercial banks borrow and lend their excess reserves to each other overnight. We cannot predict the nature of future fiscal 
and monetary policies and the effect of these policies on our future business and earnings. 

13 

  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
Future Legislation and Regulatory Reform 

The OCC announced on September 28, 2023 that its key areas of supervisory strategies for 2024 will include: asset and liability 
management;  credit  risk  management  and  allowance  for  credit  losses;  cybersecurity;  operations;  digital  ledger  technology 
activities; change management; payments; Bank Secrecy Act/anti-money laundering/countering the financing of terrorism/Office 
of  Foreign  Assets  Control;  consumer  compliance,  fair  lending  risk  and  CRA  performance;  and  climate-related  financial  risk 
management. 

New  laws,  regulations  and  policies  are  regularly  proposed  that  contain  wide-ranging  proposals  for  altering  the  structures, 
regulations and competitive relationships of financial institutions operating in the U.S. In addition, existing laws, regulations and 
policies are continually subject to modification or changes in interpretation. We cannot predict whether or in what form any law, 
regulation or policy will be adopted or modified or the extent to which our operations and activities, financial condition, results 
of operations, strategic plans or future prospects may be affected by its adoption or modification. 

The cumulative effect of these laws and regulations adds significantly to the cost of our operations and thus has a negative impact 
on profitability. There has also been a tremendous expansion in recent years of financial service providers that are not subject to 
the same level of regulation, examination and oversight as we are. Those providers, because they are not so highly regulated, 
may have a competitive advantage over us and may continue to draw large amounts of funds away from traditional banking 
institutions, with a continuing adverse effect on the banking industry in general. 

Human Capital Resources 

Our business is built on relationships with our customers, our community, and most of all, our employees. We are committed to 
providing quality service and products to the consumers and businesses within the markets we serve. We strive to create superior 
shareholder value by attracting and retaining exceptional employees who are highly motivated and well trained.  

Our  compensation  strategy provides  a  total  rewards  structure  that  reflects  position  responsibilities,  is  competitive  with  the 
external market, and is capable of attracting, retaining, and motivating our employees. We provide a comprehensive benefits 
package for eligible employees which includes group health (medical, dental, and vision) insurance including a health savings 
account option, paid time off, short and long term disability insurance, life insurance and a 401(k) plan in which we provide a 
matching contribution. We also offer eligible employees participation in our Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) as well 
as our Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”) in order to better align employee and shareholder interests. 

We provide employees with robust training programs that promote employee development and effectiveness by providing high-
quality curriculums designed to meet individual, departmental and Bank-wide objectives. This includes mentorships, 1-on-1 job 
shadowing, classroom training, internships, and computer-based training. 

We believe employing a diverse and inclusive workforce strengthens our ability to serve our customers and our communities, 
which  is  a  key  component  of  our  success.  To  that  end,  we  are  a  proud  equal  opportunity  employer  committed  to  attracting, 
retaining and promoting employees regardless of sex, sexual orientation, gender identity, race, color, national origin, age, religion 
and physical ability. We do not tolerate illegal discrimination or harassment and encourage employees to immediately report any 
violations to management and human resources.  

As of December 31, 2023, we had 320 full-time and 11 part-time employees. None of our employees are represented by any 
collective bargaining unit or are parties to a collective bargaining agreement. We believe that our relations with our employees 
are good. 

Available Information 

Our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), including annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports 
on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and all amendments thereto, are available on our website as soon as reasonably 
practicable  after  the  reports  are  filed  with  or  furnished  to  the  SEC.  Copies  can  be  obtained  free  of  charge  in  the  “Investor 
Relations”  section  of  our  website  at  www.investarbank.com.  Our  SEC  filings  are  also  available  through  the  SEC’s  website 
www.sec.gov. Copies of these filings are also available by writing to us at the following address: 

Investar Holding Corporation 
P.O. Box 84207 
Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70884-4207 

14 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Item 1A. Risk Factors 

Our business is subject to risk. In addition to the other information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, including 
management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations and our financial statements and the notes 
thereto,  investors  should  consider  the  following  risks  when  evaluating  whether  to  invest  in  our  common  stock.  If  any  of  the 
following risks occur, whether alone or in combination, our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and 
long-term growth prospects could be materially and adversely affected. Additional risks that we do not presently know of or 
currently deem immaterial may also adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and long-
term growth prospects. 

Risks Related to our Business 

As a business operating in the financial services industry, our business and operations may be adversely affected by prevailing 
economic conditions and geopolitical matters. 

Our  financial  performance  generally,  and  in  particular  the  ability  of  borrowers  to  pay  interest  on  and  repay  principal  of 
outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, as well as demand for loans and other products and services 
we offer,  is highly dependent  upon  the business  environment  in  the  primary  markets  where  we  operate  and  in  the  U.S.  as  a 
whole. For  example,  high  inflation  in  2021  through  2023  resulted  in  the  Federal  Reserve  raising  target  interest  rates,  on  a 
cumulative  basis,  by  525  basis  points  since  March  2022,  causing  increases  in  the  costs  of  credit,  capital  and  deposits  and 
limitations on the availability of credit and capital. Our business may also be adversely affected by declines in economic growth, 
business activity, investor or business confidence; declines in real estate values; rising unemployment; rising domestic political 
tensions; risks of government shutdowns; natural disasters; the emergence or worsening of widespread public health challenges 
or pandemics such as the COVID-19 pandemic; or a combination of these or other economic, political and business factors. 

In addition, new or rising geopolitical tensions including those resulting from the wars and violence in Ukraine and Israel and 
surrounding areas, along with other instances of violence, acts of terrorism and political unrest, can result in disruptions in or 
volatility in the economy and in financial and commodity markets in the U.S. and globally, disruptions in international trade 
patterns, and slow growth or declines in economic sectors of the global and U.S. economies. 

Economic uncertainty and negative events in the economy or in domestic political or geopolitical matters could have a material 
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition, including our liquidity position. Among other things, 
they may result in higher than expected loan delinquencies, a decline in the value of collateral securing our loans, instability in 
our deposit base, further increases in our costs of capital and deposits, disruptions in our ability to complete acquisitions, and a 
decline in demand for our products and services. They may cause us to incur losses, including losses on loans beyond those 
provided for in our allowance for credit losses, and losses in our investment securities portfolio, impairments of assets including 
goodwill, and may adversely impact our regulatory capital. 

Increasing and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase 
significantly in 2023; further increases in interest rates could continue to have an adverse effect on our profitability. 

The majority of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature and, as a result, we are subject to significant risk from changes 
in interest rates. Changes in interest rates may affect our net interest income as well as the valuation of our assets and liabilities. 
We cannot predict with certainty changes in interest rates, which are affected by many factors beyond our control, including 
inflation,  recession,  unemployment,  money  supply,  competition  for  loans  and  deposits,  domestic  and  international  events, 
changes in the U.S. and other financial markets, and the policies of the Federal Reserve. Inflation increased rapidly during 2021 
through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared 
to the Federal Reserve’s target rate of inflation of two percent. In response, the Federal Reserve raised the federal funds target 
rate multiple times from March 2022 through July 2023, by 525 basis points on a cumulative basis. 

Our earnings depend significantly on our net interest income, which is the difference between interest income on interest-earning 
assets, such as loans and securities, and  interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. We 
expect to periodically experience “gaps” in the interest rate sensitivities of our assets and liabilities, meaning that either our 
interest-bearing liabilities will be more sensitive to changes in market interest rates than our interest-earning assets, or vice versa. 
In either event, if market interest rates move contrary to our position, this “gap” may work against us, and our earnings may be 
adversely affected. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-earning 
assets in a period, an increase in interest rates could reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature 
or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could reduce net interest 
income. 

15 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Additionally,  an  increase  in  the  general  level  of  interest  rates  may  also,  among  other  things,  adversely  affect  our  current 
borrowers’ ability to repay variable rate loans, the demand for and our ability to originate loans, negatively affect the value of 
our investment securities portfolio, and decrease loan prepayment rates, or could increase the cost of the Company’s deposits 
and borrowings. 

Rising and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase significantly 
in 2023, putting pressure on our net interest margin. Our cost of interest-bearing deposits rose to 2.49% in 2023 from 0.42% in 
2022, an increase of 207 basis points. Our costs of short-term borrowings rose to 4.93% in 2023 from 3.05% in 2022, an increase 
of 188 basis points. 

We may experience additional pressure on our net interest margin during 2024 if our cost of funds increases faster than the yield 
on our interest-earning assets. Additionally, due in large part to higher interest rates and market volatility during 2022 and 2023, 
gross unrealized losses in our investment portfolio totaled $57.7 million at December 31, 2023 and $62.5 million at December 
31, 2022. These losses may continue or worsen during 2024, and we may experience realized losses in our portfolio. 

A continued high general level of interest rates or any additional increases in such rates could result in increased loan defaults, 
foreclosures  and  charge-offs,  and also  necessitate  further  increases  to  the  allowance  for  credit  losses.  At  the  same  time,  the 
marketability  and  value  of  the  property  securing  a  loan  may  be  adversely  affected  by  any  reduced  demand  resulting  from 
sustained higher or increased interest rates. Further, when we place a loan on nonaccrual status, we reverse any accrued but 
unpaid interest receivable, which decreases interest income, but we continue to have a cost to fund the loan, which is reflected 
as interest expense, without any interest income to offset the associated funding expense. Thus, an increase in the amount of 
nonperforming assets would have an adverse impact on net interest income. 

Conversely,  a  decrease  in  the  general  level  of  interest  rates  may  lead  to,  among  other  things,  prepayments  on  our  loan  and 
mortgage-backed securities portfolios as borrowers refinance their loans at lower rates, lower rates on new loans, lower rates on 
existing variable rate loans, and lower yields on investment securities, which could result in decreased yields on earning assets. 

Although our asset-liability management strategy is designed to control and mitigate exposure to the risks related to changes in 
the general level of market interest rates, we may not be able to accurately predict the likelihood, nature and magnitude of those 
changes or how and to what extent they may affect our business. We also may not be able to adequately prepare for or compensate 
for the consequences of such changes. Significant increases in interest rates, as has occurred during the last two fiscal years, 
makes our business and our balance sheet more challenging to manage. Any failure to predict and prepare for changes in interest 
rates  or  adjust  for  the  consequences  of  these  changes  may  adversely  affect  our  earnings  and  capital  levels.  For  additional 
information,  see  Item  7.  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of  Operations  –  Risk 
Management – Interest Rate Risk. 

A lack of liquidity, including due to events outside our control or ineffective liquidity management, could adversely affect our 
ability to fund operations and meet our obligations as they become due. 

Liquidity is essential to our business. Liquidity risk is the potential that we will be unable to meet our obligations as they come 
due because of an inability to liquidate assets or obtain adequate funding. The primary source of the Bank’s funds are customer 
deposits, loan repayments and investment securities maturities or sales, while borrowings are a secondary source of liquidity. 
We also use brokered deposits from time to time and our use of brokered deposits increased during 2023. Brokered deposits tend 
to be more sensitive to changes in interest rates than other types of deposits and therefore can be a more expensive and uncertain 
source of funds. The Bank’s liquidity could be adversely impacted if rates offered by the Bank were less than those offered by 
other institutions seeking brokered deposits, or if such depositors were to perceive a decline in the Bank’s safety or soundness. 
Additionally, we must maintain our well-capitalized status in order to accept brokered deposits without prior regulatory approval. 
Our access to deposits and other funding sources in adequate amounts and on acceptable terms is affected by a number of factors, 
including rates paid by competitors, returns available to customers on alternative investments, customer confidence in the safety 
of uninsured deposits and general economic conditions. Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to 
originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses, pay dividends to our shareholders, or to fulfill obligations such as repaying 
our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our business, 
financial condition, results of operations and long-term growth prospects. 

The highly-publicized failures of Silicon Valley Bank, Signature Bank and First Republic Bank during the first half of 2023 
caused  significant  disruptions  in  the  banking  industry.  These  industry  developments  negatively  impacted  overall  customer 
confidence in the safety of their deposits, particularly uninsured deposits, at some regional banks. As a result, some customers 
moved deposits to, or maintained deposits with, larger financial institutions or moved funds to investment alternatives outside 
the  banking  industry.  The  rapid  failures  of  these  large  banks  highlighted  risks  associated  with  advances  in  technology  that 
increase the speed at which information, concerns and rumors can spread through traditional and new media and increase the 

16 

  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
speed  at  which  deposits  can  be  moved  from  bank  to  bank  or  outside  the  banking  system,  heightening  liquidity  concerns  of 
traditional banks. Regulators and the largest U.S. banks took steps designed to increase liquidity at regional banks and strengthen 
depositor confidence in the broader banking industry, including the Bank Term Funding Program discussed elsewhere in this 
report  and  measures  to  protect  uninsured  deposits  from  loss;  however,  there  are  no  guarantees  that  such  steps  would  be 
implemented in the future if a similar disruption in the industry were to occur. For more information on the Company’s deposits 
and  liquidity  position,  see  Part  I.  Item  2.  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of 
Operations under the headings “Certain Events That Affect Period-over-Period Comparability,” “Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition – Deposits” and “Liquidity and Capital Resources.” Concerns about liquidity in the banking industry and 
the safety of uninsured deposits that may result from similar events in the future may materially adversely impact our liquidity, 
cost of funds, loan funding capacity, net interest margin, capital and results of operations. 

Inflation and rising prices may continue to adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. 

As noted above, inflation increased rapidly during 2021 and continued rising through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of 
inflation generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared to the Federal Reserve’s target rate of inflation 
of two percent. Inflation increases our borrowers’ costs of living and costs of doing business, which may make it more difficult 
for them to repay their loans, increasing our credit risk. Inflation also increases many of our operating costs, including the costs 
of goods and services we purchase and the costs of salaries and benefits. We believe that higher rates resulting from inflation 
and related factors led to constrained loan demand during 2023. When the rate of inflation accelerates, there is an erosion of 
consumer and customer purchasing power. Accordingly, if the rate of inflation accelerates in the future, this could impact our 
business  by reducing  our  tolerance  for  extending  credit,  and  our  customer’s  desire  to  obtain  credit,  or  causing us  to  incur 
additional provisions for credit losses resulting from a possible increased default rate. Inflation and related higher rates have led 
and may continue to lead to lower loan re-financings. In addition, inflation has led to the Federal Reserve raising interest rates 
during 2022 and 2023, as discussed above. 

Our allowance for credit losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses inherent in our loan portfolio, and we may be 
required  to  further  increase  our  provision  for  credit  losses. This  risk  may  be  heightened  by  our  adoption  of  the  Current 
Expected Credit Loss accounting standard effective January 1, 2023. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for 
credit losses, our net income will decrease. 

Our business depends on our ability to successfully measure and manage credit risk. As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that 
the principal of and interest on a loan will not be paid timely or at all, and that the value of any collateral supporting a loan will 
be insufficient to cover any exposure to loss on a loan. Management maintains an allowance for credit losses, which is a reserve 
established  through  a  provision  for  credit  losses  charged  to  expense,  to  absorb  credit  losses  in  the  loan  portfolio.  The 
determination  of  the  appropriate  level  of  the  allowance  is  inherently  subjective,  involves  a  high  degree  of  judgment  and 
complexity, and requires us to make significant estimates, all of which are subject to material changes. 

In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued a new accounting standard (Accounting Standards 
Update  “ASU”  2016-13),  referred  to  as  Current  Expected  Credit  Loss  (“CECL”)  that  requires  that  the  measurement  of  all 
expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date be based on historical experience, current conditions, and 
reasonable and supportable forecasts, and requires enhanced disclosures related to the significant estimates and judgments used 
in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of an organization’s portfolio. In addition, the 
new  standard  amends  the  accounting  for  credit  losses  on  purchased  financial  assets  with  credit  deterioration.  ASU  2016-13 
became effective for us, as a smaller reporting company, on January 1, 2023. Please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant 
Accounting Policies – Recent Accounting Pronouncements, for additional discussion. 

The CECL methodology requires that lifetime “expected credit losses” be recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or 
acquired, and be adjusted each quarter for changes in expected lifetime credit losses. The CECL methodology replaces multiple 
prior  impairment  models  under  U.S.  GAAP  that  generally  required  that  a  loss  be  “incurred”  before  it  was  recognized,  and 
represents a significant change from prior U.S. GAAP. Our ongoing estimates of expected credit losses will depend upon our 
models  and  assumptions,  existing  and  forecasted  macroeconomic  conditions  and  the  credit  quality,  composition  and  other 
characteristics of our loan and other applicable portfolios. We believe these factors are likely to cause variability in our expected 
credit losses under CECL compared to previous GAAP, and therefore an increase in the variability of our period-to-period net 
income. We believe that CECL is also likely to reduce comparability across financial services companies due to the ability to 
adopt  different  measurement  approaches  for  expected  credit  losses  and  different  economic  assumptions  used  in  each  of  the 
companies’ models. 

17 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans generally are viewed as having more risk of default than residential 
real estate loans or other loans or investments. These types of loans are also typically larger than residential real estate loans and 
other consumer loans. Because our loan portfolio contains a significant number of commercial and industrial and commercial 
real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of a material amount of these loans may cause a significant 
increase in our allowance for credit losses, non-performing assets, and/or past due loans. An increase in our allowance for credit 
losses, non-performing assets, and/or past due loans could result in a loss of earnings, or an increase in loan charge-offs, which 
would have an adverse impact on our results of operations and financial condition. 

Inaccurate  management  assumptions,  including  with  respect  to  economic  conditions  affecting  borrowers,  new  information 
regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may 
require us to increase our allowance for credit losses. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review the allowance for 
credit losses and may require an increase in the provision for credit losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based 
on judgments different than those of management. Finally, if actual charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for credit 
losses, we will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for credit losses. Any increases in the allowance for credit 
losses  will result  in  a decrease  in net  income  and,  possibly,  capital  and may have  a material  adverse  effect  on  our business, 
financial condition, and results of operations. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for credit losses, our net income 
will decrease. 

Our  pivot  during  2023  from  primarily  a  growth  strategy  to  a  near-term  strategy  focused  primarily  on  consistent,  quality 
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet may not be successful in increasing our profitability. 

During  2023,  we  pivoted  our  near-term  strategy  from primarily  a  growth  strategy  to  primarily  a  focus on  consistent,  quality 
earnings  through  the  optimization  of our  balance  sheet,  as  described  elsewhere  in  this  report.  Our  new  strategy  may  not  be 
successful in increasing our profitability. 

Our long-term business strategy includes the continuation of our multi-state growth plans, and our financial condition and 
results of operations could be negatively affected if we fail to grow or fail to manage our growth effectively. 

In  addition  to organic  growth, we have grown our business  through de  novo branching  and  through  the  acquisition of  other 
financial institutions and branch locations. We have completed seven whole-bank acquisitions since 2011 and regularly review 
acquisition opportunities. We have also expanded our operations outside our historical south Louisiana base and into Texas and 
Alabama. Over the long-term, we intend to pursue a multi-state growth strategy for our business primarily through attractive 
acquisition opportunities as well as continue to pursue organic growth throughout our franchise. Our long-term growth prospects 
must be considered in light of the risks, expenses and difficulties frequently encountered by companies when expanding their 
franchise, including the following: 

•   De Novo Branching; Branch Acquisitions. There are considerable costs involved in opening or acquiring branches,
and de novo branches generally do not generate sufficient revenues to offset their costs until they have been in operation
for at least a year or more. We have not opened a de novo branch since 2020, except that in the third quarter of 2023
we converted an existing loan and deposit production office in Tuscaloosa, Alabama to a cashless branch designed to
provide a digital banking experience. We do not expect to open de novo branches in 2024. 

•   Expansion into New Markets. We operated exclusively in Louisiana until we acquired financial institutions in Texas
and  Alabama  in  2019.  The  financial  services  industry  in  these  areas  is  highly  competitive,  and  the  challenges  of
continuing to operate in new markets and multiple states may be greater than we anticipate. During 2023, we completed 
the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with two branches that we previously acquired in
Texas,  in  order  to  focus  more  on  our  core  markets.  Of  our  Bank’s  branch  network,  these  two  locations  were
geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters. 

•   Acquisition and Integration Risks. An acquisition strategy involves substantial risks and uncertainties including: 

◦ 

◦ 
◦ 

the time and costs of evaluating potential acquisition candidates and new markets, negotiating transactions, and
related diversion of management’s attention from day-to-day operations; 
our ability to continue to finance acquisitions and possible dilution to our existing shareholders; 
potential for acquisition agreements, once signed, not to be completed due to inability to obtain required regulatory
approvals, third-party litigation, lack of shareholder approval if required, failure of other conditions to closing,
agreement of the parties, or other reasons; 

18 

   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
◦ 

◦ 

unanticipated  difficulties  in  integrating  acquired  businesses,  including  potential  losses  of  customers  and
employees,  higher  than  expected  integration  costs,  and  inability  to  maintain  and  increase  market  share  at  new
locations; and 
potential differences between management’s expectations regarding how an acquired business will perform and
actual results once acquired, which may result in lower than expected revenues, inability to achieve expected cost
savings and synergies, higher than expected liabilities and costs, impairments of goodwill, and losses. 

•   Organic Growth Risks. As we continue to pursue organic growth at our existing and new or acquired locations, we
may be unable to successfully maintain loan quality, obtain deposits at attractive rates, attract and retain personnel to
implement  and  oversee  such  growth,  or  maintain  an  efficient  overhead  cost  structure.  We  may  also  introduce  new
products and services that do not produce projected profits and may result in losses. 

Failure to successfully address these issues relating to our long-term growth strategy could have a material adverse effect on our 
financial condition and results of operations. Also, if our long-term growth occurs more slowly than anticipated or declines, our 
operating results could be materially adversely affected. 

Changes in retail distribution strategies and consumer behavior may adversely impact our business, financial condition and 
results of operations.  

We have significant investments in our physical branch network, including in bank premises and equipment as well as in our 
branch  work  force.  Advances  in  technology  as  well  as  changing  customer  preferences  for  remote  methods  of  accessing  our 
products and services could decrease the value of our branch network and may cause us to further change our retail distribution 
strategy, and close, consolidate or sell certain branches or parcels of land held for future branch locations. These actions could 
lead  to  losses  on  these  assets  or  adversely  impact  the  carrying  value  of  long-lived  assets  and  may  lead  to  expenditures  to 
reconfigure remaining branches. Any changes in our branch network strategy could adversely impact our business if it results in 
the loss of customers. 

In recent periods, we have focused on enhancing our online banking platform and plan to continue to introduce new technologies, 
with  the goal of  delivering products  and  services  more  efficiently with fewer branches  and people. We  closed  five  branches 
during our last three fiscal years. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that 
resulted in significant cost savings. In 2022, we sold five former branch locations and three tracts of land that were being held 
for future branch locations. In January 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with 
two of our Texas branches in order to focus more on our core markets. Of the Bank’s entire branch network, these two locations 
were geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters. During the third quarter of 2023, we ceased operation of 
14 ATMs and in January 2024 we closed a branch in our Alabama market. We could incur material losses in the future due to 
the closure or consolidation of branches or sale of land held for future branch locations. 

Our business is concentrated in southern Louisiana, southeast Texas, and Alabama, and an economic downturn affecting 
these areas may magnify the adverse effects and consequences to us. 

We currently conduct our operations primarily in southern Louisiana, and more specifically, in the Baton Rouge, New Orleans, 
Lafayette and Lake Charles metropolitan areas, in the greater Houston, Texas area, and in Alabama. As of December 31, 2023, 
our  primary  markets  were  south  Louisiana  (approximately  80%  of  our  total  deposits  of $2.3 billion),  southeast  Texas 
(approximately  5%  of  our  total  deposits)  and Alabama  (approximately  15%  of  our  total  deposits). At  December  31,  2023, 
approximately 60%, 5%, and 5% of the secured loans in our total loan portfolio were secured by properties and other collateral 
located in Louisiana, Texas and Alabama, respectively. 

This geographic concentration imposes a greater risk to us than to our competitors in the area who maintain significant operations 
outside of our selected markets. Accordingly, any regional or local economic downturn, or natural or man-made disaster, that 
affects southern Louisiana, southeast Texas, Alabama, or existing or prospective property or borrowers in such areas may affect 
us and our profitability more significantly and more adversely than our more geographically diversified competitors. 

Much of our business development and marketing strategy is directed toward fulfilling the banking and financial services needs 
of small to medium-sized businesses. Such businesses generally have fewer financial resources in terms of capital or borrowing 
capacity than larger entities. If economic conditions negatively impact our selected markets and these businesses are adversely 
affected, our financial condition and results of operations may be negatively affected. 

19 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
Adverse economic factors affecting particular industries could have a negative effect on our customers and their ability to 
make payments to us. 

Certain industry-specific economic factors may also adversely affect us. For example, the energy sector, which is historically 
cyclical, has experienced significant volatility in oil and gas prices. While we consider our direct exposure to the energy sector 
not to be significant, comprising approximately 2.0% of total loans at December 31, 2023, continued oil price volatility could 
have further negative impacts on general economic conditions, particularly in our south Louisiana and southeast Texas markets, 
which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations. 

We have a significant number of loans secured by real estate, and a downturn in the real estate market could result in losses 
and negatively impact our profitability. 

At December 31, 2023, approximately 75% of our total loan portfolio had real estate as a primary or secondary component of 
the collateral securing the loan. The real estate provides an alternate source of repayment in the event of a default by the borrower, 
but its value may deteriorate during the time the credit is extended. Declines in real estate values in our markets could significantly 
impair the value of the particular collateral securing our loans and our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure for an amount 
necessary to satisfy the borrower’s obligations to us. Furthermore, in a declining real estate market, we often will need to further 
increase our allowance for credit losses to address the deterioration in the value of the real estate securing our loans. Any of the 
foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows. 

Commercial real estate loans may expose us to greater risks than our other real estate loans. 

Our  loan  portfolio  includes  commercial  real  estate  loans,  which  are  secured  by  owner-occupied  and  nonowner-occupied 
commercial  properties.  As  of  December  31,  2023,  our  owner-occupied  commercial  real  estate  loans  totaled $449.6 million, 
or 20.3% of our total loan portfolio and our nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans totaled $488.1 million, or 22.1% of 
our total loan portfolio. 

Commercial real estate loans typically depend on the successful operation and management of the businesses that occupy these 
properties  or  the  financial  stability  of  tenants  occupying  the  properties.  Nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans 
typically are dependent, in large part, on the owner’s ability to rent the property and the ability of the tenants to pay rent, whereas 
owner-occupied commercial real estate loans typically are dependent, in large part, on the success of the owner’s business. Cash 
flows, which may include proceeds from sales of commercial real estate, may be affected significantly by general economic 
conditions. Weak economic conditions may impair the borrower’s business operations and typically slow the execution of new 
leases. Such economic conditions may also lead to existing lease turnover. As a result of these factors, vacancy rates for retail, 
office and industrial space may increase. High vacancy rates could also result in rents falling. The combination of these factors 
could result in deterioration in the fundamentals underlying the commercial real estate market and the deterioration in value of 
some of our loans. These loans expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the 
collateral securing these loans typically cannot be liquidated as easily as residential real estate. If we foreclose on these loans, 
our holding period for the collateral typically is longer than for a 1-4 family residential property because there are fewer potential 
purchasers of the collateral. Additionally, nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans generally involve relatively large 
balances to single borrowers or related groups of borrowers. Accordingly, charge-offs on nonowner-occupied commercial real 
estate loans may be larger on a per loan basis than those incurred with our residential or consumer loan portfolios. Unexpected 
deterioration in the credit quality of our commercial real estate loan portfolio would require us to increase our provision for loan 
losses, which would reduce our profitability and could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of 
operations, and cash flows. 

Commercial and industrial loans may expose us to greater risk than other loans. 

Commercial and industrial loans primarily consist of working capital lines of credit and equipment loans, typically secured by 
accounts receivable or inventory, or the relevant equipment. Repayment of these loans generally comes from the generation of 
cash flow as the result of the borrower’s business operations. Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those 
associated with commercial real estate lending or construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by 
business assets (including real estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the 
creditworthiness and projected cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the general business conditions of the local 
economy and the borrower’s ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to repay us 
under the agreed upon terms and conditions, are the chief considerations when assessing the risk of a commercial and industrial 
loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment and other business 
assets  may,  among  other  things,  be  obsolete  or  of  limited  resale  value. Additionally,  as  of December  31,  2023 52% of  our 
commercial and industrial loans were variable rate loans; rising interest rates increase interest payments due on such loans and 
may increase the risk of default by the borrower. 

20 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
We have been increasing the proportion of commercial and industrial loans in our loan portfolio. Our commercial and industrial 
loans represented 16.6%, 20.7% and 24.6% of total loans as of December 31, 2021, 2022 and 2023, respectively. The increase 
from year-end 2022 to year-end 2023 was caused primarily by our purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit 
which, at the time of the loan purchase agreement, had an unpaid principal balance of approximately $163 million and total 
commitments of approximately $238 million, as described in more detail elsewhere in this report. The acquired loans are to 
consumer finance lending companies. The repayment of consumer finance loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness and 
projected cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the primary risks associated with these types of loans are the 
general business conditions of the local economy, and the ability to generate sufficient operating revenue to repay us under the 
agreed upon terms and conditions. Loans to consumer finance lending companies accounted for approximately 8% of our total 
loans at December 31, 2023. The increase from year-end 2021 to year-end 2022 was driven primarily by an increase in public 
finance loans and loan production by our Commercial and Industrial Division.  

Commercial and industrial loans include public finance loans made to governmental entities, which can be taxable or tax-exempt, 
for  purposes  including debt  refinancing, economic  development,  quality  of  life  projects, short-term  cash-flow  needs, 
and infrastructure enhancements, among other things. Public finance loans generally are repaid using pledged revenue sources 
including income tax, property tax, sales tax, and utility revenue, among other sources. Accordingly, repayment depends upon 
the financial stability and tax or revenue generating capacity of the particular revenue source. Public finance loans comprise less 
than 5% of our loan portfolio as of December 31, 2023. 

Loss of our senior executive officers or other key employees and our inability to recruit or retain suitable replacements could 
adversely affect our business, results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy. 

Our success depends significantly on the continued service and skills of our executive management team. The implementation 
of our business strategies also depends significantly on our ability to retain employees with experience and business relationships 
within their respective market areas, as well as on our ability to attract, motivate and retain highly qualified senior and middle 
management. Competition for employees is intense. We could have difficulty replacing key employees with personnel with the 
combination of skills and attributes required to execute our business strategies and who have ties to the communities within our 
market areas. The loss of any of our key personnel could therefore have a material adverse effect on our business, financial 
condition, results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy. 

Hurricanes or other adverse weather conditions, as well as man-made disasters, could negatively affect our local markets or 
disrupt our operations, which may adversely affect our business and results of operations. 

Our business is concentrated in southern Louisiana, in southeast Texas, and in Alabama. Our selected markets are susceptible to 
major hurricanes, floods, tropical storms, tornadoes and other natural disasters and adverse weather, the nature and severity of 
which can be difficult to predict. These natural disasters can  disrupt our operations, cause widespread property damage, and 
severely depress the local economies in which we operate. For example, the historic flooding of Baton Rouge and surrounding 
areas  in  August  2016  had  significant  impacts  in  several  markets  in  which  we  conduct  business.  Hurricane  Harvey  caused 
significant damage and flooding in Texas when it made landfall in August 2017. Hurricane Ida, which made landfall as a category 
4 hurricane in Louisiana in August 2021, caused significant damage in the southern part of the state and also disrupted operations 
for  certain  of  our  customers.  We  recognized  a  material  impairment  related  to  a  lending  relationship  with  a  group  of  related 
borrowers (the “Borrower”), collateralized by commercial real estate, inventory, and equipment. As a result of Hurricane Ida, 
the Borrower’s business operations were disrupted, and due to this impact on the Borrower’s operations, certain of the collateral 
supporting the loan relationship experienced a significant reduction in value. The severity and impact of future severe weather 
events are difficult to predict and may be exacerbated by global climate change. The 2010 Deepwater Horizon oil spill in the 
Gulf  of  Mexico  illustrated  that  man-made  disasters  can  also  adversely  affect  economic  activity  in  the  markets  in  which  we 
operate. Any economic decline as a result of a natural disaster, adverse weather, oil spill or other man-made disaster can reduce 
the demand for loans and our other products and services. 

Such events could also affect the stability of our deposit base, impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans (resulting 
in increased delinquencies, foreclosures and loan losses), impair the value of collateral securing such loans, cause significant 
property damage, result in loss of revenue and/or cause us to incur additional expenses. The occurrence of any such event could, 
therefore, result in decreased revenue and loan losses that have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, 
results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy. 

21 

  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
 
Climate related events and legislative and societal responses regarding climate change present risks to our business. 

Climate change may intensify severe weather events such as hurricanes and rainstorms that recur in our market areas, which may 
adversely impact our locations and business and those of our customers and suppliers. In addition, there has been an increased 
focus among businesses, consumers and investors regarding transitioning to renewable energy and a net zero economy. If we fail 
to adequately anticipate and address these changing preferences, our business could be adversely impacted. We are also subject 
to risks relating to potential new climate change-related legislation or regulations, which could increase our and our customers’ 
costs. The risks associated with these matters are continuing to evolve rapidly and the ultimate impact on our business is difficult 
to predict with any certainty. 

Our failure to effectively implement new technologies could adversely affect our operations and financial condition. 

Our  industry  is  undergoing  rapid  technological  changes  with  frequent  introductions  of  new  technology-driven  products  and 
services, including those using artificial intelligence. Our ability to compete successfully to some extent depends on whether we 
can implement new technologies to provide products and services to our customers more efficiently while avoiding significant 
operational challenges that increase our costs or delay full implementation, especially relative to our peers, many of which have 
greater resources to devote to technological improvements. 

We rely on information technology and telecommunications systems, many of which are provided by third-party vendors. 

The successful and uninterrupted functioning of our information technology and telecommunications systems is critical to our 
business. We outsource many of our major systems, such as data processing and deposit processing. If one of these third-party 
service providers terminates their relationship with us or fails to provide services to us for any reason or provides such services 
poorly, our business may be materially and adversely affected. In addition, we may be forced to replace such vendors, which 
could interrupt our operations and result in a higher cost to us. 

Cyberattacks or other security breaches could adversely affect our operations, net income or reputation. 

The financial services industry is particularly at risk for cybersecurity concerns because of the proliferation of new and emerging 
technologies, and the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct financial transactions. Additionally, 
increased  use  of  internet  and  mobile  banking  products, and  applications  and  plans  to  use  or  develop  additional  remote 
connectivity solutions increase our cybersecurity risks and exposure. In recent years we have increased our offerings of online 
and  mobile  banking  services,  including  on-line  bill  payment,  on-line  funds  transfers,  mobile  deposits,  mobile  wallets,  video 
banking and Zelle®. These risks are heightened when customers use near real-time money transfer solutions such as Zelle®, 
where fraudulent and scam transactions can be more difficult to detect, prevent and recover. Additionally, as part of our banking 
business, we and certain of our third-party vendors collect, use and hold sensitive data concerning individuals and businesses 
with whom we have a banking relationship. Threats to data security, including unauthorized access and cyberattacks, rapidly 
emerge and change and are becoming increasingly sophisticated, exposing us to additional costs to secure our data in accordance 
with  customer  expectations  and  statutory  and  regulatory  requirements.  We  could  also  experience  a  breach  by  intentional  or 
negligent conduct on the part of our employees or other internal sources or by merchants using our customers’ debit and credit 
cards, software bugs, other technical malfunctions, or other causes. As a result of any of these threats, our computer systems 
and/or  our  customer  accounts  could  become  vulnerable  to  misappropriation  of  confidential  information,  account  takeover 
schemes, ransomware, or cyberfraud. A ransomware attack could potentially shut down our data processing system and prevent 
us from accessing critical information. Our systems and those of our third-party vendors may become vulnerable to damage or 
disruption  due  to  circumstances  beyond  our  or  their  control,  such  as  from  catastrophic  events,  power  anomalies  or  outages, 
natural  disasters,  network  failures,  and  viruses  and  malware. Events  may  occur  that  increase  our  and  other  companies’ 
vulnerability  with  respect  to  cybersecurity  risks,  such  as  a  sudden  and  substantial  increase  in  remote  work  by  employees  as 
occurred  during  the  early  stages  of  the  pandemic  or  may  occur  during  adverse  weather  events,  and  as  a  result  of  increased 
cyberattacks by foreign actors, including in connection with the wars and violence in Ukraine and Israel and surrounding areas. 

A breach of security that results in unauthorized access to our data could result in violations of applicable privacy and other laws 
and expose us to disruptions in our daily operations as well as to data loss, litigation, damages, fines and penalties, regulatory 
sanctions, customer  notification  requirements,  significant  increases  in  compliance  and  insurance  costs,  increases  in  costs  for 
measures  to  minimize  and  remediate  these risks  and  breaches,  loss  of  confidence  in  our  security  measures,  and  reputational 
damage, any of which could individually or in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, 
financial condition, prospects, and shareholder value. 

22 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
 
We have attempted to address these concerns by backing up our systems as well as retaining qualified third-party vendors to test 
and audit our network. However, there can be no guarantees that our efforts and those of our third-party vendors will be successful 
in  avoiding  material  problems  with  our  information  technology  and  telecommunications  systems.  We  may  not  be  able  to 
anticipate all cyber security breaches or implement effective preventative measures against such breaches. 

Changes in deposit mix have increased our funding costs, which could continue, and loss of deposits could also increase our 
funding costs. 

Deposits have historically been a low cost and stable source of funding. We compete with banks and other financial institutions 
for deposits. Funding costs could increase if the Company loses deposits and replaces them with more expensive sources of 
funding, if customers shift their deposits into higher cost products, or if the Company needs to raise its interest rates to avoid 
losing deposits. Higher funding costs reduce the Company’s net interest margin, net interest income and net income. As interest 
rates began to rise significantly during 2022, competition for deposits increased, and the Bank raised rates it offered on deposits 
to remain competitive in its markets. During 2023, as interest rates continued to rise and remain high, customers continued to 
shift into interest-bearing deposit products and we also utilized brokered time deposits, which increased our total costs of deposits 
by 207 basis points from 2022 to 2023. Disruptions in the banking industry during the first half of 2023 discussed elsewhere in 
this report highlighted the speed at which deposits can be moved from bank to bank or outside the banking system, heightening 
liquidity concerns of traditional banks. Any further increases in interest rates, sustained high interest rates or any new events 
producing concerns among customers about the safety of uninsured deposits could further increase our cost of deposits or cause 
us to lose deposits, which would increase our costs of funds and reduce net income. 

We may need to raise additional capital in the future to execute our long-term business strategy or to comply with regulatory 
requirements. 

In addition to the liquidity that we require to conduct our day-to-day operations, the Company, on a consolidated basis, and the 
Bank, on a stand-alone basis, must meet regulatory requirements. Also, we may need capital to finance our long-term growth, 
including through acquisitions. For example, in 2019, we sold $25.0 million of subordinated notes structured to qualify as Tier 
2 capital, and $30.0 million of common stock, in part to fund acquisitions. If the Bank’s regulators deemed its capital levels to 
be too low for safety and soundness reasons or if the Bank were to be designated as “undercapitalized” or in a lower capitalization 
category than “undercapitalized,” it could be required to raise additional capital. For additional information, see Item 1. Business 
- Regulatory Capital Requirements - Prompt Corrective Action Regulations. 

Our ability to raise additional capital depends on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other 
factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry, market conditions and governmental activities, and on our 
financial condition and performance. Rising interest rates as experienced during 2022 and 2023 increased our costs of short-term 
borrowings and long-term debt. Further increases in interest rates would increase the costs of our variable rate borrowings. There 
can be no assurances that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. If we fail to maintain 
capital to meet regulatory requirements, our business, financial condition, results of operations and long-term growth prospects 
could be materially and adversely affected. 

Competition in our industry is intense, which could adversely affect our profitability and long-term growth. 

We face substantial competition in all areas of our operations from a variety of different competitors, many of which are larger 
and have substantially greater resources than we have, including higher total assets and capitalization, a more extensive and 
established  branch  network,  greater  access  to  capital  markets  and  a  broader  offering  of  financial  services.  Such  competitors 
primarily include national, regional and community banks within the various markets in which we operate. Because of their scale, 
many of these competitors can be more aggressive than we can on loan and deposit pricing. We also face competition from many 
other types of financial institutions, including savings and loans, credit unions, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance 
companies, factoring companies and other financial intermediaries. Many of these entities have fewer regulatory constraints and 
may have lower cost structures than we do. There has been an increasing trend of credit unions acquiring banks. Credit unions 
are tax-exempt entities which provides an advantage when pricing loans and deposits. The acquisition of banks by credit unions 
may increase competition for customers and acquisitions. 

Our  industry  could  become  even  more  competitive  as  a  result  of  legislative  and  regulatory  changes,  as  well  as  continued 
consolidation. Finally, technology has lowered barriers to entry and made it possible for non-banks to offer products and services 
traditionally provided by banks, such as automatic transfer and automatic payment systems, including Venmo and PayPal, and 
such  as  bitcoin  and  other  types  of  cryptocurrencies.  The  process  of  eliminating  banks  as  intermediaries,  known  as 
“disintermediation,” could result in the loss of fee income, as well as the loss of customer deposits and related income from those 
deposits. Disintermediation can also impact our lending business because of the growth of fintech companies delivering lending 
and other financial services. We may also lose employees to these competitors. Our ability to compete successfully depends on 

23 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
a number of factors, including customer convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, pricing and range of products. If we 
are  unable  to  successfully  compete,  our  business,  financial  condition,  and results  of  operations  will  be  materially  adversely 
affected. 

If  the  goodwill  that  we  record  in  connection  with  a  business  acquisition  becomes  impaired,  it  could  require  charges  to 
earnings, which would have a negative impact on our financial condition and results of operations. 

Goodwill represents the amount by which the cost of an acquisition exceeded the fair value of net assets we acquired in connection 
with the purchase of another financial institution. We review goodwill for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if 
events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset might be impaired. 

We determine impairment by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that 
goodwill. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment 
loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. Any such adjustments are reflected in our results of operations in the periods 
in which they become known. As of December 31, 2023, our goodwill totaled $40.1 million. While we have not recorded any 
such  impairment  charges  since  we  initially  recorded  the  goodwill,  there  can  be  no  assurance  that  our  future  evaluations  of 
goodwill will not result in findings of impairment and related write-downs, which may have a material adverse effect on our 
financial condition and results of operations. 

The value of the securities in our investment portfolio may decline in the future, and we may incur losses with respect to our 
investment securities. 

Our investment securities portfolio may be impacted by market conditions beyond our control, including fluctuations in interest 
rates, rating agency downgrades of the securities, credit deterioration or default of issuers of the securities, and inactivity or 
instability in the credit markets. For example, during 2022, increases in interest rates had a negative effect, particularly on the 
value of our available for sale investment securities portfolio, which we carry at fair value on our consolidated balance sheets. 
As  of December  31,  2023,  gross  unrealized losses  in  our  investment  portfolio,  primarily  reflected  in  accumulated  other 
comprehensive  loss  on  the  consolidated  balance  sheets, totaled $57.7 million. If  investment  securities  in  an  unrealized  loss 
position are sold, such losses would become realized, which would adversely affect our results of operations. We evaluate our 
investment securities on at least a quarterly basis, and more frequently if economic and market conditions warrant, to determine 
whether any decline in fair value below amortized cost is the result of an other-than-temporary impairment. The process for 
determining  impairment  and  any  credit  losses  with  respect  to  our  investment  securities  often  requires  complex,  subjective 
judgments about the future financial performance. In addition, market volatility may make it difficult to value certain securities. 
Subsequent valuations, in light of factors prevailing at that time, may result in significant changes in the values of these securities 
in future periods. Any of these factors could require us to recognize losses or impairments in the value of our securities portfolio, 
which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations in future periods. 

We face significant fraud, operational and other risks related to our activities, which could expose us to negative publicity, 
litigation and/or regulatory action. 

We are exposed to many types of operational risks, including, particularly as a financial institution, fraud risks and human error. 
Our fraud risks include fraud committed by external parties against the Company or our customers, fraud committed internally 
by our associates and fraud committed by customers. Certain fraud risks, including identity theft and account takeover, may 
increase as a result of customers’ accounts or personally identifiable information being obtained through breaches of retailers’ 
or other third parties’ networks. Fraud attacks against us and other companies in the financial services industry, and against our 
customers when engaged in financial transactions, have increased in recent years and have become more sophisticated and more 
difficult to detect. We expect that detecting and preventing fraud, and remediating losses caused by fraud, will continue to require 
ongoing and potentially increased attention and investment. There are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies, as 
there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated, monitored or identified. If our risk 
management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses, we may have to expend resources detecting and 
correcting the failure in our systems and we may be subject to potential claims from third parties and government agencies. We 
may  also  suffer  severe  reputational  damage.  Any  of  these  consequences  could  materially  and  adversely  affect  our  business, 
financial condition or results of operations. 

Because the nature of the financial services industry involves a high volume of transactions, certain systems or human errors 
may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and successfully rectified. The Company’s necessary dependence 
upon  automated  systems  to  record  and  process  our  transaction  volume  may  further  increase  the  risk  that  technical  flaws  or 
associate tampering or manipulation of those systems will result in losses that are difficult to detect. The Company is further 
exposed to the risk that our third-party vendors may be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations or will be subject to the same 
risk of fraud or systems or human errors as we are. These risks include the cybersecurity risks discussed above. 

24 

   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Risks Related to Our Industry 

We operate in a highly regulated environment, which could restrain our growth and profitability. 

We are subject to extensive regulation and supervision under federal and state banking laws and regulations that govern almost 
all aspects of our operations, including, among other things, our lending practices, deposit-taking practices, capital structure, 
investment practices, dividend policy, operations and growth. The level of regulatory scrutiny that we are subject to may fluctuate 
over time, based on numerous factors, including as a result of changes in the political administrations. These laws and regulations, 
and the supervisory framework that oversees the administration of these laws and regulations, are primarily intended to protect 
consumers, depositors, the Deposit Insurance Fund and the banking system as a whole, and not shareholders and counterparties. 
Furthermore, new proposals for legislation continue to be introduced in the U.S. Congress that could further substantially increase 
regulation  of  the  financial  services  industry,  and  impose  restrictions  on  our  operations  and  our  ability  to  conduct  business 
consistent with historical practices, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of 
operations and growth prospects. Our efforts to comply with new laws, regulations and standards typically result in increased 
expenses and a diversion of management time and attention. The information under the heading “Supervision and Regulation” 
in Item 1. Business, provides more information regarding the regulatory environment in which we and the Bank operate. 

Federal regulators periodically examine our business, and we may be required to remediate adverse examination findings. 

The financial services industry is subject to intense scrutiny from bank supervisors in the examination process and aggressive 
enforcement of regulations on both the federal and state levels. The Federal Reserve and the  OCC periodically examine our 
business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a federal banking agency were 
to determine that our financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity, or other 
aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that we were in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a 
number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” 
practices, to require affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative 
order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties 
against our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected 
or  there  is  an  imminent  risk  of  loss  to  depositors,  to  terminate  our  deposit  insurance  and  place  us  into  receivership  or 
conservatorship. If we become subject to any regulatory actions, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results 
of  operations,  financial  condition  and  growth  prospects.  Failure  to  comply  with  any  applicable  regulations  and  supervisory 
expectations related thereto could result in fines, penalties, lawsuits, regulatory sanctions, damage to our reputation or restrictions 
on business. 

We are subject to numerous laws designed to protect consumers, including the Community Reinvestment Act and fair lending 
laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to a wide variety of sanctions. 

The ECOA, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on 
financial institutions. The Department of Justice and other federal agencies enforce these laws and regulations, but private parties 
may also have the ability to challenge an institution’s performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation. If an 
institution’s performance under the fair lending laws and regulations is found to be deficient, the institution could be subject to 
damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity, restrictions on expansion, 
and restrictions on entering new business lines, among other sanctions. In addition, the OCC’s assessment of our compliance 
with the Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) is taken into account when evaluating any application we submit for, among 
other things, approval of the acquisition or establishment of a branch or other deposit facility, an office relocation, a merger or 
the acquisition of another financial institution. Our failure to satisfy our CRA obligations could, at a minimum, result in the 
denial of such applications and limit our growth. 

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes 
and regulations. 

The Bank Secrecy Act, the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001, and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among 
other  duties,  to  institute  and  maintain  an  effective  anti-money  laundering  program  and  file  suspicious  activity  and  currency 
transaction reports as appropriate. The federal Financial Crimes Enforcement Network is authorized to impose significant civil 
money  penalties  for  violations  of  those  requirements  and  has  recently  engaged  in  coordinated  enforcement  efforts  with  the 
individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration and Internal 
Revenue Service. We are also subject to increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets 
Control.  If  our  policies,  procedures  and  systems  are  deemed  deficient,  we  would  be  subject  to  liability,  including  fines  and 
regulatory actions, which may include restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals 
to proceed with certain aspects of our business plan, including our acquisition plans. Failure to maintain and implement adequate 

25 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us. Any of 
these results could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects. 

In addition, bank regulatory agencies consider the effectiveness of a financial institution’s anti-money laundering activities and 
other regulatory compliance matters when reviewing bank mergers and bank holding company acquisitions. Accordingly, non-
compliance with the applicable regulations could materially impair the Company’s ability to enter into or complete mergers and 
acquisitions.  

Our success depends on our ability to respond to the threats and opportunities of fintech innovation. 

Fintech developments, such as bitcoin or other types of cryptocurrency and the development of alternative payment systems such 
as Venmo and PayPal, have the potential to disrupt the financial industry and change the way banks do business. Our success 
depends on our ability to adapt to the pace of the rapidly changing technological environment, which is crucial to retention and 
acquisition of customers. On July 31, 2018, the OCC announced it would grant limited-purpose national bank charters to fintech 
companies that offer bank products and services. The federal charter would allow fintech companies to operate nationwide under 
a single set of national standards, without needing to seek state-by-state licenses or joining with brick-and-mortar banks, which 
could have the effect of allowing fintech companies to more easily compete with us for financial products and services in the 
communities we serve. At present, the future of the OCC limited-purpose fintech charter is unclear. To date, the OCC has not 
approved any such charters and each application for a charter has been met with a lawsuit challenging the OCC’s authority to 
issue such charters. 

We may be required to pay significantly higher FDIC deposit insurance premiums in the future. 

The deposits of Investar Bank are insured by the FDIC up to legal limits and, accordingly, subject it to the payment of FDIC 
deposit insurance assessments. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC 
deposit insurance. A bank’s regular assessments are determined by its risk classification, which is based on certain financial 
information and the level of supervisory concern that it poses. In order to maintain a strong funding position and restore the 
reserve ratios of the Deposit Insurance Fund, the FDIC has, in the past, increased deposit insurance assessment rates and charged 
a  special  assessment  to  all  FDIC-insured  financial  institutions.  While  the  FDIC’s  special  assessment  in  2023  generally  only 
applied to banks with over $5 billion in total assets, further increases in assessment rates or special assessments that apply to all 
banks may occur in the future, especially if there are significant financial institution failures. Any future special assessments, 
increases in assessment rates or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums could reduce our profitability or limit our 
ability  to  pursue  certain business opportunities,  which  could  have  an  adverse  effect on  our business, financial  condition  and 
results of operations. 

Our use of third-party vendors and our other ongoing third-party business relationships are subject to increasing regulatory 
requirements and attention. 

We regularly use third-party vendors as part of our business. We also have substantial ongoing business relationships with other 
third parties. These types of third-party relationships are subject to increasingly demanding regulatory requirements and attention 
by our federal bank regulators. Regulation requires us to perform due diligence and ongoing monitoring and control over our 
third-party vendors and other ongoing third-party business relationships. In certain cases, we may be required to renegotiate our 
agreements with these vendors to meet these requirements, which could increase our costs. We expect that our regulators will 
hold us responsible for deficiencies in our oversight and control of our third-party relationships and in the performance of the 
parties  with  which  we  have  these  relationships.  As  a  result,  if  our  regulators  conclude  that  we  have  not  exercised  adequate 
oversight and control over our third-party vendors or other ongoing third-party business relationships or that such third parties 
have  not  performed  appropriately,  we  could  be  subject  to  enforcement  actions,  including  civil  money  penalties  or  other 
administrative or judicial penalties or fines as well as requirements for customer remediation, any of which could have a material 
adverse effect our business, financial condition or results of operations. 

26 

   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Risks Related to an Investment in our Common Stock 

The market price of our common stock may be volatile, which may make it difficult for investors to sell their shares at the 
volume, prices and times desired. 

The market price of our common stock may fluctuate substantially due to a variety of factors, many of which are beyond our 
control, including, without limitation: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

actual, anticipated, or unanticipated variations in our quarterly and annual operating results, financial condition or asset
quality; 

changes in general economic or business conditions, both domestically and internationally; 

the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies, including the interest rate policies of the Federal
Reserve, or in laws and regulations affecting us; 

changes in the credit, mortgage and real estate markets; 

the number of securities analysts covering us; 

our creditworthiness; 

publication of research reports about us, our competitors, or the financial services industry generally, or changes in, or
failure to meet, securities analysts’ estimates of our financial and operating performance, or lack of research reports by
industry analysts or ceasing of coverage; 

changes in market valuations or earnings of companies that investors deemed comparable to us; 

the average daily trading volume of our common stock; 

future issuances of our common stock or other securities; 

changes in dividends on our common stock; 

additions or departures of key personnel; 

perceptions in the marketplace regarding our competitors and/or us; 

significant acquisitions or business combinations, strategic partnerships, joint ventures or capital commitments by or
involving our competitors or us; and 

other news, announcements or disclosures (whether by us or others) related to us, our competitors, our markets or the
financial services industry. 

The stock market and, in particular, the market for financial institution stocks have experienced significant fluctuations in recent 
years. In addition, significant fluctuations in the trading volume in our common stock may cause significant price variations to 
occur. Increased market volatility may materially and adversely affect the market price of our common stock, which may make 
it difficult for investors to sell their shares at the volume, prices and times desired. 

Shares eligible for future sale and shares we may issue in the future could adversely affect market prices of our common 
stock. 

Shares of our common stock eligible for future sale, including those that may be issued in any private or public offering of our 
common stock, as consideration in acquisition transactions, or as incentives under incentive plans, could adversely affect market 
prices  for our common  stock. As  of  December 31, 2023, we had 9,748,067 shares  outstanding  and 326,605 shares subject  to 
options granted under our incentive plan. Because our outstanding shares of common stock either were issued in an offering 
registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) or have been held for more than one year, such 
shares are freely tradable, except for shares held by our affiliates (approximately 6% of shares outstanding as of December 31, 
2023) and 336,749 shares that represent unvested restricted shares under our incentive plan. Shares issued under our incentive 
plan will be available for sale into the public market, except for shares held by our affiliates. Shares held by our affiliates may 
be resold subject to the restrictions in Rule 144 of the Securities Act. In the future, we may issue additional shares of common 
stock to raise capital for growth or as consideration in acquisition transactions or for other purposes, and such shares may be 
registered under the Securities Act and freely tradable or may be issued in a private placement and registered for resale under the 
Securities Act. 

27 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Our dividend policy may change without notice, and our future ability to pay dividends is subject to restrictions. 

Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive only such cash dividends as our board of directors may declare out of funds 
legally available for the payment of dividends. We have no obligation to continue paying dividends, and we may change our 
dividend policy at any time without notice to our shareholders. In addition, our existing and future debt agreements limit, or may 
limit, our ability to pay dividends. Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, we may 
not pay a dividend if either our parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after 
giving effect to the payment of the dividend, would not maintain regulatory capital ratios that are as “well capitalized” levels for 
regulatory capital purposes. We are also prohibited from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of 
Default under such notes. Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, we are prohibited 
from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Our ability to pay dividends 
may be limited on account of the junior subordinated debentures that we assumed through acquisitions. We must make payments 
on the junior subordinated debentures before any dividends can be paid on our common stock. 

Since the Company’s primary asset is its stock of Investar Bank, we are dependent upon dividends from the Bank to pay our 
operating expenses, satisfy our obligations and to pay dividends on the Company’s common stock. Accordingly, any declaration 
and payment of dividends on common stock will substantially depend upon the Bank’s earnings and financial condition, liquidity 
and  capital  requirements,  the  general  economic  and  regulatory  climate  and  other  factors  deemed  relevant  by  our  board  of 
directors. Furthermore, consistent with our strategic plans, capital availability, projected liquidity needs, and other factors, we 
have made, and will continue to make, capital management decisions and policies that could adversely impact the amount of 
dividends, if any, paid to our common shareholders. 

In  addition,  there  are  numerous  laws  and  banking  regulations  that  limit  our  and  Investar  Bank’s  ability  to  pay 
dividends. For further discussion of the regulatory restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, see Item 1. Business – Supervision 
and Regulation – Dividends. 

Our Restated Articles of Incorporation and By-laws, and certain banking laws applicable to us, could have an anti-takeover 
effect that decreases our chances of being acquired, even if our acquisition is in our shareholders’ best interests. 

Certain provisions of our restated articles of incorporation and our by-laws, as amended, and federal banking laws, including 
regulatory approval requirements, could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire control of our organization or conduct 
a proxy contest, even if those events were perceived by many of our shareholders as beneficial to their interests. These provisions, 
and the corporate and banking laws and regulations applicable to us: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

enable our board of directors to issue additional shares of authorized, but unissued capital stock. In particular, our board
may issue “blank check” preferred stock with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from
time to time by the board; 

enable our board of directors to increase the size of the board and fill the vacancies created by the increase; 

enable our board of directors to amend our by-laws without shareholder approval; 

require advance notice for director nominations and other shareholder proposals; and 

require prior regulatory application and approval of any transaction involving control of our organization. 

These  provisions  may  discourage  potential  acquisition  proposals  and  could  delay  or  prevent  a  change  in  control,  including 
circumstances in which our shareholders might otherwise receive a premium over the market price of our shares. 

Our issuance of preferred stock could adversely affect holders of our common stock and discourage a takeover. 

Our shareholders authorized our board of directors to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock without any further action 
on the part of our shareholders. The board also has the power, without shareholder approval, to set the terms of any series of 
preferred stock that may be issued, including voting rights, dividend rights, preferences over our common stock with respect to 
dividends or in the event of a dissolution, liquidation or winding up and other terms. In the event that we issue preferred stock in 
the future that has preference over our common stock with respect to payment of dividends or upon our liquidation, dissolution 
or winding up, or if we issue preferred stock with voting rights that dilute the voting power of our common stock, the rights of 
the holders of our common stock or the market price of our common stock could be adversely affected. In addition, the ability of 
our board of directors to issue shares of preferred stock without any action on the part of our shareholders may impede a takeover 
of us and prevent a transaction perceived to be favorable to our shareholders. 

28 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is subject to risk of loss. 

Our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss by the FDIC, any deposit insurance fund or by 
any other public or private entity. Investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk 
Factors” section and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is subject to the same market forces that affect the price 
of common stock in any company. As a result, an investor may lose some or all of his or her investment in our common stock. 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments 

Not applicable. 

Item 1C. Cybersecurity 

Risk Management and Strategy  

As a financial institution, we believe that the risk of cybersecurity incidents is a significant, increasing, and always evolving risk 
for our business. Federal law and regulations require us to maintain a comprehensive written information security program, and 
federal banking regulators regularly issue guidance regarding cybersecurity threats intended to enhance our cybersecurity risk 
management. Accordingly, we have developed and implemented processes for assessing, identifying and managing material risks 
from cybersecurity threats designed to comply with federal law and regulations and protect against cybersecurity threats to our 
business.  Our  program  is  supported  by  management  and  the  Company’s  Board  of  Directors  (the  “Board  of  Directors”). The 
Company  maintains  an  active  cyber  insurance  policy  to  enhance  protections  against  material  data  intrusions  or  loss  of 
privacy. For an overview of the federal banking laws and regulations that govern our management and oversight of cybersecurity 
risks,  refer  to  Item  1.  Business  –  Supervision  and  Regulation  –  “Financial  Privacy  and  Cybersecurity  Requirements,” 
incorporated by reference into this Item 1C. 

The Company’s Information Security Program (the “Program”) is comprised of five pillars: the Information Security Policy, the 
Enterprise Information Security Risk Assessment, the Incident Response Plan, a formalized Security Awareness Campaign, and 
an enterprise monitoring and reporting program. 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

the  same 

The Information  Security  Policy contains  numerous distinct  administrative  and  technical  controls  that  govern  data
security  for  the  organization and  is  based  on  the  National  Institute  of  Standards  and  Technology (“NIST”) 
Cybersecurity Framework. The policy is reviewed and approved by the Board of Directors annually. 
impact
The  Enterprise  Information  Security  Risk  Assessment quantifies  risk  criteria  utilizing 
measures, including financial, strategic, operational, and reputational, set forth by the Enterprise Risk Committee. The 
risk assessment is reviewed and approved by the Board of Directors annually. The Enterprise Risk Committee includes
members of management from various departments and members of the Board of Directors and oversees the overall
risk  management  of  the  Company. The  Enterprise  Risk  Committee  meets  as  often  as  appropriate  to  perform  its 
responsibilities,  but  no  less  than  once  per  calendar  quarter  and reports  findings  and  provides  recommendations to 
the Board of Directors on a routine basis. 
The Incident Response Plan (“IRP”) includes procedures for responding to actual or potential cybersecurity incidents,
including providing timely notice to customers and our bank regulatory agencies when appropriate. The IRP is based 
on the NIST Cybersecurity Framework. The plan is tested annually through tabletop exercises. 
The Security Awareness Campaign is designed with the goal that employees are educated on policy, threats, and best
practices from onboarding and throughout their tenure at the Company. This effort includes an onboarding training
program, annual attestation and training, and weekly communication designed to help instill in employees a security
mindset through repetition. 
The  Company  maintains an enterprise monitoring  and  reporting  program,  which  identifies key  risk  indicators  for 
tracking  and  identifying  trends.  The  key  risk  indicators  are  presented  to  the  Company’s  Information  Technology
Committee (“IT Committee”) and the Board of Directors on a monthly basis. 

29 

  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
The Program is monitored each year through various internal and external audits, as well as OCC regulatory exams. Vulnerability 
and penetration testing are also conducted at least annually by an independent third party to supplement the vulnerability and 
patching  program  routinely  performed  by  internal  staff. Third-party  vendors  supplement  the  Company’s  internal  patching 
program  as  necessary. The  Company  also  utilizes  a  third-party  “SOC  as  a  Service” to  monitor  extended  detection  and 
response logs and network traffic. 

Third-party service provider risk is evaluated prior to and throughout the relationship. Third-party service providers must meet 
a minimum set of baseline security standards prior to being onboarded. During onboarding, the third party and the services they 
provide are added to the Information Security Risk Assessment, including consideration of inherent risk factors and mitigating 
controls. Alternative vendors and the effort to transition between vendors are identified during onboarding as well as in the event 
that the selected provider may fail in providing contracted services at any time. After a third party is onboarded, they are subject 
to the annual third-party risk management program, specific to their assigned risk criticality. This effort includes the review of 
service  organization  controls  reports,  business  continuity  and  disaster  recovery efforts,  insurance  certificates,  and  other 
compliance related concerns when applicable. 

During the  last  three years we have not  experienced any  cybersecurity  incidents  that  have  materially  affected our  Company, 
including our business, strategy, results of operations or financial condition. For a discussion of how risks from cybersecurity 
threats may be reasonably likely to materially affect us, refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors – Risks Related to our Business – “We 
rely on information technology and telecommunications systems, many of which are provided by third-party vendors” and – 
“Cyberattacks  or  other  security  breaches  could  adversely  affect  our  operations,  net  income  or  reputation,”  incorporated  by 
reference into this Item 1C.  

Governance 

The  Board  of  Directors  is  responsible  for  oversight  of  risks from  cybersecurity  threats. Oversight  of  cybersecurity  risk 
management is performed primarily by the Board of Directors and the IT Committee. The IT Committee consists of members of 
the Board of Directors and key members of management. The IT Committee’s primary purpose is to assist the Board of Directors 
in its oversight of technology and innovation strategies, plans and operations related to cybersecurity, data privacy, and third-
party  technology risk management. The  Chief  Information  Security Officer  (“CISO”) provides  monthly  information  security 
reports on cybersecurity programs, policies and controls, key risk indicators and trends including responses to any cybersecurity 
events, and efforts to improve security. Annually, the CISO provides security training to the Board of Directors. The CISO also 
provides  the  Board  of  Directors  with  an  annual  Information  Security  Program  Summary  Report  in  compliance  with  federal 
banking guidelines. 

The  program  is  managed  by  the CISO who  reports  to  the  Chief  Operations  Officer  and  is  reviewed  by  regulators  as  well  as 
internal auditors. The Chief Information Officer (“CIO”) and information technology staff support the CISO in cybersecurity 
operations as necessary to mitigate risks to the Company's technology infrastructure. The CISO holds two cybersecurity industry 
leading certifications (CISSP, CCSP) and has more than 20 years of technology experience. Information technology staff are 
generally  subject  to  professional  education,  experience,  and certification  requirements,  and  receive  education  and  mentoring 
from the CISO and CIO. 

Item 2. Properties 

Our main office, which serves as our executive and operations center, is located at 10500 Coursey Boulevard in Baton Rouge, 
Louisiana. In addition, we operate 28 full-service branches. Our 20 branches in Louisiana are located in Ascension (1), East 
Baton Rouge (3), West Baton Rouge (1), Jefferson (2), Lafayette (2), Livingston (1), Orleans (1), St. Tammany (1), Tangipahoa 
(1), East Feliciana (2), West Feliciana (1), Evangeline (3) and Calcasieu (1) Parishes. Our two branches in Texas are located in 
Galveston (1) and Harris (1) Counties, and one loan and deposit production office is located in Montgomery County. Our six 
branches in Alabama are located in Calhoun (3), Sumter (2), and Tuscaloosa (1) Counties. We also have one stand-alone ITM in 
Morgan City, Louisiana. 

We  own  the building, known  as  Investar Tower,  in  which  our  main office  is  located, and  all  of our  branch offices, with  the 
exception of two leased branch locations in Louisiana, and two leased branch locations and one loan and deposit production 
office in Texas. As lessor, we lease space on the first floor of our main office building to multiple tenants, and we also lease a 
portion of one of our branch locations. Each of our owned branch facilities is a stand-alone building with on-site parking and 
drive-up access, the majority of which are equipped with an ATM or ITM. We believe that our facilities are in good condition 
and are adequate to meet our operating needs for the foreseeable future. 

30 

  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
We also own a tract of land in each of the following Louisiana parishes: East Baton Rouge Parish; St. Mary Parish; and Ascension 
Parish.  Each  tract  of  land  has  been  designated  as  either  a  future  branch  or  stand-alone  ITM  location.  The  timing  of  the 
development of these tracts of land is uncertain. 

Item 3. Legal Proceedings 

From time to time we are party to ordinary routine litigation matters incidental to the conduct of our business. We are not presently 
party to, and none of our property is the subject of, any legal proceedings, the resolution of which we believe would have a 
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows, growth prospects or capital levels, 
nor were any such proceedings terminated during the fourth quarter of 2023. 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures 

Not applicable. 

31 

  
  
  
  
  
 
 
PART II 

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities 

Market Information 

Our common stock is listed on the Nasdaq Global Market (the “Nasdaq”) under the symbol “ISTR.” As of March 4, 2024, there 
were approximately 712 holders of record of our common stock including participants in security position listings. 

Dividend Policy 

The Company has paid a quarterly dividend since 2011 and intends to continue to declare dividends on a quarterly basis. The 
declaration  of  dividends  is  at  the  discretion  of  our  board  of  directors  and  will  depend  on  our  financial  performance,  future 
prospects, regulatory requirements and other factors deemed relevant by the board of directors. 

Since we are a holding company with no material business activities, our ability to pay dividends is substantially dependent upon 
the  ability  of  Investar  Bank  to  transfer  funds  to  us  in  the  form  of  dividends,  loans  and  advances.  The  Bank’s  ability  to  pay 
dividends  and  make  other  distributions  and  payments  to  us  depends  upon  the  Bank’s  earnings,  financial  condition,  general 
economic conditions, compliance with regulatory requirements and other factors. In addition, the Bank’s ability to pay dividends 
to us is itself subject to various legal, regulatory and other restrictions. See Item 1. Business – Supervision and Regulation – 
Dividends, above for a discussion of the restrictions on dividends under federal banking laws and regulations. In addition, as a 
Louisiana  corporation,  we  are  subject  to  certain  restrictions  on  dividends  under  the  Louisiana  Business  Corporation  Act. 
Generally, a Louisiana corporation may pay dividends to its shareholders unless, after giving effect to the dividend, either (1) the 
corporation would not be able to pay its debts as they come due in the usual course of business or (2) the corporations’ total 
assets are less than the sum of its total liabilities and the amount that would be needed, if the corporation were to be dissolved at 
the time of the payment of the dividend, to satisfy the preferential rights of shareholders whose preferential rights are superior to 
those receiving the dividend. In addition, our existing and future debt agreements limit, or may limit, our ability to pay dividends. 
Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, we may not pay a dividend if either our 
parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after giving effect to the payment of 
the dividend, would not maintain regulatory capital ratios that are at “well capitalized” levels for regulatory capital purposes. We 
are also prohibited from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Under the 
terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, we are prohibited from paying dividends upon and 
during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Finally, our ability to pay dividends may be limited on account 
of the junior subordinated debentures that we assumed through acquisitions. We must make payments on the junior subordinated 
debentures before any dividends can be paid on our common stock. 

These restrictions do not, and are not expected in the future to, materially limit the Company’s ability to pay dividends to its 
shareholders in an amount consistent with the Company’s history of paying dividends. 

32 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Stock Performance Graph 

The above graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return on the Company’s common stock over a measurement period 
beginning at the market close on the last trading day of 2018, with (i) the cumulative total return on the stocks included in the 
Russell 3000 Index and (ii) the cumulative total return on the stocks included in the S&P United States SmallCap Banks Index, 
which includes banks with market capitalizations of $250 million to $1 billion. The performance graph assumes that the value of 
the investment in our common stock, the Russell 3000 Index and the S&P United States SmallCap Banks Index was $100 at 
December 31, 2018 and that all dividends were reinvested. 

Index 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Russell 3000 
S&P US SmallCap Banks 

Investar Holding Corporation 
Russell 3000 
S&P US SmallCap Banks 

Investar Holding Corporation 
Russell 3000 
S&P US SmallCap Banks 

97.72    $ 
131.02      
125.46      

96.39    $ 
118.71      
114.88      

100.00    $ 
100.00      
100.00      

   12/31/2018      6/30/2019       12/31/2019      6/30/2020    
59.36  
  $ 
126.47  
85.84  
   12/31/2020      6/30/2021       12/31/2021      6/30/2022    
93.00  
  $ 
157.04  
133.49  

77.51    $ 
199.03      
158.62      
   12/31/2022      6/30/2023       12/31/2023       
65.91      
  $ 
202.54        
140.55        

95.61    $ 
182.32      
144.29      

68.61    $ 
158.39      
113.94      

92.27    $ 
160.80      
139.85      

52.68    $ 
186.80      
108.62      

There can be no assurance that our common stock performance will continue in the future with the same or similar trends depicted 
in the performance graph above. We will not make or endorse any predictions as to future stock performance. 

The information provided under the heading “Stock Performance Graph” shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or to 
be “filed” with the SEC or subject to its proxy regulations or to the liabilities of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934, as amended, other than as provided in Item 201 of Regulation S-K. The information provided in this section shall not be 
deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Exchange 
Act of 1934, as amended. 

33 

  
 
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
   
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities 

Not applicable. 

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities 

(a) Total Number of 
Shares (or Units) 
Purchased(1) 

(b) Average Price 
Paid per Share (or 
Unit)(2) 

(c ) Total Number 
of Shares (or Units) 
Purchased as Part 
of Publicly 
Announced Plans or 
Programs 

(d) Maximum 
Number (or 
Approximate Dollar 
Value) of Shares (or 
Units) That May Be 
Purchased Under 
the Plans or 
Programs(3) 

22,000    $ 

9,794      

—      
31,794    $ 

10.67      

9.89      

—      
10.43      

22,000       

9,766       

—       
31,766       

524,032  

514,266  

514,266  
514,266  

Period 
October 1, 2023 to  
October 31, 2023 
November 1, 2023 to 
November 30, 2023 
December 1, 2023 to 
December 31, 2023 

Includes 28 shares surrendered to cover the payroll taxes due upon the vesting of restricted stock. 

(1)  
(2)  The average price paid per share does not include the effect of excise tax expense incurred on net stock repurchases. 
(3)  The Company has had a stock repurchase program since 2015. On July 19, 2023, the Company announced that its
board of directors authorized the repurchase of an additional 350,000 shares of the Company’s common stock under
its stock repurchase plan. As of December 31, 2023, the Company had 514,266 shares remaining available under the
program. 

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans 

Please refer to the information under the heading “Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans” in Item 
12, Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters, for a discussion of the 
securities authorized for issuance under the Company’s equity compensation plans. 

Item 6. [Reserved] 

34 

  
  
  
  
    
    
    
  
    
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 

This  section  presents  management’s  perspective  on  the  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  of  Investar  Holding 
Corporation and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National Association (the “Bank,” together with Investar Holding 
Corporation, the “Company,” “we,” “our,” or “us”). The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with 
the Company’s consolidated financial statements and related notes and other supplemental information included herein. Certain 
risks, uncertainties and other factors, including those set forth under Item 1A. Risk Factors in Part I, and elsewhere in this Annual 
Report on Form 10-K, may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected results discussed in the forward-looking 
statement appearing in this discussion and analysis. 

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS 

This  annual  report  on  Form  10-K,  both  in  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of 
Operations, and elsewhere, contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act and 
Section 21E  of  the  Securities  Exchange  Act  of  1934,  as  amended  (the  “Exchange  Act”).  These  forward-looking  statements 
include statements relating to our projected growth, anticipated future financial performance, changes in our allowance for credit 
losses  including  due  to  the  adoption  of  ASU  2016-13,  anticipated  future  credit  quality  and  our  potential  ability  to  achieve 
performance and strategic goals, as well as statements relating to the anticipated effects of these factors on our business, financial 
condition and results of operations. These statements can typically be identified through the use of words or phrases such as 
“may,”  “should,”  “could,”  “predict,”  “potential,”  “believe,”  “think,”  “will  likely  result,”  “expect,”  “continue,”  “will,” 
“anticipate,” “seek,” “estimate,” “intend,” “plan,” “projection,” “would” and “outlook,” or the negative version of those words 
or other comparable words or phrases of a future or forward-looking nature. 

Our  forward-looking  statements  contained  herein  are  based  on  assumptions  and  estimates  that  management  believes  to  be 
reasonable in light of the information available at this time. However, many of these statements are inherently uncertain and 
beyond our control and could be affected by many factors. Factors that could have a material effect on our business, financial 
condition, results of operations, cash flows and future growth prospects can be found in Item 1A. Risk Factors. These factors 
include, but are not limited to, the following, any one or more of which could materially affect the outcome of future events: 

• 

the  significant  risks  and  uncertainties  for  our  business,  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition,  as  well  as  our
regulatory  capital  and  liquidity  ratios  and  other  regulatory  requirements caused  by  business  and  economic  conditions
generally and in the financial services industry in particular, whether nationally, regionally or in the markets in which we
operate; 

•  changes  in  inflation,  interest  rates,  yield  curves  and  interest  rate  spread  relationships  that  affect  our  loan  and  deposit

pricing; 

•  our ability to continue to successfully execute the pivot of our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to a
strategy primarily focused on consistent, quality earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet, and our ability to
successfully execute a long-term growth strategy; 

•  our ability to achieve organic loan and deposit growth, and the composition of that growth; 

•  a reduction in liquidity, including as a result of a reduction in the amount of deposits we hold or other sources of liquidity,
which may be caused by, among other things, disruptions in the banking industry similar to those that occurred in early
2023 that caused bank depositors to move uninsured deposits to other banks or alternative investments outside the banking
industry; 

•  our  ability  to  identify  and  enter  into  agreements  to  combine  with  attractive  acquisition  partners,  finance  acquisitions,
complete acquisitions after definitive agreements are entered into, and successfully integrate and grow acquired operations;

•  our adoption on January 1, 2023 of ASU 2016-13, and inaccuracy of the assumptions and estimates we make in establishing

reserves for credit losses and other estimates; 

•  changes in the quality or composition of our loan portfolio, including adverse developments in borrower industries or in

the repayment ability of individual borrowers; 

•  changes in the quality and composition of, and changes in unrealized losses in, our investment portfolio, including whether

we may have to sell securities before their recovery of amortized cost basis and realize losses; 

• 

the extent of continuing client demand for the high level of personalized service that is a key element of our banking
approach as well as our ability to execute our strategy generally; 

•  our dependence on our management team, and our ability to attract and retain qualified personnel; 

• 

the concentration of our business within our geographic areas of operation in Louisiana, Texas and Alabama; 

35 

  
  
  
  
  
  
increasing costs of complying with new and potential future regulations; 

• 
•  new or increasing geopolitical tensions, including resulting from wars in Ukraine and Israel and surrounding areas; 
• 
•  concentration of credit exposure; 

the emergence or worsening of widespread public health challenges or pandemics including COVID-19; 

•  any deterioration in asset quality and higher loan charge-offs, and the time and effort necessary to resolve problem assets;

• 

fluctuations in the price of oil and natural gas; 

•  data processing system failures and errors; 

• 

risks  associated  with  our  digital  transformation  process,  including  increased  risks  of  cyberattacks  and  other  security
breaches and challenges associated with addressing the increased prevalence of artificial intelligence; 

risks of losses resulting from increased fraud attacks against us and others in the financial services industry; 

• 
•  potential impairment of our goodwill and other intangible assets; 

•  our potential growth, including our entrance or expansion into new markets, and the need for sufficient capital to support

that growth; 

• 

the impact of litigation and other legal proceedings to which we become subject; 

•  competitive pressures in the commercial finance, retail banking, mortgage lending and consumer finance industries, as

well as the financial resources of, and products offered by, competitors; 

• 

the impact of changes in laws and regulations applicable to us, including banking, securities and tax laws and regulations
and accounting standards, as well as changes in the interpretation of such laws and regulations by our regulators; 

•  changes in the scope and costs of FDIC insurance and other coverages; 

•  governmental monetary and fiscal policies; 

•  hurricanes, tropical storms, tropical depressions, floods, winter storms, droughts and other adverse weather events, all of
which have affected our market areas from time to time; other natural disasters; oil spills and other man-made disasters; 
acts of terrorism; other international or domestic calamities; acts of God; and other matters beyond our control; and 

•  other circumstances, many of which are beyond our control. 

The foregoing factors should not be construed as exhaustive and should be read together with the other cautionary statements 
included herein. If one or more events related to these or other risks or uncertainties materialize, or if our underlying assumptions 
prove to be incorrect, actual results may differ materially from what we anticipate. Accordingly, you should not place undue 
reliance on any such forward-looking statements. 

Any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and we do not undertake any obligation to publicly 
update or review any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise. New 
factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict which will arise. In addition, we cannot assess the impact 
of each factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ 
materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. We qualify all of our forward-looking statements by these 
cautionary statements. 

Overview 

Through our wholly-owned subsidiary Investar Bank, National Association, we provide full banking services, excluding trust 
services, tailored primarily to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses. Our primary 
areas of operation are south Louisiana (approximately 80% of our total deposits as of December 31, 2023), including Baton 
Rouge,  New  Orleans,  Lafayette,  Lake  Charles,  and  their  surrounding  areas;  southeast  Texas,  primarily  Houston  and  its 
surrounding area and Alabama, including York and Oxford and their surrounding areas. As of March 7, 2024, we operated 28 
full service branches comprised of 20 full service branches in Louisiana, two full service branches in Texas, and six full service 
branches in Alabama. Our Bank commenced operations in 2006 and we completed our initial public offering in July 2014. On 
July 1, 2019, the Bank changed from a Louisiana state bank charter to a national bank charter and its name changed to Investar 
Bank, National Association. 

36 

  
  
   
  
  
 
 
During 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to primarily a focus on consistent, quality 
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. Our long-term strategy includes organic growth through high quality 
loans and growth through acquisitions, including whole-bank acquisitions, strategic branch acquisitions and asset acquisitions. 
We have completed seven whole-bank acquisitions since 2011 and regularly review acquisition opportunities. Our most recent 
whole bank acquisition was completed in April 2021. During our last three fiscal years, we have not opened any de novo branch 
locations; however,  in  the  third quarter of 2023, we  converted  an  existing  loan  and deposit  production  office in  Tuscaloosa, 
Alabama to a cashless branch designed to provide a digital banking experience. During the third and fourth quarters of 2023, we 
purchased commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million in two tranches. 

We  have  continued  to  evaluate  opportunities  to  improve  our  branch  network  efficiency,  leverage  our  digital  initiatives,  and 
further reduce costs. We closed five branches during our last three fiscal years, and one in Alabama during the first quarter of 
2024. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that resulted in significant cost 
savings. In 2022, we sold five former branch locations and three tracts of land that were being held for future branch locations. 
On January 27, 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with our Alice, Texas and 
Victoria, Texas branch locations to First Community Bank in order to focus more on our core markets. Of the Bank’s entire 
branch network, these two locations were geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters. During the third 
quarter of 2023, we ceased operation of 14 ATMs. 

In an effort to focus more on our core business and optimize profitability, in the third quarter of 2023, we made the strategic 
decision  to  exit the  consumer mortgage  origination  business. Consumer  mortgage  loan  products  are  typically  long-term  and 
fixed-rate  and  generally  require  a  higher  relative  allowance  for  credit  losses  than  other  loan  products.  Consumer  mortgage 
volumes have decreased to historical lows due to the combination of rising housing prices and interest rates and constriction of 
housing supply. As a result of this decision, we further optimized our workforce and will continue to dedicate resources to our 
more  profitable  business  lines.  Related  severance  expense  was  $0.1  million.  Substantially  all  of  the  consumer  mortgage 
portfolio is included in the 1-4 family loan category. 

Our principal business is lending to and accepting deposits from individuals and small to medium-sized businesses in our areas 
of operation. As a financial holding company operating through one reportable segment, we generate our income principally 
from interest on loans and, to a lesser extent, our securities investments, as well as from fees charged in connection with our 
various  loan  and  deposit  services.  Our  principal  expenses  are  interest  expense  on  interest-bearing  customer  deposits  and 
borrowings, salaries and employee benefits, occupancy costs, data processing and other operating expenses. We measure our 
performance through our net interest margin, return on average assets, and return on average equity, among other metrics, while 
seeking to maintain appropriate regulatory leverage and risk-based capital ratios. 

37 

  
  
  
   
 
 
For certain GAAP performance measures, see “Certain Performance Indicators” below. We also monitor changes in our tangible 
equity,  tangible  assets,  tangible  book  value  per  share,  and  our  efficiency  ratio,  shown  in  the  section  “Certain  Performance 
Indicators: Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below. 

Certain Performance Indicators 

(In thousands, except share data) 
Financial Information 

Total assets 
Total stockholders' equity 
Net interest income 
Net income 
Diluted earnings per share 

Performance Ratios 

Return on average assets 
Return on average equity 
Net interest margin 
Dividend payout ratio 

Capital Ratios 

Total equity to total assets 
Tangible equity to tangible assets(3) 

2023(1) 

As of and for the years ended December 31, 
2021(2) 

2020(2) 

2022 

2019(2) 

  $ 2,815,155      $ 2,753,807     $ 2,513,203     $ 2,321,181     $  2,148,916  
241,976  
64,818  
16,839  
1.66  

226,768        
74,520        
16,678        
1.69        

242,598       
83,814       
8,000       
0.76       

215,782       
89,785       
35,709       
3.50       

243,284       
73,534       
13,889       
1.27       

0.60 %     
7.63        
2.83        
23.37        

1.37%    
15.63       
3.67       
10.31       

0.31%    
3.22       
3.53       
40.26       

0.61%    
5.77       
3.49       
19.69       

0.85%
8.21  
3.51  
13.55  

8.06 %     
6.65        

7.84%    
6.37       

9.65%    
8.04       

10.48%    
9.22       

11.26%
9.96  

(1)  During 2023 we purchased commercial and industrial lines of credit with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million.
We also sold certain assets, deposits, and other liabilities associated with two branches in Texas previously acquired
from PlainsCapital Bank. 

(2)  The following acquisitions are included from the date of each acquisition: On March 1, 2019, the Company acquired
Mainland Bank, by merger with and into the Bank. On November 1, 2019, the Company acquired Bank of York, by
merger with and into the Bank. On February 21, 2020, the Bank acquired two branches from PlainsCapital Bank. On 
April 1, 2021, the Company acquired Cheaha Financial Group, Inc. and its wholly-owned subsidiary Cheaha Bank, by
merger with and into the Company and Bank, respectively. 

(3)  Non-GAAP financial measure. See reconciliation below. 

Certain Performance Indicators: Non-GAAP Financial Measures 

Our accounting and reporting policies conform to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, or GAAP, and 
the prevailing practices in the banking industry. However, we also evaluate our performance based on certain additional metrics. 
The efficiency ratio, tangible book value per share, and the ratio of tangible equity to tangible assets are not financial measures 
recognized under GAAP and, therefore, are considered non-GAAP financial measures. 

38 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Our management, banking regulators, financial analysts and investors use these non-GAAP financial measures to compare the 
capital adequacy of banking organizations with significant amounts of preferred equity and/or goodwill or other intangible assets, 
which  typically  stem  from  the  use  of  the  purchase  accounting  method  of  accounting  for  mergers  and  acquisitions.  Tangible 
equity, tangible assets, tangible book value per share or related measures should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute 
for  total  stockholders’  equity,  total  assets,  book  value  per  share  or  any other  measure calculated  in  accordance  with  GAAP. 
Moreover, the manner in which we calculate tangible equity, tangible assets, tangible book value per share and any other related 
measures may differ from that of other companies reporting measures with similar names. The following table reconciles, as of 
the dates set forth below, stockholders’ equity (on a GAAP basis) to tangible equity and total assets (on a GAAP basis) to tangible 
assets and calculates both our tangible book value per share and efficiency ratio (dollars in thousands). 

Total stockholders’ equity - GAAP 
Adjustments: 
Goodwill 
Core deposit intangible 
Trademark intangible 

Tangible equity 

  $

  $

2023 
226,768      $

As of and for the years ended December 31, 
2021 
242,598     $ 

2022 
215,782     $

2020 
243,284     $

2019 
241,976  

40,088        
2,132        
100        
184,448      $

40,088       
2,959       
100       
172,635     $

40,088       
3,848       
100       
198,562     $ 

28,144       
3,988       
100       
211,052     $

26,132  
4,803  
100  
210,941  

Total assets - GAAP 
Adjustments: 
Goodwill 
Core deposit intangible 
Trademark intangible 

Tangible assets 

Total shares outstanding 
Book value per share 
Effect of adjustments 
Tangible book value per share 
Total equity to total assets 
Effect of adjustments 
Tangible equity to tangible assets 

Efficiency ratio(1) 
Noninterest expense 
Net interest income 
Noninterest income 
Efficiency ratio 

  $ 2,815,155      $ 2,753,807     $ 2,513,203     $  2,321,181     $ 2,148,916  

40,088        
2,132        
100        

26,132  
4,803  
100  
  $ 2,772,835      $ 2,710,660     $ 2,469,167     $  2,288,949     $ 2,117,881  

40,088       
2,959       
100       

28,144       
3,988       
100       

40,088       
3,848       
100       

     9,748,067         9,901,847       10,343,494       10,608,869       11,228,775  
21.55  
  $
(2.76) 
18.79  
11.26%
(1.30) 
9.96%

23.45     $ 
(4.25)      
19.20     $ 
9.65%     
(1.61)      
8.04%     

23.26      $
(4.34 )      
18.92      $
8.06 %    
(1.41 )      
6.65 %    

21.79     $
(4.36)      
17.43     $
7.84%     
(1.47)      
6.37%     

22.93     $
(3.04)      
19.89     $
10.48%    
(1.26)      
9.22%    

  $

  $

62,630      $
74,520        
6,538        
77.26 %    

60,865     $
89,785       
18,350       
56.29%     

63,062     $ 
83,814       
12,042       
65.79%     

57,131     $
73,534       
12,096       
66.72%    

48,168  
64,818  
6,216  
67.81%

(1)   Calculated as noninterest expense divided by the sum of net interest income (before provision for credit losses) and

noninterest income. 

Critical Accounting Estimates 

The preparation of our consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires us to make estimates and judgments 
that  affect  our  reported  amounts  of  assets,  liabilities,  income  and  expenses  and  related  disclosure  of  contingent  assets  and 
liabilities. Although independent third parties are often engaged to assist us in the estimation process, management evaluates the 
results, challenges assumptions used and considers other factors which could impact these estimates. Actual results may differ 
from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions. 

For more detailed information about our accounting policies, please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies. 
The following discussion presents our critical accounting estimates, which are those estimates made in accordance with GAAP 
that involve a significant level of estimation uncertainty and have had or are reasonably likely to have a material impact on our 
financial  condition  or  results  of  operations.  We  believe  that  the  judgments,  estimates  and  assumptions  that  we  use  in  the 
preparation of our consolidated financial statements are appropriate. 

39 

  
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
     
     
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
      
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Allowance  for  Credit  Losses.  In  June  2016,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  (“FASB”)  issued  a  new  accounting 
standard (Accounting Standards Update “ASU” 2016-13), referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss (“CECL”) standard, 
which became effective for us, as a smaller reporting company, on January 1, 2023. The CECL methodology requires that lifetime 
expected credit losses be recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or acquired, and be adjusted each period for changes 
in expected lifetime credit losses. The CECL methodology replaces multiple prior impairment models under U.S. GAAP that 
generally  required  that  a  loss  be  “incurred”  before  it  was  recognized,  and  represents  a  significant  change  from  prior  U.S. 
GAAP. Results for reporting periods beginning prior to January 1, 2023 are presented in accordance with ASU 2016-13 while 
prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with previously applicable U.S. GAAP. 

For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

On  January  1,  2023,  we  adopted  Accounting  Standards  Codification  (“ASC”)  Topic  326,  “Financial  Instruments—Credit 
Losses,” commonly referred to as Current Expected Credit Losses (“CECL”), on a modified retrospective basis. The provisions 
of  this  guidance  required  a  material  change  to  the  manner  in  which  the  Company  estimates  and  reports  losses  on  financial 
instruments,  including  loans  and  unfunded  lending  commitments,  select  investment  securities,  and  other  assets  carried  at 
amortized cost.  

The allowance is sensitive to external factors including the general health of the economy, as evidenced by changes in interest 
rates, gross domestic product, unemployment rates, and changes in real estate demand and values. Management considers these 
variables and all other available information when establishing the final level of the allowance. These variables and others have 
the  ability  to  result  in  actual  loan  losses  that  differ  from  the  originally  estimated  amounts.  Changes  in  the  factors  used  by 
management to determine the appropriateness of the allowance or the availability of new information could cause the allowance 
to be increased or decreased in future periods. 

The Company’s management considers available forecasts, current events not captured and our specific portfolio characteristics 
and applies weights to the scenario output based on a best estimate of likely outcomes. Changing economic conditions have 
introduced enhanced estimation uncertainty in the forecasts used to estimate expected credit loss. Our credit loss models were 
built  using  historical  data  that  may  not  correlate  to  existing  economic  conditions.  Such  forecasted  information  is  inherently 
uncertain, therefore, actual results may differ significantly from management’s estimates. 

The quantitative loss rate analysis is supplemented by a review of qualitative factors that considers whether conditions differ 
from those existing during the historical periods used in the development of the credit loss models. Such factors include, but are 
not limited to, changes in current and expected future economic conditions, changes in the nature and volume of the portfolio, 
changes  in  levels  of  concentrations,  changes  in  the  volume  and  severity  of  past  due  loans,  changes  in  lending  policies  and 
personnel and changes in the competitive and regulatory environment of the banking industry. While quantitative data for these 
factors is used where available, there is significant judgment applied in these processes. 

For credits that are individually evaluated, a specific allowance is calculated as the shortfall between the credit’s value and the 
Bank’s  exposure.  The  loan’s  value  is  measured  by  either  the  fair  value  of  the  collateral  of  the  loan  based  on  third-party 
appraisals if it is collateral dependent, or based on a discounted cash flow methodology. Collateral on impaired loans may include, 
but  is  not  limited  to,  commercial  and  residential  real  estate  and accounts  receivable.  Values  for  impaired  credits  are  highly 
subjective  and  based  on  information  available  at  the  time  of  valuation  and  the  current  resolution  strategy.  These  values  are 
difficult to assess and have heightened uncertainty resulting from current market conditions. Actual results could differ from 
these estimates. 

Management  considers  the  appropriateness  of  these  critical  assumptions  as  part  of  its  allowance  review  and  believes  the 
allowance for credit loss level is appropriate based on information available through the financial statement date. Please refer to 
Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses, and Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit 
Losses and – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023, for additional discussion.  

40 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

The allowance for loan losses was established as losses were estimated through a provision for loan losses charged to earnings. 
Through  December  31,  2022,  the  allowance  for  loan  losses  was  based  on  the  amount  that  management  believed  would  be 
adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio based on, among other things, evaluations of the collectability 
of loans and prior loan loss experience. The evaluations took into consideration such factors as changes in the nature and volume 
of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, review of specific problem loans, and current economic conditions that may affect 
borrowers’ ability to pay. Another component of the allowance was losses on loans assessed as impaired under FASB Accounting 
Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 310,“Receivables” (“ASC 310”). The balance of the loans determined to be impaired 
under ASC 310 and the related allowance was included in management’s estimation and analysis of the allowance for loan losses. 
Allowances for impaired loans were generally determined based on collateral values or the present value of estimated cash flows. 

The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance was inherently subjective as it requires estimates that are susceptible 
to significant revision as more information became available. We had an established methodology to determine the adequacy of 
the allowance for loan losses that assessed the risks and losses inherent in our portfolio and portfolio segments. We have an 
internally  developed  model  that  required  significant  judgment  to  determine  the  estimation  method  that  fit the  credit  risk 
characteristics of the loans in our portfolio and portfolio segments. Qualitative and environmental factors that may not be directly 
reflected  in  quantitative  estimates  include:  asset  quality  trends,  changes  in  loan  concentrations,  new  products  and  process 
changes, changes and pressures from competition, changes in lending policies and underwriting practices, trends in the nature 
and  volume  of  the  loan  portfolio,  and  national  and  regional  economic  trends.  Changes  in  these  factors  were  considered  in 
determining changes in the allowance for loan losses. The impact of these factors on our qualitative assessment of the allowance 
for loan losses could change from period to period based on management’s assessment of the extent to which these factors were 
already reflected in historic loss rates. The uncertainty inherent in the estimation process was also considered in evaluating the 
allowance for loan losses. 

Acquisition Accounting. We account for our acquisitions under ASC Topic 805,“Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”), which 
requires the use of the purchase method of accounting. All identifiable assets acquired, including loans, are recorded at fair value 
(which is discussed below). The excess purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If the 
fair value of the net assets acquired exceeds the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. 

For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

ASU 2016-13 amended  the accounting  model  for  purchased  financial  assets  and  replaced  the  guidance  for  purchased  credit 
impaired (“PCI”) financial assets with the concept of purchased credit deteriorated (“PCD”) assets. For PCD assets, the CECL 
estimate is recognized through the allowance for credit losses with an offset to the amortized cost basis of the PCD asset at the 
date of acquisition. Subsequent changes in the allowance for credit losses for PCD assets are recognized through a provision for 
credit losses on loans. We used the prospective transition approach for PCD loans that were previously classified as PCI and 
accounted  for  under ASC 310-30, “Loans  and  Debt  Securities  Acquired  with  Deteriorated  Credit  Quality” (“ASC 310-30”). 
As permitted under ASU 2016-13, the Company did not reassess whether PCI assets met the criteria of PCD assets as of the date 
of adoption. 

Please  refer  to Note  1. Summary  of  Significant  Accounting  Policies  –  Acquisition  Accounting  and  –  Accounting  Standards 
Adopted in 2023, for additional discussion.  

For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

Because  the fair  value measurements  incorporated  assumptions regarding  credit  risk,  no  allowance  for  loan  losses  related  to 
acquired loans was recorded on the acquisition date. The fair value measurements of acquired loans were based on estimates 
related to expected prepayments and the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows. 
The fair value adjustment was amortized over the life of the loan using the effective interest method. 

Through  December  31,  2022,  we  accounted  for  acquired  impaired  loans  under  ASC  Topic  310-30.  An  acquired  loan  was 
considered  impaired  when  there  was  evidence  of  credit  deterioration  since  origination  and  it  was  probable  at  the  date  of 
acquisition that we would be unable to collect all contractually required payments. ASC 310-30 prohibited the carryover of an 
allowance for loan losses for acquired impaired loans. Over the life of the acquired loans, we continually estimated the cash 
flows expected to be collected on individual loans or on pools of loans sharing common risk characteristics. As of the end of 
each fiscal quarter, we evaluated the present value of the acquired loans using the effective interest rates. For any increases in 
cash flows expected to be collected, we adjusted the amount of accretable yield recognized on a prospective basis over the loan’s 
or pool’s remaining life, while we recognized a provision for loan loss in the consolidated statement of operations if the cash 
flows expected to be collected had decreased. 

41 

  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Overview of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 

Net income for the year ended December 31, 2023 totaled $16.7 million, or $1.69 per diluted share, compared to $35.7 million, 
or $3.50 per diluted share, for the year ended December 31, 2022. This represents a $19.0 million, or a 53.3%, decrease in net 
income. 

Net  income decreased primarily  due  to a $15.3 million  decrease  in  net  interest  income  and an $11.8  million decrease  in 
noninterest income, partially offset by a $2.0 million negative provision for credit losses in 2023 compared to a provision for 
credit  losses  of $2.9  million  in  2022. The  decrease  in  net  interest  income was  a  result  of  a  $43.9 million  increase  in  interest 
expense partially offset by a $28.6 million increase in interest income, as the Bank experienced margin compression due to rising 
market interest rates. The decrease in noninterest income is mainly attributable to $8.1 million of swap termination fees and $1.4 
million of income from insurance proceeds recorded during the year ended December 31, 2022 and the loss on sale or disposition 
of  fixed  assets  of  $1.3  million  during  the  year ended December  31,  2023,  primarily  resulting  from the  sale  of  the  Alice  and 
Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3 million for the year ended December 
31, 2022. The negative provision for credit losses of $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily due to net 
recoveries  of  $2.3  million  in  2023.  At December  31,  2023,  the  Company  and  the  Bank  each  were  in  compliance  with  all 
regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank was considered “well-capitalized” under prompt corrective action regulations. 

Additional key components of the Company’s performance during the year ended December 31, 2023 are summarized below. 

• 

Credit quality metrics improved as nonperforming loans were 0.26% of total loans at December 31, 2023 compared
to 0.54% at December 31, 2022. 

•  We recognized net recoveries of $2.3 million in the loan portfolio during the year ended December 31, 2023 primarily 
attributable  to  recoveries  on  one  loan  relationship  that  became  impaired  in  the  third  quarter  of  2021 as  a  result  of 
Hurricane Ida. 

•  We recognized interest recoveries of $1.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, $1.1 million of which are

attributable to one commercial and industrial oil and gas loan relationship. 

• 

• 

Total deposits were $2.3 billion at December 31, 2023, an increase of $173.4 million, or 8.3%, compared to deposits
of  $2.1 billion  at  December  31,  2022.  Noninterest-bearing  deposits  decreased $132.0 million,  or  22.7%,  to 
$448.8 million compared to $580.7 million at December 31, 2022. Time deposits and brokered time deposits increased,
and  other  deposit  categories  decreased.  At December  31,  2023,  estimated  uninsured  deposits  represented
approximately 32% of our total deposits.  

Total  loans  increased $105.9 million,  or  5.0% to $2.2 billion  at  December  31,  2023,  compared  to $2.1 billion  at 
December  31, 2022. Excluding  approximately $13.9  million  in  loans associated  with  the  Alice  and Victoria, Texas
branches sold in January 2023 and approximately $162.7 million in revolving lines of credit purchased during 2023,
total  loans  decreased  $43.0  million,  or  2.1%,  to $2.05  billion  at December  31,  2023,  compared  to  $2.09  billion
at December 31, 2022. 

•  On January 1, 2023, Investar adopted ASU 2016-13. Also referred to as the CECL standard, ASU 2016-13 requires the 
measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical experience,
current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. Upon adoption, we recorded a one-time, cumulative effect 
adjustment to increase the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million and reduce retained earnings, net of tax, by $4.3
million. Our allowance for credit losses to total loans was 1.38% at December 31, 2023. 

•  Net interest income for the year ended December 31, 2023 was $74.5 million, a decrease of $15.3 million, or 17.0%, 
compared to $89.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2022, driven primarily by an increase in the rates paid on 
interest-bearing liabilities, partially offset by increases in the volume and yield earned on interest-earning assets. 

•  We experienced pressure on our net interest margin as interest rates rose rapidly during 2022 and 2023, and we raised
rates offered on deposits and incurred higher costs on our borrowings. For the year ended December 31, 2023 our net 
interest margin was 2.83%, compared to 3.67% for the year ended December 31, 2022 

• 

Return on average assets decreased to 0.60% for the year ended December 31, 2023, compared to 1.37% for the year 
ended  December  31,  2022.  Return  on  average  equity  was 7.63% for  the year  ended  December  31,  2023 compared 
to 15.63% for the year ended December 31, 2022. 

42 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
•  We  repurchased  222,448  shares  of  our  common  stock  at  an  average  price  of  $13.47  per  share  during  2023  and
repurchased 518,978 shares of our common stock at an average price of $20.27 per share during 2022. We increased
dividends by 8% to $0.395 per share for 2023 from $0.365 per share for 2022. 

• 

Stockholders’ equity increased 5.1% to $226.8 million at December 31, 2023, compared to December 31, 2022, due to
net income for 2023 and a decrease in accumulated other comprehensive loss due to an increase in the fair value of the
Bank’s AFS securities portfolio, partially offset by the cumulative effect adjustment as a result of the adoption of ASU
2016-13 reflected in retained earnings. 

Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability 

Rising Inflation and Interest Rates. During the entirety of 2021, the federal funds target rate was 0% to 0.25%, and it remained 
at that rate until March 2022. Inflation increased rapidly during 2021 through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation 
generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared to recent historical periods. In response, the Federal 
Reserve  raised  the  federal  funds  target  rate  multiple  times  from  March  2022  through  July  2023. Through  these  incremental 
increases to the target rate, the Federal Reserve has raised, on a cumulative basis, the target rate from 0% to 0.25% by 525 basis 
points to 5.25% to 5.50%. 

Disruptions in the Banking Industry in 2023. Between March 10, 2023 and March 12, 2023, state banking supervisors closed 
Silicon Valley Bank (“SVB”) and Signature Bank and named the FDIC as receiver. At the time of closure, they were among the 
30 largest U.S. banks. Reports indicated that, among other things, both banks had grown in asset size in recent periods at a faster 
rate than their peers, had large proportions of uninsured deposits (approximately 87.5% and 89.7% of total deposits, respectively) 
and high unrealized losses on investment securities. SVB’s business strategy focused on serving the technology and venture 
capital sectors, and Signature Bank had significant exposure to deposits from the digital asset industry. Prior to their closure, 
both banks experienced sudden and rapid deposit withdrawals. These events caused bank deposit customers, particularly those 
with uninsured deposits, to become concerned regarding the safety of their deposits, and in some cases caused customers to 
withdraw deposits. In response to the disruptions, among other things, the Federal Reserve announced a new Bank Term Funding 
Program (“BTFP”) to provide eligible banks with loans of up to one-year maturity backed by collateral pledged at par value. On 
April 24, 2023, San Francisco-based First Republic Bank, also among the 30 largest U.S. banks, reported a large deposit outflow 
and substantially reduced net income. First Republic Bank also had a large proportion of uninsured deposits (67% as of December 
31, 2022). On May 1, 2023, regulators seized First Republic Bank and sold all of its deposits and most of its assets to JPMorgan 
Chase Bank. 

In response to the disruptions and related publicity, we formed an internal task force that included members of our Asset/Liability 
Committee (“ALCO”). The task force met frequently to review our liquidity position and liquidity sources, and oversaw the 
Bank’s process to qualify for the BTFP. In addition, we took steps to inform our customers about our financial position, liquidity 
and  insured  deposit  products.  During  the  second  quarter  of  2023,  we  utilized  the  BTFP  and  reduced  Federal  Home  Loan 
Bank (“FHLB”)  advances. The  Bank  utilized  this  source  of  funding due  to  its  lower  rate,  the  ability  to  prepay 
the obligations without penalty, and as a means to lock in funding. During the fourth quarter of 2023 and again in the first quarter 
of  2024,  the  Bank  refinanced  its  BTFP borrowings  with new borrowings  under  the program due  to more  favorable  rates.  In 
January  2024,  the  Federal  Reserve  announced  that  it  will  cease  making  new  loans  under  the  BTFP  on  March  11,  2024.  As 
of December  31,  2023,  estimated  uninsured  deposits  represented  approximately 32% of  our  total  deposits. For  additional 
information, see “Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Deposits, Borrowings, Liquidity and Capital Resources” and 
Part I. Item 1A. Risk Factors. 

Hurricane Ida. On August 29, 2021, Hurricane Ida hit the Louisiana coast as a category 4 hurricane. Though Hurricane Ida did 
not cause significant physical damage to our branch locations, the storm devastated some of our market areas. The Company set 
up programs to help employees and customers experiencing financial difficulty as a result of the hurricane, including a deferral 
program. Additionally, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $21.6 million in the third quarter of 2021 related to a 
lending relationship with related borrowers (collectively, the “Borrower”) consisting of multiple loans secured by various types 
of collateral, including real estate, inventory, and equipment. As a result of Hurricane Ida’s impact on the Borrower’s business 
operations, some of the collateral securing the loan relationship, including real estate, inventory, and equipment, experienced a 
significant reduction in value. Since the third quarter of 2021, as of December 31, 2023, we have recorded net recoveries related 
to this loan relationship of $2.5 million, substantially all of which were in 2023. 

43 

  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
COVID-19 Pandemic. In March 2020, COVID-19 was declared a pandemic by the World Health Organization. Our business 
remained open through the pandemic, although it was significantly disrupted in the early stages of the pandemic as we adjusted 
to various and changing government and voluntary restrictions on activities. The pandemic generally slowed business lending 
activity from the level we would otherwise have expected, particularly in 2020, except for our participation in the Paycheck 
Protection Program (“PPP”) under which we made loans to qualified borrowers that under specified conditions were subject to 
forgiveness and repayment by the federal government. We began participating in the PPP in the second quarter of 2020 and made 
loans totaling $178.0 million, almost all of which had been repaid by the end of 2022. The pandemic and the PPP created excess 
liquidity in the market, contributing to increases in our noninterest and interest-bearing demand deposits, and in money market 
deposit  accounts  and  savings  accounts  in  2021.  We  took  actions  to  protect  our  customers  and  employees  throughout  the 
pandemic, including increasing our remote banking and working options. We recorded an increased provision for loan losses 
during 2020 as a result of the impact of the pandemic. Market conditions generally improved during 2021 and 2022 compared to 
2020, as vaccines became available and government restrictions lessened. The federal government declared an end to the COVID-
19 public health emergency in May 2023. 

Acquisitions. On  April  1,  2021,  the  Company  completed  its  acquisition  of  Cheaha  Financial  Group,  Inc. (“Cheaha”) and  its 
wholly-owned subsidiary, Cheaha Bank, an Alabama state bank headquartered in Oxford, Alabama that served the residents of 
Calhoun Country, Alabama through four branch locations. All of the issued and outstanding shares of Cheaha were converted 
into aggregate cash merger consideration of $41.1 million. On the date of the acquisition, Cheaha had total assets with a fair 
value of $240.8 million, including $120.4 million in loans, and we assumed $207.0 million in deposits. The Company recorded 
a core deposit intangible and goodwill of $0.8 million and $11.9 million, respectively, related to the acquisition of Cheaha. 

Adoption of ASU 2016-13. As discussed throughout this report, we adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023, and recorded a 
one-time,  cumulative  effect adjustment  that  increased  the  allowance  for  credit  losses  by  $5.9  million  and  decreased  retained 
earnings, net of tax, by $4.3 million. 

Loan Purchase Agreement. In August 2023, we entered into a loan purchase agreement to acquire commercial and industrial 
revolving lines of credit, and related accrued interest, with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million and total commitments 
of $237.8 million in two tranches. The first and second tranches consist of unpaid principal balances of $35.8 million and $127.0 
million, respectively, and total commitments of $61.1 million and $176.7 million, respectively. The purchase of the first tranche 
was completed on September 15, 2023, and the purchase of the second tranche was completed on October 3, 2023. The revolving 
lines of credit are variable-rate and shorter-term in nature with varying renewal terms. The loans are to consumer finance lending 
companies  that  possess  a  history  of  high  credit  quality  and  that  we  believe  provide  us  with  opportunities  to  deepen  the 
relationships through our services such as treasury management. We also hired two individuals with significant experience in 
lending in this area. 

Sale of Two Branches to First Community Bank. On January 27, 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and 
other liabilities associated with the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations to First Community Bank, a Texas state bank located in 
Corpus Christi, Texas. We sold approximately $13.9 million in loans and $14.5 million in deposits. 

Exit from Consumer Mortgage Origination Business. In the third quarter of 2023, we made the strategic decision to exit the 
consumer mortgage origination business. For additional discussion, see “Overview.” 

Branch Closures. We closed one branch location in Prairieville, Louisiana in April 2021 and one branch location in Dickinson, 
Texas  in  October  2021.  We  closed  one  branch  location in  Baton  Rouge,  Louisiana and  one  branch  location  in  Westlake, 
Louisiana in May 2022. We closed one branch location in Central, Louisiana in March 2023. We sold the land and buildings 
relating to five locations during 2022. During 2022, we also sold three tracts of land that were held for future branch locations. 
In the first quarter of 2024, we closed one branch in Alabama. We continue to evaluate opportunities to reduce our physical 
branch footprint and further improve efficiency through digital initiatives.  

Subordinated Debt Issuance and Redemption. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate 
principal amount of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Subordinated Notes due 2032 (the “2032 Notes”). In June 2022, we used the 
majority of the proceeds to redeem $18.6 million of our 2017 issuance of 6.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 
2027 (the “2027 Notes”). We utilized the remaining proceeds for share repurchases and for general corporate purposes. 

Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition 

Total  assets  were $2.82 billion  at  December  31,  2023, an  increase of  $61.3  million,  or 2.2%,  compared  to  total  assets 
of $2.75 billion at December 31, 2022. The growth experienced since December 31, 2022 can mainly be attributed to growth in 
loans of $105.9 million primarily due to the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit, partially offset by a 
decrease of $43.2 million in the available for sale securities portfolio. 

44 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Loans 

General. Loans, constitute our most significant asset, comprising 79% and 76%, of our total assets at December 31, 2023 and 
2022, respectively. Loans increased $105.9 million, or 5.0%, to $2.2 billion at December 31, 2023 from $2.1 billion at December 
31, 2022. The increase in loans was primarily the result of the purchase of approximately $162.7 million in revolving lines of 
credit  during  2023  as  described  in Certain  Events  that  Affect  Year-Over-Year  Comparability  –  Loan  Purchase  Agreement, 
partially offset by lower demand and the sale of approximately $13.9 million in loans associated with the sale of the Alice and 
Victoria, Texas branches. Given the elevated interest rate environment, we are emphasizing origination of high margin loans that 
promote long-term profitability and proactively exiting credit relationships that do not fit this strategy. 

The table below sets forth the balance of loans outstanding by loan type as of the dates presented, and the percentage of each 
loan type to total loans (dollars in thousands). 

Mortgage loans on real estate 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Owner-occupied 
Nonowner-occupied 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

December 31, 

2023 

Percentage 
of Total 
Loans 

      Amount 

2022 

Percentage 
of Total 
Loans 

   Amount 

  $

190,371       
413,786       
105,946       
7,651       

449,610       
488,098       
543,421       
11,736       
  $ 2,210,619       

8.6%  $
18.7       
4.8       
0.4       

201,633      
401,377      
81,812      
12,877      

445,148      
20.3       
513,095      
22.1       
435,093      
24.6       
13,732      
0.5       
100%  $ 2,104,767      

9.6%
19.1  
3.9  
0.6  

21.1  
24.4  
20.7  
0.6  
100%

At December  31,  2023,  the  Company’s  total  business  lending  portfolio,  which  consists  of  loans  secured  by  owner-occupied 
commercial  real  estate  properties  and  commercial  and  industrial  loans,  was $993.0 million, an  increase of $112.8 million, 
or 12.8%,  compared  to  the  business  lending  portfolio  of $880.2 million  at December  31,  2022.  The  increase in  the  business 
lending portfolio as of December 31, 2023 is primarily driven by the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of 
credit  described  above,  partially  offset  by  lower  loan  demand  due  to  higher  rates. Largely  as  a  result  of  the  loan  portfolio 
purchase, our variable-rate loans as a percentage of total loans increased to 27% at December 31, 2023 compared to 22% at 
December  31,  2022.  We  continue  to  focus  on  a  relationship-driven  banking  strategy and  have  increased  our  emphasis  on 
originating higher margin commercial and industrial and owner-occupied commercial real estate loans.  

Nonowner-occupied  loans  totaled $488.1 million  at December  31,  2023, a  decrease of $25.0 million,  or 4.9% compared 
to $513.1 million at December 31, 2022, primarily due to a reclassification of approximately $24.1 million nonowner-occupied 
loans to multifamily loans due to a change to the primary use of the property. 

As  discussed  above  under  “Overview,” during  the  third  quarter  of  2023  we  exited  the  consumer  mortgage  loan  origination 
business to transition into shorter duration, higher risk-adjusted return asset classes, in an effort to focus more on our core business 
and  optimize  profitability.  The  consumer  mortgage  portfolio  was  approximately  $261.6  million  at December  31,  2023, 
substantially  all  of  which is  included  in  the  1-4  family  category. The  remaining  loans  in  the  category  consisted  primarily  of 
second mortgages, home equity loans, home equity lines of credit, and business purpose loans secured by 1-4 family residential 
real estate. 

Loan Concentrations. Loan concentrations are considered to exist when there are amounts loaned to multiple borrowers engaged 
in similar activities that would cause them to be similarly impacted by economic or other conditions. At December 31, 2023 and 
December 31, 2022, we had no concentrations of loans exceeding 10% of total loans other than loans in the categories listed in 
the table above. 

45 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
The following table sets forth loans outstanding at December 31, 2023, which, based on remaining scheduled repayments of 
principal, are due in the periods indicated, as well as the amount of loans with fixed and variable rates in each maturity range. 
Loans with balloon payments and longer amortizations are often repriced and extended beyond the initial maturity when credit 
conditions  remain  satisfactory.  Demand  loans,  loans  having  no  stated  schedule  of  repayments  and  no  stated  maturity,  and 
overdrafts are reported below as due in one year or less. 

(dollars in thousands) 
Mortgage loans on real estate: 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Owner-occupied 
Nonowner-occupied 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

Loans with fixed rates: 
Mortgage loans on real estate: 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Owner-occupied 
Nonowner-occupied 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans with fixed rates    $ 

After One 
Year 
Through 
Five Years     

After Five 
Years 
Through 
Ten Years     

After Ten 
Years 
Through 
Fifteen 
Years 

One Year 
or Less 

After 
Fifteen 
Years 

Total 

  $ 

104,701    $ 
51,591      
5,386      
1,496      

51,251    $ 
85,021      
82,147      
4,552      

17,390    $ 
38,047      
16,780      
1,603      

9,106    $ 
21,224      
522      
—      

7,923    $ 
217,903      
1,111      
—      

190,371  
413,786  
105,946  
7,651  

  $ 

  $ 

35,807      
34,408      
300,972      
2,794      
537,155    $ 

100,426      
250,717      
84,165      
7,558      
665,837    $ 

196,837      
161,603      
91,887      
910      
525,057    $ 

107,946      
41,159      
64,944      
384      
245,285    $ 

8,594      
211      
1,453      
90      

449,610  
488,098  
543,421  
11,736  
237,285    $  2,210,619  

13,752    $ 
13,875      
3,786      
592      

50,801    $ 
79,989      
79,151      
3,994      

17,390    $ 
38,047      
6,472      
1,603      

9,106    $ 
21,224      
522      
—      

7,923    $ 
217,903      
1,111      
—      

98,972  
371,038  
91,042  
6,189  

16,882      
30,242      
28,637      
2,108      
109,874    $ 

96,894      
226,060      
73,257      
7,558      
617,704    $ 

159,033      
137,006      
91,887      
910      
452,348    $ 

88,321      
23,408      
64,944      
384      
207,909    $ 

2,136      
211      
1,453      
90      

363,266  
416,927  
260,178  
11,050  
230,827    $  1,618,662  

Loans with variable rates: 
Mortgage loans on real estate: 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Owner-occupied 
Nonowner-occupied 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans with variable 

  $ 

90,949    $ 
37,716      
1,600      
904      

450    $ 
5,032      
2,996      
558      

18,925      
4,166      
272,335      
686      

3,532      
24,657      
10,908      
—      

—    $ 
—      
10,308      
—      

37,804      
24,597      
—      
—      

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      

91,399  
42,748  
14,904  
1,462  

19,625      
17,751      
—      
—      

6,458      
—      
—      
—      

86,344  
71,171  
283,243  
686  

rates 

  $ 

427,281    $ 

48,133    $ 

72,709    $ 

37,376    $ 

6,458    $ 

591,957  

46 

  
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
       
       
       
       
       
   
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
       
       
       
       
       
   
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
   
 
 
Investment Securities 

We purchase investment securities primarily to provide a source for meeting liquidity needs, with return on investment as a 
secondary  consideration.  We  also  use  investment  securities  as  collateral  for  certain  deposits  and  other  types  of  borrowings. 
Investment securities represented 14% of our total assets and totaled $382.4 million at December 31, 2023, a decrease of $31.1 
million,  or 7.5%,  from $413.5 million  at  December  31,  2022.  The  decrease  in  investment  securities  at  December  31,  2023 
compared to December 31, 2022 was driven primarily by a $20.3 million decrease in residential mortgage-backed securities, a 
$9.8 million decrease in obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations, and an $8.4 million 
decrease  in  commercial  mortgage-backed  securities,  partially  offset  by  an  $11.0  million  increase  in  obligations  of  state  and 
political subdivisions. Due in large part to higher interest rates and market volatility, net unrealized losses in our investment 
portfolio totaled $57.3 million at December 31, 2023 and $62.1 million at December 31, 2022.  

The table below shows the carrying value of our investment securities portfolio by investment type and the percentage that such 
investment type comprises of our entire portfolio as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands). 

Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies 

and corporations 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

Total investment securities 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

   Balance 

Percentage 
of Portfolio       Balance 

Percentage 
of Portfolio   

  $

  $

20,043       
34,866       
26,356       
234,354       
66,771       
382,390       

5.2%  $
9.1       
6.9       
61.3       
17.5       
100%  $

29,805      
23,916      
29,942      
254,618      
75,191      
413,472      

7.2%
5.8  
7.2  
61.6  
18.2  
100%

The investment portfolio consists of available for sale (“AFS”) and held to maturity (“HTM”) securities. We do not hold any 
investments classified as trading. We classify debt securities as HTM if management has the positive intent and ability to hold 
the securities to maturity. HTM securities are stated at amortized cost. Securities not classified as HTM are classified as AFS 
and are stated at fair value. At December 31, 2023, AFS securities comprised 95% of our total investment portfolio. 

We adopted ASU 2016-13 effective January 1, 2023. Due to the nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current 
interest rate environment, we determined that the declines in the fair values of the AFS and HTM securities portfolio were not 
attributable to credit losses. Accordingly, there was no adjustment made to the amortized cost basis upon adoption. The carrying 
values of our AFS securities are adjusted for unrealized gains or losses not attributable to credit losses as valuation allowances, 
and any gains or losses are reported on an after-tax basis as a component of other comprehensive income (loss). For additional 
information regarding accounting for our investment securities  upon the adoption of ASU 2016-13, see Note 1. Summary of 
Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023. 

During the year ended December 31, 2023, we purchased $14.1 million of HTM securities classified as obligations of state and 
political subdivisions. There were no purchases of HTM securities during the year ended December 31, 2022. During the year 
ended December 31, 2023, we purchased $107.9 million of AFS investment securities, compared to $181.6 million during the 
year ended  December  31,  2022. Proceeds  from  maturities,  prepayments  and  calls  of  AFS  investment  securities  were  $140.7 
million in 2023 compared to $60.2 million in 2022, and we sold $15.0 million of AFS investment securities in 2023 compared 
to none in 2022. 

U.S.  Treasury  and  U.S. government  agencies and  corporations securities  represented  96%  and  9%  of  the  AFS  securities  we 
purchased in 2023 and 2022, respectively. We utilized excess funds in the third quarter of 2023 to purchase $40.0 million in 
obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations, which matured in October 2023. Mortgage-
backed  securities represented  4%  and  84%  of  the  AFS securities  we  purchased  in  2023 and 2022,  respectively.  We  did  not 
purchase any other investment type in 2023. Of the remaining AFS securities purchased in 2022, 5% were corporate bonds and 
2% were  municipal  securities.  We  only  purchase  corporate  bonds  that  are  investment  grade  securities  issued  by  seasoned 
corporations. 

47 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
The  table  below  sets  forth  the  stated  maturities  and  weighted  average  yields  of  our  investment  debt  securities  based  on  the 
amortized cost of our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands). 

One Year or 
Less 

After One Year 
Through Five 
Years 

After Five 
Years Through 
Ten Years 

     After Ten Years   
  Amount     Yield      Amount      Yield      Amount     Yield      Amount    Yield   

Held to maturity: 
Obligations of states and political 

subdivisions 

Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Available for sale: 
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. 
government agencies and corporations 

Obligations of states and political 

subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

  $ 

960       4.90%   $  2,556       5.31%   $  4,647       4.62%  $ 10,000      5.82 %
—       —        2,309      3.09   
—       —       

—       —       

605       2.88        9,942       5.44        9,836       6.28       

—      —   

27       2.92        1,412       2.37        9,459       2.57        7,870      2.63   
350       3.55        12,439       3.98        14,558       4.38        2,750      2.80   
—       —       
—       —        6,692       2.93       268,258      2.24   
52       4.00        4,827       4.11        3,089       3.25        67,117      3.62   

  $  1,994      

      $ 31,176      

      $ 48,281      

      $358,304     

The maturity of mortgage-backed securities reflects scheduled repayments based upon the contractual maturities of the securities. 
Weighted average yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a fully tax equivalent basis assuming a federal tax 
rate of 21%. 

Premises and Equipment 

Bank premises and equipment decreased $5.4 million, or 10.9%, to $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 from $49.6 million at 
December 31, 2022. The decrease was primarily attributable to the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations and the closure 
of one branch and one stand-alone ATM in Louisiana, which decreased bank premises and equipment by $1.4 million and $1.7 
million, respectively. The remaining decrease was primarily attributable to depreciation. 

Deferred Tax Asset 

At  December  31,  2023,  the  net  deferred  tax  asset  was $16.9 million,  compared  to $16.4 million at  December  31,  2022.  The 
increase in the deferred tax asset at December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022 was primarily driven by the adoption 
of ASU 2016-13, partially offset by a decrease in the net unrealized losses of the Bank’s AFS securities portfolio.  

The Bank acquired net operating loss carryforwards as a result of acquisitions. At December 31, 2023, we held approximately 
$4,000 and $0.3 million in net operating loss carryforwards that expire in 2033 and 2039, respectively. U.S. tax law imposes 
annual limitations under Internal Revenue Code Section 382 on the amount of net operating loss carryforwards that may be used 
to offset federal taxable income. Under these laws, we may apply up to approximately $0.6 million to offset our taxable income 
each  year.  In  addition  to  this  limitation,  our  ability  to  utilize  net  operating  loss  carryforwards  depends  upon  the  Company 
generating taxable income. Given the substantial amount of time before our net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire, we 
currently expect to utilize these net operating loss carryforwards in full before their expiration. 

48 

  
  
  
     
     
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
         
       
  
    
      
        
         
        
         
        
         
       
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
Deposits 

The  following  table  sets  forth  the  composition  of  our  deposits  and  the  percentage  of  each  deposit  type  to  total  deposits  at 
December 31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits 
Interest-bearing demand deposits 
Money market deposit accounts 
Savings accounts 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 

Total deposits 

Percentage 
of Total 
Deposits        Amount 

Percentage 
of Total 
Deposits    
27.9%
27.1  
10.0  
7.5  
0.5  
27.0  
100%

580,741      
19.9%  $
565,598      
21.7       
208,596      
8.0       
155,176      
6.1       
9,990      
11.9       
32.4       
562,264      
100%  $ 2,082,365      

   Amount 
  $

448,752       
489,604       
179,366       
137,606       
269,102       
731,297       
  $ 2,255,727       

Total  deposits  were $2.26 billion  at  December  31,  2023, an  increase of $173.4 million,  or 8.3%,  from  total  deposits 
of $2.08 billion  at  December  31,  2022. Time  deposits  and  brokered  time  deposits  increased,  and  other  deposit  categories 
decreased. The majority of the increase in time deposits at December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022 is due to organic 
growth and existing customer funds migrating from other deposit categories as a result of rising interest rates. Brokered time 
deposits 
at December  31,  2023 from $10.0  million  December  31,  2022.  We 
utilize brokered time deposits, entirely in denominations of less than $250,000, to secure fixed cost funding and reduce short-
term borrowings. We utilized shorter term brokered time deposits, which were laddered in duration to provide flexibility, to fund 
a portion of the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit in 2023. At December 31, 2023, the balance of 
brokered time deposits remained below 10% of total assets, and the remaining weighted average duration was approximately 12 
months with a weighted average rate of 5.18%.  

to $269.1 million 

increased 

The Company had no brokered demand deposits at December 31, 2023 and 2022 or at December 31, 2021. Prior to December 
31, 2021, the Bank utilized brokered demand deposits to satisfy the borrowings under its interest rate swap agreements due to 
more favorable pricing. In the third quarter of 2021, we voluntarily terminated multiple swap agreements, the borrowings for 
which matured in October 2021. During 2022, we voluntarily terminated our remaining interest rate swap agreements. 

Estimated  uninsured  deposits were  $720.1 million and  $701.1 million at December  31,  2023  and  2022,  respectively.  The 
estimates are based on the same methodologies and assumptions used for our regulatory reporting requirements. The insured 
deposit data for 2023 and 2022 does not reflect an evaluation of all of the account ownership category distinctions that would 
determine the availability of deposit insurance to individual accounts based on FDIC regulations. 

The following table shows scheduled maturities of time deposits in excess of the FDIC insurance limit of $250,000 at December 
31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Time remaining until maturity: 
Three months or less 
Over three months through six months 
Over six months through twelve months 
Over twelve months 

Total 

Borrowings 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

68,638    $ 
27,536      
77,471      
20,793      
194,438    $ 

63,006  
13,610  
58,672  
14,228  
149,516  

  $ 

  $ 

Total borrowings include securities sold under agreements to repurchase, federal funds purchased, advances from the Federal 
Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”), borrowings under the BTFP, subordinated debt issued in 2019 and 2022, and junior subordinated 
debentures  assumed  through  acquisitions. We  also  maintain  unsecured  lines  of  credit  with  First  National  Bankers  Bank 
(“FNBB”) and The Independent Bankers Bank (“TIB”) totaling $60.0 million, which are federal funds lines of credit used for 
overnight borrowing only. We had no outstanding balances drawn on the unsecured lines of credit at December 31, 2023 or 2022. 

49 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
Our advances from the FHLB were $23.5 million at December 31, 2023, a decrease of $363.5 million from FHLB advances 
of $387.0 million at December 31, 2022. FHLB advances are used to fund increased loan and investment activity that is not 
funded by deposits or other borrowings. Based on original maturities, at December 31, 2023, all of our $23.5 million of FHLB 
advances were long-term, compared to $333.5 million short-term and $53.5 million long-term FHLB advances at December 31, 
2022.  We  utilized  federal  funds  purchased  during  2023  and  2022  although  none  were  outstanding  at  year-end. We 
had $8.6 million of securities sold under agreements to repurchase at December 31, 2023 compared to none at December 31, 
2022. The carrying value of the subordinated debt was $44.3 million and $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 
2022,  respectively. Junior  subordinated  debt  of $8.6  million  and $8.5  million at  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  respectively, 
represents  the  junior  subordinated  debentures  that  we  assumed  in  connection  with  our  acquisitions  of  Cheaha  in  2021, BOJ 
Bancshares, Inc. in 2017 (“BOJ”), and First Community Bank in 2013.  

On  March  12,  2023,  the  Federal  Reserve  established  the  BTFP.  The BTFP is  a  one-year  program  which  provides  additional 
liquidity through borrowings for a term of up to one year secured by the pledging of certain qualifying securities and other assets 
valued at par. Beginning in the second quarter, we utilized the BTFP to secure fixed rate funding for a one-year term and reduce 
short-term FHLB advances, which are priced daily. We utilized this source of funding due to its lower rate and the ability to 
prepay the obligations without penalty. The rates on the borrowings under the BTFP are fixed for one year from the day each 
borrowing is made. During the fourth quarter of 2023 and again in the first quarter of 2024, we refinanced all of our borrowings 
under  the  BTFP  with  new  loans  under  the  BTFP  with  a  one-year  term  due  to  more  favorable  rates. At December  31,  2023, 
outstanding borrowings under the BTFP were $212.5 million with a weighted average rate of 4.83%. 

Typically, the main source of our short-term borrowings are advances from the FHLB; however, during 2023, our primary source 
of short-term borrowings were borrowings under the BTFP due to more favorable rates. The rate charged for advances from the 
FHLB is directly tied to the Federal Reserve’s federal funds target rate. As previously discussed, the Federal Reserve raised the 
federal funds target rate multiple times in 2022 and 2023. As of December 31, 2023, the federal funds target rate was 5.25% to 
5.50%. 

The average balances and cost of short-term borrowings for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 are summarized 
in the table below (dollars in thousands). 

Average Balances 
December 31, 
     2022 

     2021 

   2023 

     Cost of Short-term Borrowings    
December 31, 
      2022 

      2021 

     2023 

Federal funds purchased, short-term FHLB 

advances and other short-term borrowings 

Borrowings under BTFP 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase 

Total short-term borrowings 

  $ 124,191    $ 132,703     $
—       
     131,952      
1,489       
4,587      
  $ 260,730    $ 134,192     $

3,242      
—      
6,081      
9,323      

4.93%    
5.09       
0.13       
4.93%    

3.08%    
—       
0.15       
3.05%    

0.20%
—  
0.21  
0.20%

2032  Notes. On April 6, 2022, we  entered  into  a  Subordinated Note  Purchase  Agreement with  certain  institutional  accredited 
investors and qualified institutional buyers (the “Purchasers”) under which we issued $20.0 million in aggregate principal amount 
of our 2032 Notes to the Purchasers at a price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the 2032 Notes. The 2032 
Notes  were  issued  under  an  indenture,  dated  April  6,  2022  (the  “Indenture”),  by  and  among  the  Company  and  UMB  Bank, 
National Association, as trustee. 

The 2032 Notes have a stated maturity date of April 15, 2032 and will bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.125% per year from and 
including April 6, 2022 to but excluding April 15, 2027 or earlier redemption date. From April 15, 2027 to but excluding the 
stated maturity date or earlier redemption date, the 2032 Notes will bear interest a floating rate equal to the then current three-
month term secured overnight financing rate (“SOFR”), plus 277 basis points. As provided in the 2032 Notes, the interest rate on 
the  2032  Notes  during  the  applicable  floating  rate  period may be  determined  based  on  a  rate  other  than three-month  term 
SOFR. The 2032 Notes may be redeemed, in whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2027 or, in whole but not in part, under certain 
other limited circumstances set forth in the Indenture. Any redemption we made would be at a redemption price equal to 100% 
of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.  

Principal and interest on the 2032 Notes are subject to acceleration only in limited circumstances in the case of certain bankruptcy 
and insolvency-related events. The 2032 Notes are the unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in 
right of payment to our current and future senior indebtedness and to our obligations to our general creditors. The 2032 Notes are 
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes.  

50 

  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
We used the majority of the net proceeds to redeem our 2027 Notes in June 2022, and utilized the remaining proceeds for share 
repurchases and for general corporate purposes. 

2029 Notes. On November 12, 2019, the Company issued $25.0 million in aggregate principal amount of its 5.125% Fixed-to-
Floating Rate Subordinated 2029 Notes due 2029 (“2029 Notes”) at 100% of their face amount in a private placement to certain 
institutional and other accredited investors. The 2029 Notes have a maturity date of December 30, 2029. From and including the 
date of issuance to, but excluding December 30, 2024, the 2029 Notes will bear interest at an initial fixed rate of 5.125% per 
annum, payable semi-annually in arrears. From and including December 30, 2024 and thereafter, the 2029 Notes will bear interest 
at a floating rate equal to the then-current three-month LIBOR as calculated on each applicable date of determination, or an 
alternative rate determined in accordance with the terms of the 2029 Notes if the three-month LIBOR cannot be determined, plus 
3.490%, payable quarterly in arrears. 

The Company may redeem the 2029 Notes, in whole or in part, on or after December 30, 2024 or, in whole but not in part, under 
certain limited circumstances set forth in the 2029 Notes. Any redemption by the Company would be at a redemption price equal 
to 100% of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. 

Principal and interest on the 2029 Notes are not subject to acceleration, except upon certain bankruptcy-related events. The 2029 
Notes are unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in right of payment to the Company’s current and 
future  senior  indebtedness  and  to  the  Company’s  obligations  to  its  general  creditors.  The  2029  Notes  are  obligations  of  the 
Company only and are not obligations of, and are not guaranteed by, any of the Company’s subsidiaries. The 2029 Notes are 
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes. 

2027 Notes. On March 24, 2017, the Company issued $18.6 million in aggregate principal amount of its 2027 Notes due March 
20, 2027 at 100% of the aggregate principal amount. 

From and including the date of issuance, but excluding March 30, 2022, the 2027 Notes bore interest at an initial fixed rate of 
6.00% per annum, payable semi-annually. From and including March 30, 2022 and thereafter, the 2027 Notes bore interest at a 
floating  rate  equal  to  the  then-current  three-month  LIBOR  (but  not  less  than  zero)  as  calculated  on  each  applicable  date  of 
determination, plus 3.945%, payable quarterly. 

The Company could, beginning with the interest payment date of March 30, 2022, and on any interest payment date thereafter, 
redeem the 2027 Notes, in whole or in part, at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 Notes to be 
redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to but excluding the date of redemption. The 2027 Notes were intended to qualify as 
Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes. 

In June 2022, we redeemed the 2027 Notes in full in accordance with their terms at a redemption price equal to 100% of the 
outstanding  principal  balance  plus  accrued  and  unpaid  interest  up  to  but  excluding  the  June  30,  2022  redemption  date 
(“Redemption Date”). The aggregate redemption price, excluding accrued interest, totaled $18.6 million. Interest on the 2027 
Notes no longer accrued on or after the Redemption Date. 

Stockholders’ Equity 

Stockholders’ equity was $226.8 million at December 31, 2023, an increase of $11.0 million, or 5.1%, compared to December 
31,  2022.  The  increase  in  stockholders’  equity is primarily  attributable  to net  income  for  fiscal  year 2023 and  a decrease  in 
accumulated other comprehensive loss due to an increase in the fair value of the Bank’s AFS securities portfolio, partially offset 
by the cumulative effect adjustment as a result of the adoption of ASU 2016-13, reflected in retained earnings. 

51 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Results of Operations 

Performance Summary 

2023 vs. 2022. For the year ended December 31, 2023, net income was $16.7 million, or $1.69 per basic and diluted common 
share, compared to net income of $35.7 million, or $3.54 per basic common share and $3.50 per diluted common share, for the 
year ended December 31, 2022. The primary drivers of the decrease in net income are a $15.3 million decrease in net interest 
income and an $11.8 million decrease in noninterest income, partially offset by a $2.0 million negative provision for credit losses 
in 2023 compared to a provision for credit losses of $2.9 million in 2022. The decrease in net interest income was a result of a 
$43.9 million increase in interest expense partially offset by a $28.6 million increase in interest income, as the Bank experienced 
margin compression due to rising market interest rates. The decrease in noninterest income is mainly attributable to $8.1 million 
of swap termination fees and $1.4 million of income from insurance proceeds recorded during the year ended December 31, 2022 
and the loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $1.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily resulting 
from the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3 million 
for the year ended December 31, 2022. The negative provision for credit losses of $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 
2023 was primarily due to net recoveries of $2.3 million in 2023 primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship that 
became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. Return on average assets decreased to 0.60% for the 
year ended December 31, 2023 from 1.37% for the year ended December 31, 2022. Return on average equity was 7.63% for the 
year ended December 31, 2023 compared to 15.63% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in both return on 
average assets and return on average equity is mainly attributable to the $19.0 million decrease in net income. 

2022 vs. 2021. For the year ended December 31, 2022, net income was $35.7 million, or $3.54 per basic common share and 
$3.50 per diluted common share, compared to net income of $8.0 million, or $0.77 per basic common share and $0.76 per diluted 
common share, for the year ended December 31, 2021. The primary driver of the increase in net income is related to a decrease 
in provision for loan losses due to the $21.6 million impairment charge recorded during the third quarter of 2021 as a result of 
Hurricane Ida. As shown on the consolidated statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2022, a provision for loan 
losses of $2.9 million was recorded, compared to a provision for loan losses of $22.9 million for the year ended December 31, 
2021. We had record annual net income in 2022 primarily as a result of increases in interest income and noninterest income as 
well as a decrease in noninterest expense compared to 2021. Return on average assets increased to 1.37% for the year ended 
December 31, 2022 from 0.31% for the year ended December 31, 2021. Return on average equity was 15.63% for the year ended 
December 31, 2022 compared to 3.22% for the year ended December 31, 2021. The increase in both return on average assets and 
return on average equity is mainly attributable to the $27.7 million increase in net income. 

Net Interest Income and Net Interest Margin 

Net interest income, our principal source of earnings, is the difference between the interest income generated by earning assets 
and the total interest cost of the deposits and borrowings obtained to fund those assets. Factors affecting the level of net interest 
income include the volume of earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, yields earned on loans and investments and rates 
paid on deposits and other borrowings, the level of nonperforming loans, the amount of noninterest-bearing liabilities supporting 
earning assets, and the interest rate environment. Net interest margin is the ratio of net interest income to average interest-earning 
assets. 

The primary factors affecting net interest margin are changes in interest rates, competition, and the shape of the interest rate yield 
curve. The Federal Reserve Board sets various benchmark rates, including the federal funds rate, and thereby influences the 
general market rates of interest, including the deposit and loan rates offered by financial institutions. On March 3, 2020, the 
Federal Reserve lowered the federal funds target rate to 1.00% to 1.25%, which the Federal Reserve stated was in response to 
the  evolving  risks  to  economic  activity  posed  by  the  coronavirus.  In  a  measure  aimed  at  lessening  the  economic  impact  of 
COVID-19, the Federal Reserve reduced the federal funds target rate to 0% to 0.25% on March 16, 2020, where it remained until 
March 2022 when the Federal Reserve began increasing the federal funds target rate a total of seven times during 2022 and four 
times during 2023 to 5.25% to 5.50% as discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Rising Inflation 
and Interest Rates. 

2023 vs. 2022. Net interest income decreased 17.0% to $74.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $89.8 million 
for the same period in 2022. Net interest margin was 2.83% for the year ended December 31, 2023, a decrease of 84 basis points 
from 3.67% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in net interest income resulted primarily from an increase in 
the rates paid on interest-bearing deposits and short-term borrowings partially offset primarily by an increase in the yield earned 
on loans. Average time deposits increased $272.2 million primarily due to organic growth and customer funds migrating from 
other deposit categories due to higher rates offered, which along with higher rates paid, resulted in a $20.6 million increase in 
interest expense compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. Average short-term borrowings increased $126.5 million, as 
we utilized advances from the FHLB and borrowings under the BTFP to fund loan growth and investment activity, which along 

52 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
with  higher  rates  paid, resulted  in  an $8.8  million  increase  in  interest  expense  compared  to  the  year  ended December  31, 
2022. Average interest-bearing demand deposits decreased $211.6 million but increases in rates led to a $6.5 million increase in 
interest expense compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. Average brokered time deposits were $163.9 million during 
the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to $0.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2022, which along with higher 
rates paid added $8.2 million to interest expense. Average noninterest-bearing deposits decreased $111.1 million. Average loans 
increased $186.0  million  primarily  due  to  organic  growth  and  the  purchase  of  commercial  and  industrial  revolving  lines  of 
credit which, in addition to higher loan yields, resulted in a $24.5 million increase in interest income compared to the year ended 
December 31, 2022. Our yield on interest-earning assets increased as did our rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities primarily as 
a result of the overall increase in prevailing interest rates. 

We experienced  margin  pressure  beginning  late  in  2022,  which  continued  in  2023.  We  raised  rates  offered  on  deposits  and 
incurred higher costs on our borrowings, compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. We may experience additional pressure 
on our net interest margin during 2024 if our cost of funds increases faster than the yield on our interest-earning assets. 

Interest income was $133.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to $104.6 million for the same period in 
2022. Loan interest income made up substantially all of our interest income for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, 
although interest on investment securities contributed 9.8% of interest income for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022. 
Interest  on  our  commercial  real  estate  loans,  commercial  and  industrial  loans,  and  1-4  family  residential  real  estate  loans 
constituted the three largest components of our loan interest income for both of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022 at 
84% total interest income on loans. The overall yield on interest-earning assets increased 78 basis points to 5.06% for the year 
ended December 31, 2023 compared to 4.28% for the same period in 2022. The loan portfolio yielded 5.55% for the year ended 
December 31, 2023 compared to 4.82% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in yield on our loan portfolio was 
driven primarily by higher yields on commercial real estate loans and commercial and industrial loans. In addition, the yield on 
the investment portfolio was 2.78% for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to 2.23% for the year ended December 31, 
2022. 

Interest  expense  was $58.7  million  for  the year  ended December 31,  2023,  an  increase of $43.9 million  compared  to  interest 
expense of $14.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in interest expense is primarily attributable to the 
increase in the rates paid for interest-bearing liabilities, primarily interest-bearing deposits, and to a lesser extent the increase in 
the volume of interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022. For the year 
ended December 31, 2023, the cost of interest-bearing deposits increased 207 basis points to 2.49% and the cost of short-term 
borrowings increased 188  basis  points  to 4.93%  primarily  due  to  increases  in  the  federal  funds  target  rate. As  previously 
discussed, the federal funds target rate increased from 0% to 0.25% to 4.25% to 4.50% during 2022 and to 5.25% to 5.50% during 
2023, which affects the rate the Company pays for deposits, immediately available overnight funds, borrowings under the BTFP, 
and  long-term  borrowings. For  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023, the  cost  of  interest-bearing  liabilities increased  205 basis 
points to 2.89% compared to the same period in 2022.  

2022 vs. 2021. For a detailed discussion of our net interest income and net interest margin performance for 2022 compared to 
2021, see our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis 
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Performance Summary and – Net Interest Income 
and Net Interest Margin –2022 vs. 2021, and – Volume/Rate Analysis. 

53 

  
  
  
  
 
 
Average Balances and Yields. The following table sets forth average balance sheet data, including all major categories of interest-
earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, together with the interest earned or paid and the average yield or rate paid on each 
such category as of and for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. Averages presented below are daily averages 
(dollars in thousands). 

2023 

     Interest        

As of and for the year ended December 31, 
2022 

     Interest        

2021 

     Interest        

   Average       Income/       Yield/       Average       Income/       Yield/       Average       Income/       Yield/   
   Balance      Expense(1)      Rate(1)       Balance      Expense(1)     Rate(1)       Balance      Expense(1)     Rate(1)   

  $2,123,234    $  117,892       5.55%  $1,937,255    $  93,373       4.82%  $1,902,070    $  90,230        4.74%

     447,442      
22,051      

12,372       2.76        442,767      
18,746      

693       3.14       

9,796       2.21        275,963      
20,259      

482       2.57       

3,948        1.43  
552        2.73  

Assets 
Interest-earning assets: 
Loans 
Securities: 
Taxable 
Tax-exempt 

Interest-earning balances with 

banks 

38,561      

2,244       5.82       

45,542      

918       2.02        176,349      

812        0.46  

Total interest-earning 

assets 
Cash and due from banks 
Intangible assets 
Other assets 
Allowance for credit losses 

Total assets 
Liabilities and stockholders’ 

    2,631,288       133,201       5.06       2,444,310       104,569       4.28       2,374,641      
39,262      
41,299      
         138,096      
(20,704)     
      $2,572,594      

34,327      
43,588      
         103,711      
(22,093)     
      $2,603,843      

29,142      
42,695      
86,712      
(30,242)     
  $2,759,595      

95,542        4.02  

equity 

Interest-bearing liabilities: 
Deposits: 

Interest-bearing demand 

deposits 

Brokered demand deposits      
Savings deposits 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 

  $ 688,786    $ 
—      
     134,817      
     163,873      
     699,648      

8,941       1.30%  $ 900,405    $ 
—       —       
1,773      
534       0.40        173,460      
8,224       5.02       
82      
24,373       3.48        427,416      

2,411       0.27%  $ 858,660    $ 
7       0.42       
77,432      
79       0.05        168,194      
—      
4       4.80       
3,749       0.88        508,954      

2,398        0.28%
715        0.92  
247        0.15  
—        —  
4,127        0.81  

Total interest-bearing 

deposits 
Short-term borrowings(2) 
Long-term debt 

Total interest-bearing 

liabilities 
Noninterest-bearing demand 

    1,687,124      
     260,730      
82,844      

42,072       2.49       1,503,136      
12,845       4.93        134,192      
3,764       4.54        127,288      

6,250       0.42       1,613,240      
4,093       3.05       
9,323      
4,441       3.49        129,318      

7,487        0.46  
19        0.20  
4,222        3.26  

    2,030,698      

58,681       2.89       1,764,616      

14,784       0.84       1,751,881      

11,728        0.67  

deposits 

Other liabilities 
Stockholders’ equity 

     489,175      
21,220      
     218,502      

         600,286      
10,425      
         228,516      

         553,083      
18,852      
         248,778      

Total liabilities and 
stockholders’ 
equity 
Net interest 

  $2,759,595      

      $2,603,843      

      $2,572,594      

income/net 
interest margin     

     $  74,520       2.83%    

     $  89,785       3.67%    

     $  83,814        3.53%

(1) 

(2) 

Interest income and net interest margin are expressed as a percentage of average interest-earning assets outstanding for the indicated
periods. Interest expense is expressed as a percentage of average interest-bearing liabilities for the indicated periods. 
For additional information, see Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings. 

54 

 
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
  
    
  
  
       
  
  
       
  
  
  
  
  
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
    
    
    
       
        
       
        
        
   
    
       
        
       
        
        
   
    
       
       
        
   
    
       
        
       
        
        
   
       
       
        
   
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
      
         
        
         
         
        
         
         
        
  
    
       
       
        
   
    
       
        
       
        
        
   
       
       
        
   
       
       
        
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
Nonaccrual loans were included in the computation of average loan balances but carry a zero yield. The yields include the effect 
of loan fees of $2.0 million, $3.6 million and $3.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively, 
and discounts and premiums that are amortized or accreted to interest income or expense. 

Volume/Rate Analysis. The following tables set forth a summary of the changes in interest earned and interest paid resulting from 
changes in volume and rates for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to the year ended December 31, 2022 and the year 
ended December 31, 2022 compared to the year ended December 31, 2021 (dollars in thousands). 

Year ended December 31, 2023 vs. 
Year ended December 31, 2022 
Rate 

Net(1) 

Volume 

Interest income: 
Loans 
Securities: 
Taxable 
Tax-exempt 

Interest-earning balances with banks 
Total interest-earning assets 

Interest expense: 
Interest-bearing demand deposits 
Brokered demand deposits 
Savings deposits 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 
Short-term borrowings 
Long-term debt 

Total interest-bearing liabilities 
Change in net interest income 

Interest income: 
Loans 
Securities: 
Taxable 
Tax-exempt 

Interest-earning balances with banks 
Total interest-earning assets 

Interest expense: 
Interest-bearing demand deposits 
Brokered demand deposits 
Savings deposits 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 
Short-term borrowings 
Long-term debt 

Total interest-bearing liabilities 
Change in net interest income 

  $ 

8,964    $ 

15,555    $ 

24,519  

103      
85      
(140)     
9,012      

(567)     
(7)     
(18)     
7,870      
2,388      
3,860      
(1,551)     
11,975      
(2,963)   $ 

2,473      
126      
1,466      
19,620      

7,097      
—      
473      
350      
18,236      
4,892      
874      
31,922      
(12,302)   $ 

2,576  
211  
1,326  
28,632  

6,530  
(7) 
455  
8,220  
20,624  
8,752  
(677) 
43,897  
(15,265) 

  $ 

Year ended December 31, 2022 vs. 
Year ended December 31, 2021 
Rate 

Net(1) 

Volume 

  $ 

1,669    $ 

1,474    $ 

3,143  

2,386      
(41)     
(602)     
3,412      

117      
(699)     
8      
4      
(665)     
255      
(66)     
(1,046)     
4,458    $ 

3,462      
(29)     
708      
5,615      

(104)     
(9)     
(176)     
—      
287      
3,819      
285      
4,102      
1,513    $ 

5,848  
(70) 
106  
9,027  

13  
(708) 
(168) 
4  
(378) 
4,074  
219  
3,056  
5,971  

  $ 

  (1)  Changes in interest due to both volume and rate have been allocated entirely to rate. 

55 

   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
 
 
Noninterest Income 

Noninterest  income  includes,  among  other  things,  service  charges  on  deposit  accounts,  gains  and  losses  on  call  or  sale  of 
investment securities, gains and losses on sales or dispositions of fixed assets and other real estate owned, swap termination fee 
income, gain on sale of loans, servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans, interchange fees, income from bank owned life 
insurance, changes in the fair value of equity securities, and income from insurance proceeds. We expect to continue to develop 
new products that generate noninterest income, and enhance our existing products, in order to diversify our revenue sources. 

2023 vs.  2022.  Total  noninterest  income decreased $11.8 million,  or 64.4%,  to $6.5 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31, 
2023 compared to $18.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease is mainly attributable to $8.1 million of 
swap  termination  fees  and  $1.4  million  of  income  from insurance  proceeds  recorded  during  the  year  ended  December  31, 
2022 and  the loss  on  sale  or  disposition  of  fixed  assets  of  $1.3  million  during  the  year ended December  31,  2023,  primarily 
resulting from the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3 
million for the year ended December 31, 2022. 

Service charges on deposit accounts include maintenance fees on accounts, account enhancement charges for additional deposit 
account  features,  per  item  charges,  overdraft  fees,  and  treasury  management  charges.  Service  charges  on  deposit  accounts 
were $3.1 million for both of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022. 

There was a $0.3 million loss on call or sale of investment securities for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to a de 
minimis gain for the year ended December 31, 2022. We sold approximately $15.0 million of securities during the year ended 
December 31, 2023 compared to no sales and de minimis calls during the year ended December 31, 2022.  

Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets for the year ended December 31, 2023 increased to $1.3 million from $0.3 million for 
the year ended December 31, 2022. During 2023, a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $1.3 million was recorded as a 
result of the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, the disposition of ATMs, and a reclassification of bank premises and 
equipment to other real estate owned. During 2022, a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.5 million was recorded as 
a result of the Bank closing two branches in Louisiana, which was partially offset by a gain on sale or disposition of fixed assets 
as a result of the sale of three tracts of land that were being held for future branch locations. 

There was a $0.1 million loss on sale of other real estate owned for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to a de minimis 
gain for the year ended December 31, 2022. We sold approximately $1.5 million of other real estate owned during the year ended 
December 31, 2023 compared to $5.8 million of sales during the year ended December 31, 2022.  

No swap termination fee income was recorded during the year ended December 31, 2023. Swap termination fee income of $8.1 
million was recorded for the year ended December 31, 2022 when we voluntarily terminated a number of our interest rate swap 
agreements during the first and second quarters of 2022 in response to market conditions. 

There was a $0.1 million gain on sale of loans for the year ended December 31, 2023 as a result of the sale of the Alice and 
Victoria, Texas branches, compared to no gain or loss for the year ended December 31, 2022.  

Servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans decreased $60,000, or 81.1%, to $14,000 for the year ended December 31, 2023. 
This decrease is a result of the Bank exiting the indirect auto loan origination business at the end of 2015. Since the Bank did not 
originate auto loans for sale during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, the servicing portfolio, which experienced 
regularly scheduled paydowns, was not replaced with new loans. We expect servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans to 
decrease over time until all serviced loans are paid off. 

Interchange  fees,  which  are  fees  earned  on the  usage of  the  Bank’s  credit  and debit  cards, decreased $0.3 million, or 16.7%, 
to $1.7 million for year ended December 31, 2023 from $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in 
interchange fees can primarily be attributed to the decrease in the volume of debit and credit card transactions. 

Income  from  bank  owned  life  insurance increased $0.1 million  to $1.4 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023 
from $1.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. This increase reflects increased interest earned on the Company’s bank 
owned life insurance policies. 

No  income  from  insurance  proceeds  was  recorded  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023.  Income  from  insurance  proceeds 
totaled $1.4  million  for  the year  ended December  31,  2022. Nontaxable  income related  to  an  insurance  policy  for  the  former 
Chief Financial Officer of the Company and the Bank of $1.4 million was recorded during the fourth quarter of 2022. 

56 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
Other operating income includes, among other things, credit card, ATM and wire fees, derivative fee income, changes in the net 
asset  value  of  other  investments  and  rental  income.  The $0.6 million decrease in  other  operating  income  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2023 is primarily attributable to a $0.5 million decrease in derivative fee income compared to the year ended 
December 31, 2022.  

2022 vs.  2021.  For  a  detailed  discussion  of  our  noninterest  income  for  2022  compared  to  2021,  see Item  7.  Management’s 
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Noninterest Income – 2022 
vs. 2021 in our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022. 

Noninterest Expense 

Noninterest expense includes salaries and employee benefits and other costs associated with the conduct of our operations. Our 
goal is to manage our costs within the framework of our near-term operating strategy of generating consistent, quality earnings. 

2023 vs. 2022. Total noninterest expense was $62.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2023, an increase of $1.8 million, 
or 2.9%,  from $60.9 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2022.  This increase was  primarily  driven  by  the  increases  in 
salaries and employee benefits and other operating expenses, partially offset by a decrease in depreciation and amortization. 

Salaries  and  employee  benefits increased $2.2 million,  or 6.2%,  to $37.1 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023, 
compared  to $35.0 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2022. Included  in  salaries  and  employee  benefits  for  the 
year ended December 31, 2022 is a $2.3 million employee retention credit (“ERC”) recognized as a credit to payroll taxes, which 
decreased salaries and employee benefits reported for 2022. The increase in salaries and employee benefits is mainly attributable 
to  increases  in  health  insurance  claims  and  payroll  taxes,  partially  offset  by  decreases  in  incentive-based  compensation  and 
severance. Salaries and employee benefits for 2022 also included $0.6 million of severance due to the separation agreement with 
the former Chief Financial Officer of the Company and the Bank. Please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting 
Policies – Employee Retention Credit, for additional discussion regarding the ERCs. As of December 31, 2023, we had 320 full-
time and 11 part-time employees, compared to 331 full-time and seven part-time employees as of December 31, 2022.  

Depreciation  and  amortization decreased  $0.7 million,  or 14.8%,  to $3.8 million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023, 
compared to $4.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in depreciation and amortization is primarily 
driven by the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches and the closure of one branch during the first quarter of 2023 and two 
branches during 2022. 

Data processing decreased $0.1 million, or 3.3%, to $3.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $3.6 million for 
the same period in 2022. We did not complete any acquisitions, which typically drive higher data processing expenses, during 
the  years  ended  December  31,  2023  and  2022. We  regularly  review existing  contracts  with  the  goal  of negotiating favorable 
terms  to  offset  the  increased  variable  cost  components  of  our  data  processing  costs,  such  as  new  accounts  and  increased 
transaction volume. 

Occupancy expense increased $0.1 million, or 2.7%, to $3.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $2.9 million for 
the  year  ended  December  31,  2022.  This increase is  primarily  attributable  to  $0.4  million  in  occupancy  expense  recorded 
primarily to terminate remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases, partially 
offset by a decrease in building rent, both as a result of the sale the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches in January 2023. 

Other operating expenses include security, business development, FDIC and OCC assessments, bank shares and property taxes, 
collection and repossession, charitable contributions, repair and maintenance costs, personnel training and development, filing 
fees,  and  other  costs  related  to  the  operation  of  our  business.  Other  operating  expenses increased  $0.3 million,  or 2.5%, 
to $13.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $12.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in 
other operating expenses was primarily due to increases in FDIC assessments, other real estate expense, and bank shares taxes, 
partially offset by a decrease in collection and repossession expenses, the majority of which was related to one impaired loan 
relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida. 

2022 vs.  2021.  For  a  detailed  discussion  of  our  noninterest  expense  for 2022  compared  to  2021,  see Item  7.  Management’s 
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Noninterest Expense – 2022 
vs. 2021 in our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022. 

57 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
 
 
Income Tax Expense 

Income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 was $3.8 million, $8.6 million, and $1.9 million, 
respectively. The effective tax rates for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 were 18.4%, 19.5%, and 19.3%, 
respectively.  For  the years  ended  December 31,  2023  and  2021,  the  effective  tax  rate differs  from  the  statutory rate  of  21% 
primarily due to tax-exempt interest income earned on certain loans and investment securities and income from bank owned life 
insurance. For the year ended December 31, 2022, the effective tax rate differs from the statutory rate of 21% primarily due to 
nontaxable income from insurance proceeds and tax-exempt interest income earned on certain loans and investment securities 
and income from bank owned life insurance. 

Risk Management 

The primary risks associated with our operations are credit, interest rate and liquidity risk. Higher inflation also presents risks. 
Credit, inflation and interest rate risk are discussed below, while liquidity risk is discussed in this section under the heading 
Liquidity and Capital Resources below. 

Credit Risk and the Allowance for Credit Losses 

General. The risk of loss should a borrower default on a loan is inherent in any lending activity. Our portfolio and related credit 
risk are monitored and managed on an ongoing basis by our risk management department, the board of directors’ loan committee 
and the full board of directors. We utilize a ten point risk-rating system, which assigns a risk grade to each borrower based on a 
number of quantitative and qualitative factors associated with a loan transaction. The risk grade categorizes the loan into one of 
five risk categories, based on information about the ability of borrowers to service the debt. The information includes, among 
other  factors,  current  financial  information  about  the  borrower,  historical  payment  experience,  credit  documentation,  public 
information  and  current  economic  trends.  These  categories  assist  management  in  monitoring  our  credit  quality.  The  risk 
categories, which are consistent with the definitions used in guidance promulgated by federal banking regulators are Pass (grades 
1-6), Special Mention (grade 7), Substandard (grade 8), Doubtful (grade 9) and Loss (grade 10). For additional information, see 
Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses – Credit Quality Indicators. 

At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, there were no loans classified as loss, while there were no loans and $0.2 million 
of loans, respectively, classified as doubtful, $12.0 million and $15.0 million, respectively, of loans classified as substandard, 
and $10.8 million  and $12.8 million,  respectively,  of  loans  classified  as  special  mention  as  of  such  dates.  Of  our 
aggregate $22.9 million and $28.0 million doubtful, substandard and special mention loans at December 31, 2023 and December 
31, 2022, respectively, $2.3 million and $4.7 million, respectively, were acquired and marked to fair value at the time of their 
acquisition. 

An independent loan review is conducted annually, whether internally or externally, on at least 40% of commercial loans utilizing 
a risk-based approach designed to maximize the effectiveness of the review. Internal loan review is independent of the loan 
underwriting and approval process. In addition, credit analysts periodically review certain commercial loans to identify negative 
financial trends related to any one borrower, any related groups of borrowers or an industry. All loans not categorized as pass are 
put on an internal watch list, with quarterly reports to the board of directors. In addition, a written status report is maintained by 
our special assets division for all commercial loans categorized as substandard or worse. We use this information in connection 
with our collection efforts. 

If our collection efforts are unsuccessful, collateral securing loans may be repossessed and sold or, for loans secured by real 
estate,  foreclosure  proceedings  initiated.  The  collateral  is  sold  at  public  auction  for  fair  market  value  (based  upon  recent 
appraisals), with fees associated with the foreclosure being deducted from the sales price. The purchase price is applied to the 
outstanding loan balance. If the loan balance is greater than the sales proceeds, the deficient balance is charged-off. 

Allowance  for  Credit  Losses. Effective  January  1,  2023,  we  adopted  ASU  2016-13,  which  uses  the CECL accounting 
methodology  for  the  allowance  for  credit  losses.  Upon  adoption,  we  recorded  a  one-time,  cumulative  effect  adjustment  to 
increase the  allowance  for  credit  losses by  $5.9  million. The  allowance  for  credit  losses  was $30.5 million  at  December  31, 
2023, an increase compared to $24.4 million at December 31, 2022 and $20.9 million at December 31, 2021, respectively. The 
CECL  methodology  requires  that  lifetime  expected  credit  losses be  recorded  at  the  time  the  financial  asset  is  originated  or 
acquired and be adjusted each period through a provision for credit losses for changes in the expected lifetime credit losses. 

58 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
For the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the provision for credit losses on loans was negative $2.0 million, $2.9 
million, and $22.9 million, respectively. The negative provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2023 was 
primarily driven by net recoveries of $2.3 million in the loan portfolio primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship 
that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. The provision for loan losses for the year ended 
December 31, 2022 reflects provisioning related to our organic loan growth. The provision for loan losses for the year ended 
December 31, 2021 includes a $21.6 million impairment charge related to one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida, as 
discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Hurricane Ida. 

Refer  to Note  1. Summary  of  Significant  Accounting  Policies  –  Allowance  for  Credit  Losses  and –  Accounting  Standards 
Adopted  in  2023, for  information  regarding  our  adoption  of  ASU  2016-13. Results  for  reporting  periods  beginning  after 
December  31,  2022  are  presented  in  accordance  with  ASU  2016-13  while  prior  period  amounts  continue  to  be  reported  in 
accordance with previously applicable U.S. GAAP. Refer to “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition 
and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Estimates” for further discussion. 

The following table presents the allocation of the allowance for credit losses by loan category as of the dates indicated (dollars 
in thousands). 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

% of Loans 
in each 
Category 
to Total 
Loans 

% of Loans 
in each 
Category 
to Total 
Loans 

% of Loans 
in each 
Category to 
Total 
Loans 

Allowance 
for Credit 
Losses 

Allowance 
for Credit 
Losses 

Allowance 
for Credit 
Losses 

Mortgage loans on real estate: 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

  $ 

  $ 

2,471      
9,129      
1,124      
2      
10,691      
6,920      
203      
30,540      

8.6%  $ 
18.7       
4.8       
0.4       
42.4       
24.6       
0.5       
100%  $ 

2,555      
3,917      
999      
113      
10,718      
5,743      
319      
24,364      

9.6%  $ 
19.1       
3.9       
0.6       
45.5       
20.7       
0.6       
100%  $ 

2,347      
3,337      
673      
383      
9,354      
4,411      
354      
20,859      

10.9%
19.4  
3.2  
1.1  
47.9  
16.6  
0.9  
100%

The following table presents the amount of the allowance for credit losses allocated to each loan category as a percentage of 
total loans as of the dates indicated. 

Mortgage loans on real estate: 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

0.11%     
0.41       
0.05       
—       
0.49       
0.31       
0.01       
1.38%     

0.12%    
0.18       
0.05       
0.01       
0.51       
0.27       
0.02       
1.16%    

0.12%
0.18  
0.04  
0.02  
0.50  
0.23  
0.02  
1.11%

As discussed above, the balance in the allowance for credit losses is principally influenced by the provision for credit losses and 
by net loan loss experience. Additions to the allowance are charged to the provision for credit losses. Losses are charged to the 
allowance as incurred and recoveries on losses previously charged to the allowance are credited to the allowance at the time 
recovery is collected. 

59 

  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
  
  
    
     
    
     
    
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
      
         
         
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
   
  
 
 
The  table  below  reflects  the  activity  in  the  allowance  for  credit  losses  and  key  ratios for  the  periods  indicated  (dollars  in 
thousands). 

Allowance for credit losses at beginning of period 
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact 
Provision for credit losses on loans(1) 
Net recoveries (charge-offs)(2) 
Allowance for credit losses at end of period 
Total loans - period end 
Nonaccrual loans - period end 

Key Ratios: 

  $ 

  $ 

Year ended December 31, 
2022 

2023 

2021 

24,364     $
5,865       
(1,964)      
2,275       
30,540     $
2,210,619       
5,770       

20,859     $
—       
2,922       
583       
24,364     $
2,104,767       
9,986       

20,363  
—  
22,885  
(22,389) 
20,859  
1,872,012  
29,495  

Allowance for credit losses to total loans - period end 
Allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans - period end 
Nonaccrual loans to total loans - period end 

1.38%     
529%     
0.26%     

1.16%    
244%    
0.47%    

1.11%
71%
1.58%

(1)  For  the  year  ended December  31,  2023,  the negative provision  for  credit  losses  of $2.0 million on  the  consolidated 
statement of income includes a negative provision for loan losses of $2.0 million and a negative provision for unfunded 
loan commitments of $36,000. 

(2)  We recognized net recoveries of $2.4 million and net charge-offs of $21.6 million in the loan portfolio during the years
ended December 31, 2023 and 2021, respectively, attributable to one loan relationship that became impaired in the
third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. 

The  allowance  for  credit  losses  to  total  loans increased to 1.38% at December 31, 2023  compared  to 1.16% at December 31, 
2022  while  the  allowance  for  credit  losses  to  nonaccrual  loans  ratio increased to 529% at  December  31,  2023  from 244% at 
December 31, 2022. The increase in the allowance for credit losses to total loans at December 31, 2023 compared to December 
31, 2022 is primarily due to the one-time, cumulative effect adjustment to increase the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million 
recorded upon adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023. The increase in the allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans 
and the decrease in nonaccrual loans to total loans are due to the decrease in nonaccrual loans primarily due to large paydowns 
on one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida. Nonaccrual loans were $5.8 million, or 0.26% of total loans, at December 
31, 2023, a decrease of $4.2 million compared to $10.0 million, or 0.47% of total loans, at December 31, 2022. Many of the loans 
comprising the total relationship were placed on nonaccrual following the impairment in the third quarter of 2021. 

The following table presents the allocation of net (charge offs) recoveries by loan category for the periods indicated (dollars in 
thousands). 

2023 

Year ended December 31, 
2022 

2021 

Net 
(Charge-
offs) 
Recoveries    

Average 
balance     

Ratio of 
Net 
Charge-
offs to 
Average 
Loans 

Net 
(Charge-
offs) 
Recoveries     

Average 
balance      

Ratio of 
Net 
Charge-
offs to 
Average 
Loans 

Net 
(Charge-
offs) 
Recoveries     

Average 
balance      

Ratio of 
Net 
Charge-
offs to 
Average 
Loans 

Mortgage loans on 

real estate: 
Construction and 
development 

1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real 

estate 
Commercial and 
industrial 

Consumer 
Total 

  $ 

75    $ 200,691     
(24)      410,320     
86,668     
—      
9,206     
—      

(0.04)%  $ 
0.01  
—  
—  

48    $ 210,160      
103       380,481      
56,665      
—      
15,837      
13      

(0.02 )%  $ 
(0.03 ) 
—   
(0.08 ) 

(247)   $ 211,230      
(156)      354,748      
60,327      
23,128      

—      
(13)     

0.12%
0.04  
—  
0.06  

2,219       961,617     

(0.23) 

33       901,422      

(0.00 ) 

(10,274)      869,098      

1.18  

171       442,299     
(166)     
12,433     
2,275    $2,123,234     

(0.04) 
1.34  
(0.11)%  $ 

535       357,837      
(149)     
14,853      
583    $1,937,255      

(0.15 ) 
1.00   
(0.03 )%  $ 

(11,641)      362,483      
21,056      
(22,389)   $1,902,070      

(58)     

3.21  
0.28  
1.18%

  $ 

60 

  
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
         
         
  
      
         
         
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
        
       
  
       
        
        
  
       
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
Charge-offs  reflect  the  realization  of  losses  in  the  portfolio  that  were  recognized previously through the  provision  for  credit 
losses. Net charge-offs include recoveries of amounts previously charged off. Net recoveries for the years ended December 31, 
2023 and 2022 were $2.3 million and $0.6 million, respectively, equal to 0.11% and 0.03% of the average loan balance for the 
respective  periods.  Net  charge-offs  for  the  year ended December  31,  2021 were $22.4 million,  or 1.18%, of  the  average  loan 
balance. Net recoveries for the year ended December 31, 2023 were primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship 
that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. Net recoveries for the year ended December 31, 
2022 were primarily driven by one $0.9 million recovery on a commercial and industrial loan relationship. Net charge-offs for 
the year ended December 31, 2021 were primarily due to charge-offs of $21.6 million in the third quarter of 2021 due to the 
impairment charge related to one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida. Commercial and industrial loans and commercial 
real estate loans were the categories affected. 

Management believes the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2023 is sufficient to provide adequate protection against 
losses in our loan portfolio. However, there can be no assurance that this allowance will prove to be adequate over time to cover 
ultimate losses in connection with our loans. This allowance may prove to be inadequate due to higher inflation and interest rates 
than  anticipated,  other  unanticipated  adverse  changes  in  the  economy,  unanticipated  effects  of  the  current  geopolitical  and 
domestic political conflicts, a resurgence of COVID-19, or discrete events adversely affecting specific customers or industries. 
Our  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition  could  be  materially  adversely  affected  to  the  extent  that  the  allowance  is 
insufficient to cover such changes or events.  

Nonperforming assets. Nonperforming assets consist of nonperforming loans and other real estate owned. Nonperforming loans 
are  those  on  which  the  accrual  of  interest  has  stopped  or  loans  which  are  contractually  90  days  past  due  on  which  interest 
continues to accrue. Loans are ordinarily placed on nonaccrual when a loan is specifically determined to be impaired or when 
principal and interest is delinquent for 90 days or more. Additionally, management may elect to continue the accrual when the 
estimated net available value of collateral is sufficient to cover the principal balance and accrued interest. It is our policy to 
discontinue  the  accrual of  interest  income on  any  loan for  which  we have  reasonable doubt  as  to  the  payment  of  interest or 
principal. A loan may be returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought 
current and future principal and interest amounts contractually due are reasonably assured, which is typically evidenced by a 
sustained period of repayment performance by the borrower. 

Restructured loans. Effective January 1, 2023, we adopted ASU 2022-02, “Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326): 
Troubled  Debt  Restructurings  and  Vintage  Disclosures”,  which  eliminated  the  accounting  guidance  for  troubled  debt 
restructurings (“TDRs”). Prior to our adoption of ASU 2022-02, we accounted for a modification to the contractual terms of a 
loan that resulted in granting a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties as a TDR. 

Occasionally, we modify loans to borrowers in financial distress by providing certain concessions, such as principal forgiveness, 
term  extension,  an  other-than-insignificant  payment  delay,  an  interest  rate  reduction,  or  a  combination  of  such  concessions. 
When principal forgiveness is provided, the amount of forgiveness is charged-off against the allowance for credit losses. Upon 
our determination that a modified loan (or portion of a loan) has subsequently been deemed uncollectible, the loan (or portion of 
the loan) is written off. 

Other Real Estate Owned. Other real estate owned consists of properties acquired through foreclosure or acceptance of a deed in 
lieu  of  foreclosure,  as  well  as  any  properties  owned  by  the  Company  that  are  not  intended  to  be  used  to  carry  out  its 
operations. These  properties  are initially  recorded  at  the  lower  of  cost or  fair  market  value  based  on  appraisal  at  the  time  of 
foreclosure, less estimated selling cost. Losses arising at the time of foreclosure of properties are charged to the allowance for 
credit  losses.  For  the  year  ended December  31,  2023, additions  to  other  real  estate  owned  were $3.9 million,  which  were 
primarily driven by transfers of properties related to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a 
result  of  Hurricane  Ida.  During  the year  ended December  31,  2023,  we  closed  one  branch  and  one  stand-alone  ATM  and 
transferred the associated land and buildings from bank premises and equipment to other real estate owned, as we did not intend 
to use the properties for banking operations. Other real estate owned with a cost basis of $1.5 million and $5.8 million was sold 
during  the  years  ended  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  respectively,  resulting  in  a  net loss of $0.1 million  and  a 
net gain of $9,000 for the respective periods, compared to a cost basis of $0.9 million and a net loss of $5,000 for the year ended 
December 31, 2021. 

61 

   
  
  
  
   
  
 
 
The following table provides details of our other real estate owned as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands). 

1-4 Family 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 

Total other real estate owned 

December 31, 
2023 

December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

  $ 

—    $ 
4,323      
115      
4,438    $ 

682  
—  
—  
682  

Changes in our other real estate owned are summarized in the table below for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands). 

Balance, beginning of period 
Additions 
Transfers from bank premises and equipment 
Sales of other real estate owned 
Balance, end of period 

   Year ended 
December 31, 
2023 

     Year ended 
December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

  $ 

682    $ 
3,930      
1,425      
(1,599)     
4,438    $ 

2,653  
3,327  
525  
(5,823) 
682  

Please refer to Note 4. Other Real Estate Owned, for additional information. 

Impact of Inflation. Inflation reached a near 40-year high in late 2021 primarily due to effects of the COVID-19 pandemic, and 
continued rising through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation has generally declined; however, it has remained above 
the Federal Reserve’s target inflation rate of two percent through March 7, 2024. In response to higher inflation, the Federal 
Reserve increased the federal funds target rate during 2022 and 2023 as discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year 
Comparability – Rising Inflation and Interest Rates, which generally increased the amount we earn on our interest-earning assets 
but also increased the amount we pay on our interest-bearing liabilities as discussed throughout this report. We believe that higher 
rates  resulting  from  inflation  and  related  factors  led  to  constrained  loan  demand  during  2023.  When  the  rate  of  inflation 
accelerates, there is an erosion of consumer and customer purchasing power. Accordingly, if the rate of inflation accelerates in 
the future, this could impact our business by reducing our tolerance for extending credit, and our customer’s desire to obtain 
credit, or causing us to incur additional provisions for credit losses resulting from a possible increased default rate. Inflation and 
related higher rates have led and may continue to lead to lower loan re-financings. Inflation has also increased and may continue 
to increase the costs of goods and services we purchase, including the costs of salaries and benefits. In January 2024, the Federal 
Reserve decided not to change the federal funds target rate. Many economists expect the Federal Reserve to decrease the federal 
funds target rate one or more times during the remainder of 2024. For additional information, see Interest Rate Risk below, and 
Item 1A. Risk Factors – Risks Related to our Business – Increasing and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest 
expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase significantly in 2023; further increases in interest rates could continue to 
have  an  adverse  effect  on  our  profitability  and  – Inflation  and  rising  prices  may  continue  to  adversely  affect  our  results  of 
operations and financial condition. 

Interest Rate Risk 

Market risk is the risk of loss from adverse changes in market prices and rates. Since the majority of our assets and liabilities are 
monetary in nature, our market risk arises primarily from interest rate risk inherent in our lending and deposit activities. A sudden 
and substantial change in interest rates may adversely impact our earnings and profitability because the interest rates borne by 
assets  and  liabilities  do  not  change  at  the  same  speed,  to  the  same  extent,  or  on  the  same  basis.  Accordingly,  our  ability  to 
proactively structure the volume and mix of our assets and liabilities to address anticipated changes in interest rates, as well as 
to react quickly to such fluctuations, can significantly impact our financial results. To that end, management actively monitors 
and manages our interest rate risk exposure. 

The ALCO has been authorized by the board of directors to implement our asset/liability management policy, which establishes 
guidelines with respect to our exposure to interest rate fluctuations, liquidity, loan limits as a percentage of funding sources, 
exposure to correspondent banks and brokers and reliance on non-core deposits. The goal of the policy is to enable us to maximize 
our interest income and maintain our net interest margin without exposing the Bank to excessive interest rate risk, credit risk and 
liquidity  risk.  Within  that  framework,  the  ALCO  monitors  our  interest  rate  sensitivity  and  makes  decisions  relating  to  our 
asset/liability composition. 

62 

  
  
  
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
Net interest income simulation is the Bank’s primary tool for benchmarking near term earnings exposure. Given the ALCO’s 
objective  to  understand  the  potential  risk/volatility  embedded  within  the  current  mix  of  assets  and  liabilities,  standard  rate 
scenario simulations assume total assets remain static (i.e. no growth). The Bank may also use a standard gap report in its interest 
rate risk management process. The primary use for the gap report is to provide supporting detailed information to the ALCO’s 
discussion. 

The Bank has particular concerns with the utility of the gap report as a risk management tool because of difficulties in relating 
gap directly to changes in net interest income. Hence, the income simulation is the key indicator for earnings-at-risk since it 
expressly measures what the gap report attempts to estimate. 

Short term interest rate risk management tactics are decided by the ALCO where risk exposures exist out into the 1 to 2-year 
horizon.  Tactics  are  formulated  and  presented  to  the  ALCO  for  discussion,  modification,  and/or  approval.  Such  tactics  may 
include asset and liability acquisitions of appropriate maturities in the cash market, loan and deposit product/pricing strategy 
modification, and derivatives hedging activities to the extent such activity is authorized by the board of directors. 

Since the impact of rate changes due to mismatched balance sheet positions in the short-term can quickly and materially affect 
the current year’s income statement, they require constant monitoring and management. 

Within the gap position that management directs, we attempt to structure our assets and liabilities to minimize the risk of either 
a rising or falling interest rate environment. We manage our gap position for time horizons of one month, two months, three 
months, four to six months, seven to twelve months, 13-24 months, 25-36 months, 37-60 months and more than 60 months. The 
goal of our asset/liability management is for the Bank to maintain a net interest income at risk in an up or down 100 basis point 
environment at less than (5)%. At December 31, 2023, the Bank was within the policy guidelines for asset/liability management. 

The following table depicts the estimated impact on net interest income of immediate changes in interest rates at the specified 
levels for the periods presented. 

As of December 31, 2023 

Changes in Interest Rates 
(in basis points) 
+300 
+200 
+100 
-100 
-200 
-300 

Estimated 
Increase/Decrease in 
Net Interest Income (1) 
(7.4)% 
(5.4)% 
(2.4)% 
2.8% 
6.8% 
9.7% 

(1)   The percentage change in this column represents the projected net interest income for 12 months on a flat balance sheet

in a stable interest rate environment versus the projected net interest income in the various rate scenarios. 

The  computation  of  the  prospective  effects  of  hypothetical  interest  rate  changes  requires  numerous  assumptions  regarding 
characteristics of new business and the behavior of existing positions. These business assumptions are based upon our experience, 
business plans and published industry experience. Key assumptions include asset prepayment speeds, competitive factors, the 
relative price sensitivity of certain assets and liabilities, and the expected life of non-maturity deposits. However, there are a 
number of factors  that  influence  the  effect of  interest rate  fluctuations  on us which  are  difficult  to measure  and predict.  For 
example,  a  rapid  drop  in  interest  rates  might  cause  our  loans  to  repay  at  a  more  rapid  pace  and  certain  mortgage-related 
investments to prepay more quickly than projected. This could mitigate some of the benefits of falling rates as are expected when 
we are in a negatively-gapped position. Conversely, a rapid rise in rates could give us an opportunity to increase our margins and 
slow the rate of repayment on our mortgage-related loans which would increase our returns, but can also increase our costs of 
interest-bearing liabilities faster than we expect and faster than an increase in our yield on interest-earning assets which would 
decrease our returns. As a result, because these assumptions are inherently uncertain, actual results will differ from simulated 
results. 

63 

  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources 

Liquidity. Liquidity is a measure of the ability to fund loan commitments and meet deposit maturities and withdrawals in a timely 
and cost-effective way. Cash flow requirements can be met by generating net income, attracting new deposits, converting assets 
to cash or borrowing funds. While maturities and scheduled amortization of loans and securities are predictable sources of funds, 
deposit outflows, loan prepayments, and borrowings are greatly influenced by general interest rates, economic conditions, and 
the competitive environment in which we operate. To minimize funding risks, we closely monitor our liquidity position through 
periodic reviews of maturity profiles, yield and rate behaviors, and loan and deposit forecasts. Excess short-term liquidity is 
usually invested in overnight federal funds sold. 

Our core deposits, which are deposits excluding time deposits greater than $250,000 and deposits of municipalities and other 
political  entities,  are  our  most  stable  source  of  liquidity  to  meet  our  cash  flow  needs  due  to  the  nature  of  the  long-term 
relationships generally established with our customers. Maintaining the ability to acquire these funds as needed in a variety of 
markets, and within ALCO compliance targets, is essential to ensuring our liquidity. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, 64% and 
70% of our total assets, respectively, were funded by core deposits. 

Our investment portfolio is another alternative for meeting our cash flow requirements. Investment securities generate cash flow 
through principal payments and maturities, and they generally have readily available markets that allow for their conversion to 
cash. At December 31,  2023, 95% of our  investment  securities portfolio was  classified  as AFS,  and  we had gross unrealized 
losses  in  our  AFS  investment  securities  portfolio  of $57.7 million  and  gross  unrealized  gains  of $0.3 million.  The  sale  of 
securities in a loss position would cause us to record a loss on sale of investment securities in noninterest income in the period 
during which the securities were sold. Some securities are pledged to secure certain deposit types or short-term borrowings, such 
as  FHLB  advances  and  borrowings  under  the  BTFP,  which  impacts  their  liquidity. At  December  31,  2023,  securities  with  a 
carrying  value  of  $296.2 million  were  pledged  to  secure  certain  deposits,  borrowings,  and  other  liabilities compared  to 
$165.7 million in pledged securities at December 31, 2022 with the increase due primarily to the pledge of securities to secure 
borrowings under the BTFP. 

Other  sources  available  for  meeting  liquidity  needs  include  advances  from  the  FHLB,  repurchase  agreements  and  other 
borrowings. FHLB advances may be used to meet day to day liquidity needs, particularly if the prevailing interest rate on an 
FHLB advance compares favorably to the rates that we would be required to pay to attract deposits. At December 31, 2023, the 
balance of  our  outstanding  advances with  the FHLB was $23.5 million, all  long-term  advances based  on original maturity, a 
decrease from $387.0 million  at  December  31,  2022,  consisting  of  $333.5  million  short-term  and  $53.5  million  long-term 
advances; we decreased our use of FHLB advances as we utilized the BTFP. The total amount of the remaining credit available 
to us from the FHLB at December 31, 2023 was $919.5 million. At December 31, 2023, our FHLB borrowings were collateralized 
by a blanket pledge of certain loans totaling approximately $975.4 million. 

Beginning in March 2023, we became eligible to borrow from the BTFP, which provides additional liquidity through borrowings 
secured by the pledging of certain qualifying securities and other assets valued at par. The BTFP is a one-year program ending 
March 11, 2024, and we can borrow any time during the term and can repay the obligation at any time without penalty. During 
the second quarter, we utilized the BTFP to secure fixed rate funding for a one-year term and reduce short-term FHLB advances, 
which  are  priced  daily. During  the  fourth  quarter  of  2023  and  again  in  the  first  quarter  of  2024,  we  refinanced  all  of  our 
borrowings under the BTFP with new borrowings under the BTFP with a one-year term due to more favorable rates. At December 
31, 2023, borrowings outstanding under the BTFP were $212.5 million, and our remaining borrowing capacity under the BTFP 
was $58.5 million based on the value of securities available to be used as collateral, valued at par value as permitted under the 
program.  

Repurchase agreements are contracts for the sale of securities which we own with a corresponding agreement to repurchase those 
securities at an agreed upon price and date. Our policies limit the use of repurchase agreements to those collateralized by certain 
investment securities. We had $8.6 million of repurchase agreements outstanding at December 31, 2023, and none at December 
31, 2022. 

We maintain unsecured lines of credit with FNBB and TIB totaling $60.0 million. These lines of credit are federal funds lines of 
credit  and  are  used  for  overnight  borrowing  only.  There  were  no  outstanding  balances  on  our  unsecured  lines  of  credit 
at December 31, 2023 or 2022. 

At December  31,  2023,  we held $32.0 million of  cash  and  cash  equivalents  and  maintained  approximately $1.04  billion of 
available  funding  from  FHLB  advances,  the BTFP,  and  unsecured  lines  of  credit  with  correspondent  banks.  Cash  and  cash 
equivalents and available funding represent 149% of uninsured deposits of $720.1 million at December 31, 2023. 

64 

  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
In  addition,  at  both December  31,  2023  and  2022 we  had $45.0 million in  aggregate  principal  amount  of  subordinated  debt 
outstanding. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate principal amount of our 2032 Notes, 
and  used  the  majority  of  the  proceeds  to  redeem  $18.6  million  of  our  2027  Notes  in  June  2022. For  additional  information, 
see Note 10. Subordinated Debt Securities and see Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings above. 

Our liquidity strategy is focused on using the least costly funds available to us in the context of our balance sheet composition 
and interest rate risk position. Accordingly, we target growth of noninterest-bearing deposits. Although we cannot directly control 
the types of deposit instruments our customers choose, we can influence those choices with the interest rates and deposit specials 
we offer. In recent periods, the proportion of our deposits represented by noninterest-bearing deposits has declined primarily due 
to rising market interest rates as customers have migrated to higher yielding alternatives. At December 31, 2023, we held $269.1 
million of brokered time deposits and no brokered demand deposits, as defined for federal regulatory purposes, to secure fixed 
cost  funding  and  reduce  FHLB  advances.  At December  31,  2022,  we  held $10.0 million  of  brokered  time  deposits  and 
no brokered demand deposits, as defined for federal regulatory purposes. We have historically utilized brokered demand deposits, 
due to more favorable pricing, to satisfy the required borrowings under interest rate swap agreements. We also hold QwickRate® 
deposits, included in our time deposit balances, which we obtain through a qualified network, to address liquidity needs when 
rates on such deposits compare favorably with deposit rates in our markets. At December 31, 2023, we held $17.0 million of 
QwickRate® deposits, a decrease compared to $26.5 million at December 31, 2022. 

The following table presents, by type, our funding sources, which consist of total average deposits and borrowed funds, as a 
percentage of total funds and the total cost of each funding source for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022. 

Noninterest-bearing demand 
Interest-bearing demand 
Brokered demand deposits 
Savings deposits 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 
Short-term borrowings 
Borrowed funds 

Total deposits and borrowed funds 

Percentage of Total 
Average Deposits and 
Borrowed Funds 

Cost of Funds 

  Year ended December 31,      Year ended December 31,   

2023 

2022 

2023 

2022 

20%     
27       
—       
5       
7       
28       
10       
3       
100%     

26%    
38       
—       
7       
—       
18       
6       
5       
100%    

—%     
1.30       
—       
0.40       
5.02       
3.48       
4.93       
4.54       
2.33%     

—%
0.27  
0.42  
0.05  
4.80  
0.88  
3.05  
3.49  
0.63%

Capital Resources. Our primary sources of capital include retained earnings, capital obtained through acquisitions and proceeds 
from the sale of our capital stock and subordinated debt. We may issue capital stock and debt securities from time to time to fund 
acquisitions and support our organic growth. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate 
principal amount of our 2032 Notes, which are intended to quality as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes, and used the majority 
of the proceeds to redeem $18.6 million of our 2027 Notes in June 2022. During 2019, we issued $25.0 million of our 2029 
Notes, which are intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes. For additional information see Discussion 
and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings. 

During  2023,  we  paid $3.8 million  in  dividends,  compared  to $3.6 million  in 2022  and $3.1 million  in  2021.  Our  board  of 
directors has authorized a share repurchase program and during 2023 we paid $3.0 million to repurchase our shares, compared 
to $10.5 million in 2022 and $6.9 million in 2021. The aggregate purchase price does not include the effect of excise tax expense 
incurred  on net  share  repurchases. On  July  19,  2023  and September 21,  2022,  the board of directors  approved  an additional 
350,000 shares and 300,000 shares, respectively, of the Company’s common stock for repurchase. At December 31, 2023, we 
had 514,266 shares of our common stock remaining authorized for repurchase under the program. For additional information, 
see Note 10. Subordinated Debt Securities and Note 13. Stockholders' Equity. 

We are subject to restrictions on dividends under applicable banking laws and regulations. Please refer to the discussion under 
the heading “Supervision and Regulation – Dividends” in Item 1. Business, for more information. We are also subject to additional 
legal and contractual restrictions on dividends. Please refer to the discussion under the heading “Dividend Policy” in Item 5. 
Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities and under the 
heading “Common Stock – Dividend Restrictions” in Note 13. Stockholders' Equity. 

65 

  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
     
     
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
   
  
  
We are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve and the OCC. These requirements 
are described in greater detail under the heading “Supervision and Regulation – Regulatory Capital Requirements” of Item 1. 
Business. Those guidelines specify capital tiers, which include the following classifications: 

Tier 1 Leverage 
Ratio 
5% or above 
4% or above 
   Less than 4% 

   Less than 3% 

Capital Tiers(1) 
Well capitalized 
Adequately capitalized    
Undercapitalized 
Significantly 

undercapitalized 

Critically 

undercapitalized 

Common Equity Tier 1 
Capital Ratio 
6.5% or above 
4.5% or above 
Less than 4.5% 

Tier 1 Capital 
Ratio 
8% or above 
6% or above 
   Less than 6% 

Total Capital 
Ratio 
   10% or above      
   8% or above 
   Less than 8%      

Less than 3% 

   Less than 4% 

   Less than 6%      

Ratio of Tangible 
Equity to Total Assets 

2% or less 

(1)  

In order to be well capitalized or adequately capitalized, a bank must satisfy each of the required ratios in the table. In
order to be undercapitalized or significantly undercapitalized, a bank would need to fall below just one of the relevant
ratio thresholds in the table. In order to be well capitalized, the Bank cannot be subject to any written agreement or
order requiring it to maintain a specific level of capital for any capital measure. 

The Company and the Bank each were in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements as of December 31, 2023, 2022 
and 2021. The Bank also was considered “well-capitalized” under the OCC’s prompt corrective action regulations as of these 
dates. 

The following table presents the actual capital amounts and regulatory capital ratios for the Company and the Bank as of the 
dates presented (dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 
Investar Holding Corporation: 
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage) 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
Investar Bank: 
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage) 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 

December 31, 2022 
Investar Holding Corporation: 
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage) 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
Investar Bank: 
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage) 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 

Actual 

Minimum Capital 
Requirement to be Well 
Capitalized 

   Amount 

     Ratio 

      Amount 

     Ratio 

  $

  $

239,095       
229,595       
239,095       
313,574       

280,687       
280,687       
280,687       
310,846       

231,048       
221,548       
231,048       
300,009       

267,603       
267,603       
267,603       
292,339       

8.35%  $
9.51       
9.90       
12.99       

9.81       
11.64       
11.64       
12.89       

8.53%  $
9.79       
10.21       
13.25       

9.89       
11.83       
11.83       
12.92       

—      
—      
—      
—      

—%
—  
—  
—  

143,085      
156,805      
192,990      
241,238      

5.00  
6.50  
8.00  
10.00  

—      
—      
—      
—      

—%
—  
—  
—  

135,344      
147,044      
180,977      
226,221      

5.00  
6.50  
8.00  
10.00  

66 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
     
     
     
     
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
      
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
 
 
Off-Balance Sheet Transactions and Lease Obligations 

Swap  Contracts.  The Bank  historically  has  entered  into  interest  rate  swap  contracts,  some  of  which  are  forward  starting,  to 
manage exposure against the variability in the expected future cash flows (future interest payments) attributable to changes in 
the 1-month LIBOR associated with the forecasted issuances of 1-month fixed rate debt arising from a rollover strategy. An 
interest rate swap is an agreement whereby one party agrees to pay a fixed rate of interest on a notional principal amount in 
exchange for receiving a floating rate of interest on the same notional amount for a predetermined period of time, from a second 
party.  At December  31,  2023 and December  31,  2022,  the  Company  had  no  current  or  forward  starting  interest  rate  swap 
agreements. For additional information, see Note 12. Derivative Financial Instruments. 

During the year ended December 31, 2022, we voluntarily terminated our remaining interest rate swap agreements with a total 
notional  amount of $115.0 million in  response  to  market  conditions.  During  year  ended December  31,  2021, we  voluntarily 
terminated interest rate swap agreements with a total notional amount of $150.0 million in response to market conditions and as 
a result of excess liquidity. For years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, unrealized gains of $6.4 million and 
$1.4 million,  respectively, net  of tax  expenses  of $1.7 million  and $0.4 million,  respectively,  were  reclassified  from 
“Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income” and recorded as “Swap termination fee income” in noninterest income in the 
accompanying consolidated statements of income. 

For the years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, a gain of $4.3 million, net of a $1.2 million tax expense, and 
a gain of $5.3 million, net of a $1.4 million tax expense, respectively, was recognized in “Other comprehensive income (loss)” in 
the accompanying consolidated statements of comprehensive (loss) income for the change in fair value of the interest rate swap 
contracts. 

The Company also enters into interest rate swap contracts that allow commercial loan customers to effectively convert a variable-
rate commercial loan agreement to a fixed-rate commercial loan agreement. Under these agreements, the Company enters into a 
variable-rate loan agreement with a customer in addition to an interest rate swap agreement, which serves to effectively swap the 
customer’s variable-rate loan into a fixed-rate loan. The Company then enters into a corresponding swap agreement with a third 
party  in  order  to  economically  hedge  its  exposure  through  the  customer  agreement.  The  interest  rate  swaps  with  both  the 
customers  and  third  parties  are  not  designated  as  hedges  under  FASB  ASC  Topic  815,  “Derivatives  and  Hedging,” and  are 
marked  to market  through  earnings. As  the interest rate  swaps  are  structured  to  offset  each other,  changes  to  the  underlying 
benchmark interest rates considered in the valuation of these instruments do not result in an impact to earnings; however, there 
may be fair value adjustments related to credit quality variations between counterparties, which may impact earnings as required 
by FASB ASC Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurement.” The Company did not recognize any gains or losses in other income 
resulting from fair value adjustments during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021. At December 31, 2023, we had 
notional amounts of $174.9 million in interest rate swap contracts with customers and $174.9 million in offsetting interest rate 
swap contracts with other financial institutions. The fair value of the swap contracts consisted of gross assets of $17.3 million 
and gross liabilities of $17.3 million recorded in “Other assets” and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the 
accompanying consolidated balance sheet. 

Unfunded Commitments. The Bank enters into loan commitments and standby letters of credit in the normal course of its business. 
Loan commitments are made to meet the financing needs of our customers, while standby letters of credit commit the Bank to 
make  payments  on  behalf  of  customers  when  certain  specified  future  events  occur.  The  credit  risks  associated  with  loan 
commitments  and  standby  letters  of  credit  are  essentially  the  same  as  those  involved  in  making  loans  to  our  customers. 
Accordingly,  our  normal  credit  policies  apply  to  these  arrangements.  Collateral  (e.g.,  securities,  receivables,  inventory, 
equipment, etc.) is obtained based on management’s credit assessment of the customer. The credit risk associated with these 
commitments is evaluated in a manner similar to the allowance for credit losses. The reserve for unfunded loan commitments is 
included in “Accrued taxes and other liabilities” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2023 and 
2022, the reserve for unfunded loan commitments was $0.3 million and $0.4 million, respectively. 

Loan commitments and standby letters of credit do not necessarily represent future cash requirements, in that while the customer 
typically has the ability to draw upon these commitments at any time, these commitments often expire without being drawn upon 
in full or at all. Virtually all of our standby letters of credit expire within one year. Our unfunded loan commitments and standby 
letters of credit outstanding are summarized below as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands). 

Commitments to extend credit: 
Loan commitments 
Standby letters of credit 

67 

December 31, 
2023 

December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

413,019    $ 
17,844      

333,040  
11,379  

  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
  
The  Company  closely  monitors  the  amount  of  remaining  future  commitments  to  borrowers  in  light  of  prevailing  economic 
conditions and adjusts these commitments as necessary. The Company will continue this process as new commitments are entered 
into or existing commitments are renewed. 

Additionally,  at  December  31,  2023,  the  Company  had  unfunded  commitments  of  $1.3 million  for  its  investment  in  Small 
Business Investment Company qualified funds. 

For each of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, we engaged in no off-balance sheet transactions reasonably likely to 
have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows currently or in the future. 

Lease Obligations. The Company’s primary leasing activities relate to certain real estate leases entered into in support of the 
Company’s branch operations. The Company’s branch locations operated under lease agreements have all been designated as 
operating leases. The Company does not lease equipment under operating leases, nor does it have leases designated as finance 
leases.  

The  following  table  presents,  as  of  December  31,  2023,  contractually  obligated  lease  payments  due  under  non-cancelable 
operating leases by payment date (dollars in thousands). 

Less than one year 
One to three years 
Three to five years 
Over five years 

Total 

  $ 

  $ 

381  
727  
682  
671  
2,461  

On January 27, 2023, we completed the previously announced sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with 
the Alice and Victoria, Texas branch locations. Upon the completion of the sale, we recorded $0.3 million of occupancy expense 
to terminate the remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases. 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk 

The information contained in Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 
– Risk Management hereof is incorporated herein by reference. 

68 

  
  
   
  
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

To the Stockholders and Board of Directors 

Investar Holding Corporation 

Baton Rouge, Louisiana 

Investar  Holding  Corporation  (the  “Company”)  is  responsible  for  the  preparation,  integrity  and  fair  presentation  of  the 
consolidated financial statements included in this annual report. The consolidated financial statements and notes included in this 
annual report have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America 
and necessarily include some amounts that are based on management’s best estimates and judgments. 

Management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting 
designed  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the  preparation  of  financial 
statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. 
The  Company’s  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  includes  those  policies  and  procedures  that:  (1)  pertain  to  the 
maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of 
the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial 
statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and that receipts and 
expenditures  of  the  Company  are  being  made  only  in  accordance  with  authorizations  of  management  and  directors  of  the 
Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or 
disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. 

The system of internal control over financial reporting as it relates to the financial statements is evaluated for effectiveness by 
management and tested for reliability through a program of internal audits. Actions are taken to correct potential deficiencies as 
they are identified. Any system of internal control, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations, including the possibility 
that a control can be circumvented or overridden, and misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. Also, 
because of changes in conditions, internal control effectiveness may vary over time. Accordingly, even an effective system of 
internal control will provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. 

Management, with the participation of the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, conducted an 
assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s system of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, 
based on criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in the “Internal Control - Integrated Framework,” 
(2013)  issued  by  the  Committee  of  Sponsoring  Organizations  of  the  Treadway  Commission.  Based  on  this  assessment, 
management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2023, the Company’s system of internal control over financial reporting is 
effective and meets the criteria of the “Internal Control – Integrated Framework.” 

HORNE LLP, the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm that has audited the Company’s financial statements 
included in this annual report, has issued an attestation report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting which 
is included herein. 

Date: March 7, 2024 

Date: March 7, 2024 

By:  /s/ John J. D’Angelo 
John J. D’Angelo 
President and Chief Executive Officer 

By:  /s/ John R. Campbell 
John R. Campbell 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 

69 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Investar Holding Corporation 

Opinion on the Internal Control Over Financial Reporting  

We have audited Investar Holding Corporation’s (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 
2023,  based  on  criteria  established  in  the  Internal  Control  -  Integrated  Framework  issued  by  the  Committee  of  Sponsoring 
Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective 
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in the Internal Control - Integrated 
Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013. 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (the 
“PCAOB”), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and our report dated March 7, 2024 
expressed an unqualified opinion. 

Basis for Opinion 

The  Company’s  management  is  responsible  for  maintaining  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  and  for  its 
assessment  of  the  effectiveness  of  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  in  the  accompanying  Report  on  Management's 
Assessment of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal 
control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required 
to be  independent with  respect  to  the  Company  in  accordance  with U.S.  federal  securities  laws  and  the applicable rules  and 
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the 
audit  to  obtain  reasonable  assurance  about  whether  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  was  maintained  in  all 
material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk 
that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the 
assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We 
believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. 

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

A  company’s  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  is  a  process  designed  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the 
reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally 
accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that 
(1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions 
of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation 
of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the 
company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide 
reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company’s 
assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. 

Because  of  its  inherent  limitations,  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  may  not  prevent  or  detect  misstatements.  Also, 
projections  of  any  evaluation  of  effectiveness  to  future  periods  are  subject  to  the  risk  that  controls  may  become  inadequate 
because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 

/s/ HORNE LLP 

Baton Rouge, Louisiana 
March 7, 2024 

70 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Investar Holding Corporation 

Opinion on the Financial Statements 

We  have  audited  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance  sheets  of  Investar  Holding  Corporation  (the  “Company”)  as  of 
December  31,  2023  and  2022,  and  the  related  consolidated  statements  of  income,  comprehensive  income,  changes  in 
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows, for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, and the related notes to 
the  consolidated  financial  statements  (collectively,  referred  to  as  the  “financial  statements”).  In  our  opinion,  the  financial 
statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, and 
the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, in conformity 
with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (the 
“PCAOB”), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in 
the Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission 
in 2013, and our report dated March 7, 2024, expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal 
control over financial reporting. 

Emphasis-of-Matter 

As discussed in Note 1 to the financial statements, the Company has changed its method of accounting for credit losses effective 
January 1, 2023, due to the adoption of Accounting Standards Codification ASC 326: Financial Instruments – Credit Losses 
(“ASC  326”).  The  Company  adopted  the  new  credit  loss  standard  using  the  modified  retrospective  approach  such  that  prior 
period  amounts  are  not  adjusted  and  continue  to  be  reported  in  accordance  with  previously  applicable  generally  accepted 
accounting principles. Our opinion is not modified with respect to this matter. 

Basis for Opinion 

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on 
the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are 
required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules 
and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the 
audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to 
error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, 
whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a 
test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the 
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the 
financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. 

Critical Audit Matter 

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that 
was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (i) relates to accounts or disclosures that are 
material  to  the  financial  statements  and  (ii)  involved  especially  challenging,  subjective,  or  complex  judgments.  The 
communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and 
we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matter or on the 
accounts or disclosures to which it relates. 

71 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Allowance for Credit Losses 

Description of the Matter 

As described in Notes 1 and 3 to the financial statements, the Company’s allowance for credit losses (“ACL”) is a valuation that 
reflects the Company’s best estimate of expected credit losses inherent within the Company’s loans held for investment portfolio 
and is maintained at a level believed adequate by management to absorb credit losses inherent in the entire loan portfolio in 
accordance with Accounting Standards Codification ASC 326: Financial Instruments – Credit Losses. The ACL is measured 
over the contractual life of loans held for investments and is estimated using relevant available information relating to past events, 
current conditions and reasonable and supportable forecasts, as well as qualitative adjustments. The ACL was $30,540,000 at 
December 31, 2023, which consists of two components; the loss allocations on pools of loans that share similar risk characteristics 
and loss allocations on individual loans that do not share similar risk characteristics with other loans and the measurement of 
expected credit loss for such individual loans. 

The Company’s measurement of expected credit losses of loans on a pool basis when the loans share similar risk characteristics 
is based off historical data that is adjusted, as necessary, for qualitative factors where there are differences in the historical loss 
data of the Company and current or projected future conditions. Consideration of the relevant qualitative factors are used to bring 
the ACL to the level management believes is appropriate based on factors that are otherwise unaccounted for in the quantitative 
process.  The  ACL  also  includes  reserves  for  loans  evaluated  on  an  individual  basis,  such  as  certain  loans  on  nonaccrual. 
Management applies judgment in the determination of the qualitative factors and reserves assigned on an individual basis to 
estimate the ACL. 

The ACL was identified by us as a critical audit matter because of the extent of auditor judgment applied and significant audit 
effort to evaluate the significant subjective and complex judgments made by management including the judgment required in 
evaluating management's determination of the qualitative factors and the reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual 
basis. 

How we Addressed the Matter in Our Audit 

The primary audit procedures we performed in responses to this critical audit matter included: 

•  Obtained  an  understanding  of  the  Company's  process  for  establishing  the  ACL,  including  determination  of  the
qualitative factors and reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis, and evaluated the process utilized
by management to challenge the model results and determine the best estimate of the ACL as of the balance sheet date.
Evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of the controls associated with the ACL process, including
controls around the reliability and accuracy of data used in the model, management's review and approval of the selected
qualitative factors, the reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis, the governance of the credit loss
methodology, and management's review and approval of the ACL. 

• 

•  Assessed  reasonableness  of  model  methodology  and  key  modeling  assumptions,  as  well  as  the  appropriateness  of

• 

management’s qualitative framework, and reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis. 
Performed specific substantive tests of the model utilized, qualitative factors and the reserve assumptions for loans
evaluated on an individual basis. We evaluated if qualitative factors were applied based on a comprehensive framework
and compared the adjustments utilized by management to both internal portfolio metrics and external macroeconomic
data (as applicable) to support adjustments and evaluate trends in such adjustments. Within our reserve testing for loans
evaluated on an individual basis, we evaluated management’s assumptions, including collateral valuations. In addition,
we  evaluated  the  Company’s  estimate  of  the  overall  ACL  giving  consideration  to  the  Company’s  borrowers,  loan
portfolio, and macroeconomic trends, independently obtained and compared such information to comparable financial
institutions and considered whether new or contrary information existed. 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2020. 

/s/ HORNE LLP 

Baton Rouge, Louisiana 
March 7, 2024 

72 

  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS 
(Amounts in thousands, except share data) 

ASSETS 

Cash and due from banks 
Interest-bearing balances due from other banks 
Federal funds sold 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Available for sale securities at fair value (amortized cost of $419,283 and $467,316, 

respectively) 

Held to maturity securities at amortized cost (estimated fair value of $20,513 and 

$7,922, respectively) 

Loans 
Less: allowance for credit losses 

Loans, net 
Equity securities 
Bank premises and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $19,476 and 

$22,025, respectively 
Other real estate owned, net 
Accrued interest receivable 
Deferred tax asset 
Goodwill and other intangible assets, net 
Bank owned life insurance 
Other assets 

Total assets 

LIABILITIES 
Deposits: 
Noninterest-bearing 
Interest-bearing 
Total deposits 

Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank 
Borrowings under Bank Term Funding Program 
Repurchase agreements 
Subordinated debt, net of unamortized issuance costs 
Junior subordinated debt 
Accrued taxes and other liabilities 

Total liabilities 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 19) 

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 

  $ 

  $ 

Preferred stock, no par value per share; 5,000,000 shares authorized 
Common stock, $1.00 par value per share; 40,000,000 shares authorized; 9,748,067 

and 9,901,847 shares issued and outstanding, respectively 

Surplus 
Retained earnings 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss 

Total stockholders’ equity 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity 

  $ 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. 

73 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

  $ 

28,285    $ 
3,724      
—      
32,009      

30,056  
10,010  
193  
40,259  

361,918      

405,167  

20,472      
2,210,619      
(30,540)     
2,180,079      
14,597      

44,183      
4,438      
14,366      
16,910      
42,320      
58,797      
25,066      
2,815,155    $ 

448,752    $ 
1,806,975      
2,255,727      
23,500      
212,500      
8,633      
44,320      
8,630      
35,077      
2,588,387      

8,305  
2,104,767  
(24,364) 
2,080,403  
27,254  

49,587  
682  
12,749  
16,438  
43,147  
57,379  
12,437  
2,753,807  

580,741  
1,501,624  
2,082,365  
387,000  
—  
—  
44,225  
8,515  
15,920  
2,538,025  

—      

—  

9,748      
145,456      
116,711      
(45,147)     
226,768      
2,815,155    $ 

9,902  
146,587  
108,206  
(48,913) 
215,782  
2,753,807  

  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME 
(Amounts in thousands, except share data) 

For the years ended December 31, 
2022 

2021 

2023 

INTEREST INCOME 

Interest and fees on loans 
Interest on investment securities 

Taxable 
Tax-exempt 

Other interest income 

Total interest income 

INTEREST EXPENSE 
Interest on deposits 
Interest on borrowings 

Total interest expense 
Net interest income 

Provision for credit losses 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses 

NONINTEREST INCOME 

Service charges on deposit accounts 
(Loss) gain on call or sale of investment securities, net 
Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets, net 
(Loss) gain on sale of other real estate owned, net 
Swap termination fee income 
Gain on sale of loans 
Servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans 
Interchange fees 
Income from bank owned life insurance 
Change in the fair value of equity securities 
Income from insurance proceeds 
Other operating income 

Total noninterest income 

Income before noninterest expense 

NONINTEREST EXPENSE 

Depreciation and amortization 
Salaries and employee benefits 
Occupancy 
Data processing 
Marketing 
Professional fees 
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt 
Acquisition expense 
Other operating expenses 

Total noninterest expense 

Income before income tax expense 

Income tax expense 
Net income 

EARNINGS PER SHARE 
Basic earnings per share 
Diluted earnings per share 
Cash dividends declared per common share 

  $ 

117,892    $ 

93,373    $ 

90,230  

12,372      
693      
2,244      
133,201      

9,796      
482      
918      
104,569      

42,072      
16,609      
58,681      
74,520      

(2,000)     
76,520      

3,090      
(323)     
(1,323)     
(114)     
—      
75      
14      
1,697      
1,417      
(65)     
—      
2,070      
6,538      
83,058      

3,780      
37,143      
2,994      
3,482      
302      
1,933      
—      
—      
12,996      
62,630      
20,428      
3,750      
16,678    $ 

6,250      
8,534      
14,784      
89,785      

2,922      
86,863      

3,090      
6      
(258)     
9      
8,077      
37      
74      
2,036      
1,305      
(90)     
1,384      
2,680      
18,350      
105,213      

4,435      
34,974      
2,915      
3,600      
262      
1,774      
222      
—      
12,683      
60,865      
44,348      
8,639      
35,709    $ 

1.69    $ 
1.69      
0.395      

3.54    $ 
3.50      
0.365      

3,948  
552  
812  
95,542  

7,487  
4,241  
11,728  
83,814  

22,885  
60,929  

2,422  
2,321  
(408) 
(5) 
1,835  
199  
204  
1,920  
1,146  
214  
—  
2,194  
12,042  
72,971  

4,988  
35,527  
2,753  
3,112  
275  
1,585  
—  
2,448  
12,374  
63,062  
9,909  
1,909  
8,000  

0.77  
0.76  
0.31  

  $ 

  $ 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. 

74 

  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS) 
(Amounts in thousands) 

Net income 
Other comprehensive income (loss): 

Investment securities: 

For the years ended December 31, 
2021 
2022 
2023 

  $ 

16,678    $ 

35,709    $ 

8,000  

Unrealized gain (loss), available for sale, net of tax expense (benefit) of 

$951, ($12,993), and ($694), respectively 

3,510      

(48,019)     

(2,611) 

Reclassification of realized loss (gain), available for sale, net of tax 

benefit (expense) of $67, ($1), and ($488), respectively 

Unrealized loss, transfer from available for sale to held to maturity, net 

of tax benefit of $0 for all respective periods 

Derivative financial instruments: 

Change in fair value of interest rate swaps designated as cash flow 

hedges, net of tax expense of $0, $1,151, and $1,396, respectively 
Reclassification of realized gain, interest rate swap termination, net of 

tax expense of $0, $1,697, and $385, respectively 

Total other comprehensive income (loss) 
Total comprehensive income (loss) 

256      

(5)     

(1,833) 

—      

(1)     

(1) 

—      

4,329      

5,253  

—      
3,766      
20,444    $ 

(6,380)     
(50,076)     
(14,367)   $ 

(1,450) 
(642) 
7,358  

  $ 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. 

75 

  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
  
 
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
(Amounts in thousands, except share data) 

     Accumulated        
Other 
     Retained      Comprehensive    Stockholders’   

Total 

     Surplus       Earnings       Income (Loss)      Equity 

   Common        
   Stock 
  $ 

  $ 

Balance, December 31, 2020 
Surrendered shares 
Shares repurchased 
Options exercised 
Dividends declared, $0.31 per share 
Stock-based compensation 
Net income 
Other comprehensive loss, net 
Balance, December 31, 2021 
Surrendered shares 
Shares repurchased 
Options exercised 
Dividends declared, $0.365 per share 
Stock-based compensation 
Net income 
Other comprehensive loss, net 
Balance, December 31, 2022 
  $ 
Cumulative effect of adoption of ASU 2016-13, net      
Surrendered shares 
Shares repurchased 
Options exercised 
Dividends declared, $0.395 per share 
Stock-based compensation 
Net income 
Other comprehensive income, net 
Balance, December 31, 2023 

  $ 

(24)    
(519)    
10      
—      
92      
—      
—      

(19)    
(359)    
47      
—      
65      
—      
—      

71,385     $ 
10,609    $ 159,485    $ 
—       
(348)     
—       
(6,566)     
—       
685      
(3,225 )     
—      
—       
1,676      
8,000       
—      
—       
—      
76,160     $ 
10,343    $ 154,932    $ 
—       
(462)     
—       
(10,021)     
—       
123      
(3,663 )     
—      
—       
2,015      
35,709       
—      
—       
—      
9,902    $ 146,587    $  108,206     $ 
(4,295 )     
—      
—       
(330)     
—       
(2,804)     
97      
—       
(3,878 )     
—      
1,906      
—       
—      
16,678       
—       
—      
9,748    $ 145,456    $  116,711     $ 

—      
(22)    
(222)    
8      
—      
82      
—      
—      

1,805    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
(642)     
1,163    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
(50,076)     
(48,913)   $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
3,766      
(45,147)   $ 

243,284  
(367) 
(6,925) 
732  
(3,225) 
1,741  
8,000  
(642) 
242,598  
(486) 
(10,540) 
133  
(3,663) 
2,107  
35,709  
(50,076) 
215,782  
(4,295) 
(352) 
(3,026) 
105  
(3,878) 
1,988  
16,678  
3,766  
226,768  

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. 

76 

  
  
    
  
      
  
      
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
  
      
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
 
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(Amounts in thousands) 

Cash flows from operating activities 

Net income 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating 

For the years ended December 31, 
2021 
2022 
2023 

  $ 

16,678    $ 

35,709    $ 

8,000  

activities: 
Depreciation and amortization 
Provision for credit losses 
Net accretion of purchase accounting adjustments 
Net (accretion) amortization of securities 
Loss (gain) on call or sale of investment securities, net 
Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets, net 
Loss (gain) on sale of other real estate owned, net 
Gain on sale of loans to First Community Bank 
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt 
FHLB stock dividend 
Stock-based compensation 
Deferred taxes 
Net change in value of bank owned life insurance 
Amortization of subordinated debt issuance costs 
Change in the fair value of equity securities 

Loans held for sale: 

Originations 
Proceeds from sales 
Gain on sale of loans 

Net change in: 

Accrued interest receivable 
Other assets 
Accrued taxes and other liabilities 

Net cash provided by operating activities 

Cash flows from investing activities 

Proceeds from sales of investment securities available for sale 
Purchases of securities available for sale 
Purchases of securities held to maturity 
Proceeds from maturities, prepayments and calls of investment securities 

available for sale 

Proceeds from maturities, prepayments and calls of investment securities 

held to maturity 

Proceeds from redemption or sale of equity securities 
Purchases of equity securities 
Net decrease (increase) in loans 
Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned 
Purchases of other real estate owned 
Proceeds from sales of fixed assets 
Purchase of loans 
Purchases of fixed assets 
Purchases of bank owned life insurance 
Purchases of other investments 
Distributions from investments 
Cash paid for branch sale to First Community Bank, net of cash received 
Cash acquired from acquisition of Cheaha Financial Group, net of cash 

paid 

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities 

77 

3,780      
(2,000)     
(274)     
(62)     
323      
1,323      
114      
(75)     
—      
(642)     
1,988      
(350)     
(1,417)     
95      
65      

—      
—      
—      

(518)     
5,772      
1,447      
26,247      

4,435      
2,922      
(95)     
972      
(6)     
258      
(9)     
—      
222      
(152)     
2,107      
(655)     
(1,305)     
66      
90      

(624)     
1,281      
(37)     

(1,394)     
(1,732)     
695      
42,748      

4,988  
22,885  
(1,560) 
3,484  
(2,321) 
408  
5  
—  
—  
(40) 
1,741  
(547) 
(1,143) 
92  
(214) 

(10,235) 
9,814  
(199) 

2,451  
(3,086) 
(1,042) 
33,481  

14,974      
(107,904)     
(14,056)     

—      
(181,636)     
—      

137,803  
(255,455) 
—  

140,712      

60,173      

84,729  

1,879      
17,429      
(4,196)     
41,999      
1,484      
—      
42      
(163,842)     
(1,072)     
—      
(617)     
274      
(596)     

1,933      
1,225      
(11,615)     
(225,090)     
6,071      
—      
4,692      
—      
(1,056)     
(5,000)     
(718)     
34      
—      

—      
(73,490)     

—      
(350,987)     

2,149  
574  
(523) 
86,967  
878  
(501) 
194  
—  
(3,318) 
(8,000) 
(233) 
23  
—  

8,112  
53,399  

  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
   
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, CONTINUED 
(Amounts in thousands) 

Cash flows from financing activities 

Net increase (decrease) in customer deposits 
Net increase (decrease) in repurchase agreements 
Net (decrease) increase in short-term FHLB advances 
Net increase in borrowings under the Bank Term Funding Program 
Repayment of long-term FHLB advances 
Cash dividends paid on common stock 
Payments to repurchase common stock 
Proceeds from stock options exercised 
Proceeds from subordinated debt, net of issuance costs 
Extinguishment of subordinated debt 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 

Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period 

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW 

INFORMATION 

Cash payments for: 
Income taxes 
Interest on deposits and borrowings 

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF NONCASH INVESTING 

ACTIVITIES 

Transfer from loans to other real estate owned 
Transfer from bank premises and equipment to other real estate owned 

For the years ended December 31, 
2021 
2022 
2023 

188,125      
8,633      
(333,500)     
212,500      
(30,000)     
(3,844)     
(3,026)     
105      
—      
—      
38,993      
(8,250)     
40,259      
32,009    $ 

(38,249)     
(5,783)     
333,500      
—      
(25,000)     
(3,552)     
(10,540)     
133      
19,548      
(18,600)     
251,457      
(56,782)     
97,041      
40,259    $ 

25,946  
130  
(42,000) 
—  
—  
(3,090) 
(6,925) 
732  
—  
—  
(25,207) 
61,673  
35,368  
97,041  

2,899    $ 
56,773      

8,887    $ 
14,409      

4,207  
11,817  

3,930    $ 
1,425      

3,327    $ 
525      

521  
1,850  

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. 

78 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
      
        
        
  
    
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 

Nature of Operations 

Investar Holding Corporation is a financial holding company headquartered in Baton Rouge, Louisiana, that provides, through 
its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National Association (the “Bank”), full banking services, excluding trust services, 
tailored primarily to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses throughout its markets 
in south Louisiana, southeast Texas and Alabama. 

Basis of Presentation 

The consolidated financial statements of Investar Holding Corporation and its wholly-owned subsidiary, the Bank (together, the 
“Company”), have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America 
(“GAAP”) and to generally accepted practices within the banking industry. 

Segments 

All  of  the  Company’s  banking  operations  are  considered  by  management  to  be  aggregated  in  one  reportable  operating 
segment. Because the overall banking operations comprise substantially all of the consolidated operations, no separate segment 
disclosures are presented in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. 

Principles of Consolidation 

The  consolidated  financial  statements  include  the  accounts  of  the  Company  and  its  wholly-owned  subsidiary,  the  Bank.  All 
significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. 

Use of Estimates 

The preparation of statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the 
reported  amounts  of  assets  and  liabilities  and  the  disclosure  of  contingent  assets  and  liabilities  at  the  date  of  the  financial 
statements as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from 
those estimates, and such differences could be material. 

Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change relate to the determination of the allowance for credit 
losses.  While  management  uses  available  information  to  recognize  credit  losses  on  loans,  future  additions  to  the 
allowance may be necessary based on changes in economic conditions, changes in conditions of our borrowers’ industries or 
changes  in  the  condition  of  individual  borrowers. As  described  below  under  “Accounting  Standards  Adopted  in 2023,” the 
Company adopted Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2016-13 effective January 1, 2023, which changed how the Company 
accounts for the allowance for credit losses. In addition, regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, 
periodically review the Company’s allowance for credit losses. Such agencies may require the Company to recognize additions 
to the allowance based on their judgments about information available to them at the time of their examination. Because of these 
factors, it is reasonably possible that the allowance for credit losses may change materially in the near term. However, the amount 
of the change that is reasonably possible cannot be estimated. 

Other estimates that are susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the allowance for off-balance sheet credit 
losses, the fair value of stock-based compensation awards, the determination of other-than-temporary impairments of securities, 
and the fair value of financial instruments and goodwill. 

The COVID-19 pandemic and, in 2022 and 2023, rising inflation and interest rates have made certain estimates more challenging, 
including those discussed above. 

79 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Investment Securities 

The Company’s investments in securities are accounted for in accordance with applicable guidance contained in the Financial 
Accounting  Standards  Board  (“FASB”)  Accounting  Standards  Codification  (“ASC”),  which  requires  the  classification  of 
securities into one of the following categories: 

• 

• 

Securities to be held to maturity (“HTM”): bonds, notes, and debentures for which the Company has the positive intent
and ability to hold to maturity are reported at cost, adjusted for premiums and discounts that are recognized in interest
income using the interest method over the period to maturity. 

Securities  available  for  sale  (“AFS”):  available  for  sale  securities  consist  of  bonds,  notes,  and  debentures  that  are
available to meet the Company’s operating needs. These securities are reported at fair value. 

Unrealized  holding  gains  and  losses,  net  of  tax,  on  available  for  sale  securities  are  reported  as  a  net  amount  in  other 
comprehensive income. Purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the 
terms of the securities. Realized gains and losses on the sale of debt and equity securities are determined using the specific-
identification method and average price method, respectively. 

The  Company  follows  FASB  guidance  related  to  the  recognition  and  presentation  of  other-than-temporary  impairment.  The 
guidance specifies that if an entity does not have the intent to sell a debt security prior to recovery, the security would not be 
considered other-than-temporarily impaired unless there is a credit loss. When an entity does not intend to sell the security, and 
it is more likely than not that the entity will not have to sell the security before recovery of its cost basis, it will recognize the 
credit  component  of  an  other-than-temporary  impairment  of  a  debt  security  in  earnings  and  the  remaining  portion  in  other 
comprehensive income. 

See “Allowance  for  Credit  Losses” below  for  the  accounting  treatment  of the  allowance  of  credit  losses  for  AFS  and  HTM 
securities. 

Loans 

The  Company’s  loan  portfolio  categories  include  real  estate,  commercial  and  consumer  loans.  Real  estate  loans  are  further 
categorized into construction and development, 1-4 family residential, multifamily, farmland and commercial real estate loans. 
The  consumer  loan  category  includes  loans  originated  through  indirect  lending.  Indirect  lending,  which  is  lending  initiated 
through third-party business partners, is largely comprised of loans made through automotive dealerships. 

Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are stated at the 
unpaid principal balance outstanding, net of purchase premiums or discounts, deferred income (net of costs), any direct principal 
charge-offs, and an allowance for credit losses. Interest on loans is calculated by using the effective interest rate on daily balances 
of the principal amount outstanding. Loan origination fees, net of direct loan origination costs, and commitment fees, are deferred 
and amortized as an adjustment to yield over the life of the loan, or over the commitment period, as applicable. 

Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments 
were due. Loans are ordinarily placed on nonaccrual when a loan is specifically determined to be impaired or when principal or 
interest  is  delinquent  for  90  days  or  more;  however,  management  may  elect  to  continue  the  accrual  when  the  estimated  net 
realizable value of collateral is sufficient to cover the principal balance and the accrued interest. Any unpaid interest previously 
accrued on nonaccrual loans is reversed from income. Interest income, generally, is not recognized on specific impaired loans 
unless the likelihood of further loss is remote. Interest payments received on such loans are applied as a reduction of the loan 
principal balance. Interest income on other nonaccrual loans is recognized only to the extent of interest payments received. A 
loan may be returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and 
future principal and interest amounts contractually due are reasonably assured, which is typically evidenced by a sustained period 
of repayment performance by the borrower. 

The Company follows the FASB accounting guidance on sales of financial assets, which includes participating interests in loans. 
For loan participations that are structured in accordance with this guidance, the sold portions are recorded as a reduction of the 
loan portfolio. Loan participations that do not meet the criteria are accounted for as secured borrowings. 

See “Acquisition Accounting” below for accounting treatment of loans acquired through business acquisitions. 

80 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Employee Retention Credit 

The CARES Act provided for an Employee Retention Credit (“ERC”), which is a broad based refundable payroll tax credit that 
incentivized businesses to retain employees on the payroll during the COVID-19 pandemic. The ERC is a credit against certain 
employment taxes of up to $5,000 per employee for eligible employers based on certain wages paid after March 12, 2020 through 
December 31, 2020. In 2021, the tax credit increased to up to $7,000 for each quarter, equal to 70% of qualified wages paid to 
employees  during  a  quarter,  capped  at $10,000 of  qualified  wages  per  employee  per  quarter.  The  ERC  terminated  effective 
September 30, 2021. The Company qualified for the ERC based on the significant adverse financial impacts of the COVID-19 
pandemic. In the fourth quarter of 2022, Company recorded a $2.3 million reduction to payroll taxes related to the second quarter 
of 2021, and in the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company recorded a $1.9 million reduction to payroll taxes related to the first 
quarter of 2021, which are included as part of “Salaries and employee benefits” in noninterest expense on the accompanying 
consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2022 and 2021. 

Allowance for Credit Losses 

For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

The Company’s allowance for credit losses is determined using a current expected credit loss (“CECL”) model. The allowance 
for credit losses represents the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets accounted for on an amortized cost 
basis. Expected losses at the reporting date are calculated based on historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and 
supportable forecasts. The lifetime expected credit losses are recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or acquired and 
adjusted each period as a provision for credit losses for changes in expected lifetime credit losses. The Company developed a 
CECL  model methodology  that  calculates expected  credit  losses over  the  life of  the portfolio  by  analyzing  the  composition, 
characteristics and quality of the loan and securities portfolios, as well as prevailing economic conditions and forecasts. The 
Company’s CECL calculation estimates loan losses using a combination of discounted cash flow and remaining life analyses. To 
the extent the lives of the loans in the portfolio extend beyond the period for which a reasonable and supportable forecast can be 
made,  when  necessary,  the  model reverts  back  to  the  historical  loss  rates  adjusted  for  qualitative  factors  related  to  current 
conditions using a four-quarter reversion period. 

lending  commitments. For  modeling  purposes, 

The allowance for credit losses is measured on a pool basis when similar risk characteristics exist and is maintained at an amount 
which management believes is a current estimate of the expected credit losses for the full life of the relevant pool of loans and 
related  unfunded 
include:  agriculture  and  farmland, 
automotive, commercial  and  industrial,  construction  and  development,  commercial  real  estate  -  nonowner-occupied  and 
multifamily,  commercial  real  estate  -  owner-occupied,  credit  cards, home  equity  lines  of  credit and  junior  liens,  consumer, 
residential senior liens, and other loans, which primarily consist of public finance. Management periodically reassesses each pool 
to confirm that the loans within the pool continue to share similar characteristics and risk profiles and to determine whether 
further  segmentation  is  necessary. For  each pool  of  loans,  the  Company  evaluates  and  applies  qualitative  adjustments  to  the 
calculated allowance for credit losses based on several factors, including, but not limited to, changes in current and expected 
future economic conditions, changes in the nature and volume of the portfolio, changes in levels of concentrations, changes in 
the  volume  and  severity  of  past  due  loans,  changes  in  lending  policies  and  personnel  and  changes  in  the  competitive  and 
regulatory environment of the banking industry. The loss rates computed for each pool and expected pool-level funding rates are 
applied to the related unfunded lending commitments to calculate an allowance for credit losses.  

loan  pools 

Loans that do not share similar risk characteristics with other loans are excluded from the loan pools and individually evaluated 
for impairment. Individually evaluated loans are loans for which it is probable that all the amounts due under the contractual 
terms of the loan will not be collected. The allowance for credit losses on loans that are individually evaluated is based on a 
comparison  of  the  recorded  investment  in  the  loan  with  either  the  expected  cash  flows  discounted  using  the  loan’s  original 
effective  interest  rate,  observable  market  price  for  the  loan  or  the  fair  value  of  the  collateral  underlying  certain  collateral 
dependent loans. The allowance for credit losses is established after input from management as well as our risk management 
department  and  our  special  assets  committee.  For collateral  dependent  loans  where  the  borrower  is  experiencing  financial 
difficulty, which the Company evaluates independently from the loan pool, the expected credit loss is measured as the difference 
between the amortized cost basis of the loan and the fair value of the collateral, which is based on third-party appraisals. Credits 
deemed uncollectible are charged to the allowance for credit losses. Provisions for credit losses and recoveries on loans previously 
charged off are adjustments to the allowance for credit losses. 

81 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Expected credit losses on AFS securities are recorded in an allowance for credit losses when management does not intend to sell 
or believes that it is not more likely than not that they will be required to sell the securities prior to recovery of the securities’ 
amortized cost basis. If management has the intent to sell or believes it is more likely than not the Company will be required to 
sell an impaired available for sale security before recovery of the amortized cost basis, the credit loss is recorded as a direct write-
down of the amortized cost basis. In evaluating AFS securities in an unrealized  loss position for credit losses, the Company 
considers  the  nature  of  the  investments,  the  current  market  price,  and  the  current  interest  rate  environment,  among  other 
factors. Declines in the fair value of AFS securities that are not considered credit related are recognized in accumulated other 
comprehensive income.  

Expected credit losses on HTM securities are recorded in an allowance for credit losses and estimated using a probability of loss 
model based on reasonable and supportable forecasts. HTM securities are evaluated on a collective basis by security type. In 
evaluating HTM securities in an unrealized loss position for credit losses, the Company considers the nature of the investments, 
the current market price, and the current interest rate environment, among other factors.  

See “Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023” below for additional information. 

For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13: 

Prior to the adoption of CECL, the Company established an allowance for loan losses in an amount that management believed 
would be adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio as of the balance sheet date based on evaluations of 
the collectability of loans and prior loan loss experience. The evaluations took into consideration such factors as changes in the 
nature  and  volume  of  the  loan  portfolio,  overall  portfolio  quality,  review  of  specific  problem  loans,  and  current  economic 
conditions that may affect the borrower’s ability to pay. This evaluation was inherently subjective as it required estimates that 
were susceptible to significant revision as more information became available. Allowances for impaired loans were generally 
determined based on collateral values or the present value of estimated cash flows. Credits deemed uncollectible were charged 
to the allowance. Provisions for loan losses and recoveries on loans previously charged off were adjusted to the allowance. Past 
due status was determined based on contractual terms. 

The allowance consisted of allocated and general components. The allocated component related to loans that were classified as 
impaired. For loans that were classified as impaired, an allowance was established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral 
value or observable market price) of the impaired loan was lower than the carrying value of that loan. The general component 
covered non-classified loans and was based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. Based on management’s 
review  and  observations  made  through  qualitative  review,  management  may  apply  qualitative  adjustments  to  determine  loss 
estimates  at  a  group  and/or  portfolio  segment  level  as  deemed  appropriate.  Management  had  an  established  methodology  to 
determine the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses that assessed the risks and losses inherent in the portfolio and portfolio 
segments. The Company utilized an internally developed model that required judgment to determine the estimation method that 
fit the credit risk characteristics of the loans in its portfolio and portfolio segments. Qualitative and environmental factors that 
may not be directly reflected in quantitative estimates include: asset quality trends, changes in loan concentrations, new products 
and process changes, changes and pressures from competition, changes in lending policies and underwriting practices, trends in 
the nature and volume of the loan portfolio, changes in experience and depth of lending staff and management and national and 
regional economic trends. The Company also considered third party or comparable company loss data. Changes in these factors 
were  considered  in  determining  changes  in  the  allowance  for  loan  losses.  The  impact  of  these  factors  on  the  Company’s 
qualitative assessment of the allowance for loan losses could change from period to period based on management’s assessment 
of the extent to which these factors were already reflected in historic loss rates. The uncertainty inherent in the estimation process 
was also considered in evaluating the allowance for loan losses. 

Equity Securities 

Equity securities primarily consist of Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) stock and Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta (“FRB”) 
stock. Members of the FHLB and FRB are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other 
factors and may invest in additional amounts. FHLB stock and FRB stock is carried at cost, is restricted as to redemption, and is 
periodically evaluated for impairment based on the ultimate recovery of par value. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as 
income. Equity securities also include investments in our other correspondent banks including Independent Bankers Financial 
Corporation and First National Bankers Bank stock. These investments are carried at cost which approximates fair value. The 
balance of equity securities in our correspondent banks at December 31, 2023 and 2022 was $13.4 million and $26.0 million, 
respectively. 

82 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

In addition, equity securities include marketable securities in corporate stocks and mutual funds which totaled $1.2 million at 
both December 31, 2023 and 2022. 

Bank Premises and Equipment 

Bank premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation, with the exception of land, which is stated at 
cost. Depreciation expense is computed using the straight-line method and is charged to expense over the estimated useful lives 
of 39 years for buildings, five to 39 years for improvements, three to seven years for furniture and equipment, and one to five 
years  for  computer  equipment  and  software.  Costs  of  major  additions  and  improvements  are  capitalized.  Expenditures  for 
maintenance  and  repairs  are  expensed  as  incurred.  Gains  or  losses  on  the  disposition  of  land,  buildings,  and  equipment  are 
included in noninterest income on the consolidated statements of income. 

The Company leases certain branch locations under operating lease agreements. The Company also leases certain office facilities 
to outside parties under operating lessor agreements; however, such leases are not significant. The Company determines if an 
arrangement is a lease at inception. Operating leases, with the exception of short-term leases, are included in operating lease 
right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and operating lease liabilities in “Bank premises and equipment, net” and “Accrued taxes and other 
liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Operating lease ROU assets represent the right to use 
an underlying asset for the lease term and operating lease liabilities represent the obligation to make lease payments arising from 
the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at the commencement date based on the present value of 
lease payments over the lease term. As the Company’s leases do not provide an implicit rate, the Company uses its incremental 
borrowing rate based on the information available at the commencement date in determining the present value of lease payments. 
The operating lease ROU asset also includes any lease pre-payments made and excludes lease incentives. The Company’s lease 
terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease. When it is reasonably certain that the Company will exercise an 
option to extend a lease, the extension is included in the lease term when calculating the present value of lease payments. 

Other Real Estate Owned 

Real estate acquired through foreclosure, or other real estate owned on the consolidated balance sheets, is initially recorded at 
fair value at the time of foreclosure, less estimated selling cost, and any related write down is charged to the allowance for credit 
losses. Valuations are periodically performed by management and provisions for estimated losses on other real estate owned are 
charged to expense when fair value is determined to be less than the carrying value. 

Costs relative to the development and improvement of properties are capitalized to the extent realizable, whereas ordinary upkeep 
disbursements are charged to expense. The ability of the Company to recover the carrying value of real estate is based upon 
future sales of the other real estate owned. The ability to affect such sales is subject to market conditions and other factors, many 
of which are beyond the Company’s control. Operating income and expense of such properties is included in other operating 
income or expense, respectively, on the accompanying consolidated statements of income. Gain or loss on the disposition of such 
properties is included in noninterest income on the consolidated statements of income. 

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets 

Goodwill  represents  the  excess  of  the purchase price  over  the  fair  value  of  the  net  identifiable  assets  acquired  in  a  business 
combination. Goodwill and other intangible assets deemed to have an indefinite useful life are not amortized but instead are 
subject to review for impairment annually, or more frequently if deemed necessary, in accordance with the provisions of FASB 
ASC Topic 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other.” 

Intangible  assets  with  estimable  useful  lives  are  amortized  over  their  respective  estimated  useful  lives  and  reviewed  for 
impairment in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 360, “Property, Plant, and Equipment.” If impaired, the asset is written down 
to its estimated fair value. No impairment charges have been recognized through December 31, 2023. Core deposit intangibles 
representing  the  value  of  the  acquired  core  deposit  base  are  generally  recorded  in  connection  with  business  combinations 
involving banks and branch locations. The Company’s policy is to amortize core deposit intangibles over the estimated useful 
life of the deposit base. The remaining useful lives of core deposit intangibles are evaluated periodically to determine whether 
events and circumstances warrant revision of the remaining period of amortization. The Company’s core deposit intangibles are 
currently  amortized  using  the  sum-of-the-years-digits  basis  over  10  to  15  years.  See Note  7. Goodwill  and  Other  Intangible 
Assets, for additional information. 

83 

 
 
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Bank Owned Life Insurance 

The Company invests in bank owned life insurance (“BOLI”) policies that provide earnings to help cover the cost of employee 
benefit plans. The Company is the owner and beneficiary of the life insurance policies it purchased directly on a chosen group 
of employees. The policies are carried on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet at their cash surrender value and are subject 
to regulatory capital requirements. The determination of the cash surrender value includes a full evaluation of the contractual 
terms  of  each  policy  and  assumes  the  surrender  of  policies  on  an  individual-life  by  individual-life  basis.  Additionally,  the 
Company periodically reviews the creditworthiness of the insurance companies that have underwritten the policies. Earnings 
accruing to the Company are derived from the general account investments of the insurance companies. Increases in the net cash 
surrender value of BOLI policies and insurance proceeds received are not taxable and are recorded in noninterest income in the 
consolidated statements of income. 

Repurchase Agreements 

Securities  sold  under  agreements  to  repurchase  are  secured  borrowings  treated  as  financing  activities  and  are  carried  at  the 
amounts at which the securities will be subsequently reacquired as specified in the respective agreements. 

Stock-Based Compensation 

The  Company  accounts  for  stock-based  compensation  under  the  provisions  of  ASC  Topic  718,  “Compensation  -  Stock 
Compensation.” Under this accounting guidance, fair value is established as the measurement objective in accounting for share-
based payment awards and requires the application of a fair value based measurement method in accounting for compensation 
costs,  which  is  recognized  over  the  requisite  service  period.  The  impact  of  forfeitures  of  share-based  payment  awards  on 
compensation  expense  is  recognized  as  forfeitures  occur.  See Note  14. Stock-Based  Compensation,  for  further  disclosures 
regarding stock-based compensation. 

Off-Balance Sheet Credit-Related Financial Instruments 

The Company accounts for its guarantees in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 460, “Guarantees.” In the ordinary 
course  of  business,  the  Company  has  entered  into  commitments  to  extend  credit,  including  commitments  under  credit  card 
agreements, commercial letters of credit and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are 
funded. 

Derivative Financial Instruments 

ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging,” requires that all derivatives be recognized as assets or liabilities in the balance sheet 
at fair value. Derivatives executed with the same counterparty are generally subject to master netting arrangements, however, 
fair value amounts recognized for derivative financial instruments and fair value amounts recognized for the right/obligation to 
reclaim/return cash collateral are not offset for financial reporting purposes. 

In the course of its business operations, the Company is exposed to certain risks, including interest rate, liquidity and credit risk. 
The Company manages its risks through the use of derivative financial instruments, primarily through management of exposure 
due to the receipt or payment of future cash amounts based on interest rates. The Company’s derivative financial instruments 
manage the differences in the timing, amount and duration of expected cash receipts and payments. 

Derivatives which are designated and qualify as a hedge of the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows, or other 
types of forecasted transactions, are considered cash flow hedges. The effective portion of the derivative’s gain or loss is initially 
reported  as  a  component  of  other  comprehensive  income  and  subsequently  reclassified  into  earnings  when  the  forecasted 
transaction affects earnings or when the hedge is terminated. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss is reported in earnings 
immediately. 

In applying hedge accounting for derivatives, the Company establishes a method for assessing the effectiveness of the hedging 
derivative and a measurement approach for determining the ineffective aspect of the hedge upon the inception of the hedge. 
These  methods  are  consistent  with  the  Company’s  approach  to  managing  risk. Note  12. Derivative  Financial  Instruments, 
describes the derivative instruments currently used by the Company and discloses how these derivatives impact the Company’s 
financial position and results of operations. 

84 

 
 
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Income Taxes 

The  provision  for  income  taxes  is  based  on  amounts  reported  in  the  consolidated  statements  of  income  after  exclusion  of 
nontaxable income such as interest on state and municipal securities. Also, certain items of income and expenses are recognized 
in different time periods for financial statement purposes than for income tax purposes. Thus, provisions for deferred taxes are 
recorded in recognition of such temporary differences. 

Deferred taxes are determined utilizing a liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary 
differences  and  deferred  tax  liabilities  are  recognized  for  taxable  temporary  differences.  Temporary  differences  are  the 
differences  between  the  reported  amounts  of  assets  and  liabilities  and  their  tax  bases.  Deferred  tax  assets  are  reduced  by  a 
valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax 
assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the 
date of enactment. 

The Company has adopted accounting guidance related to accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, which sets out a consistent 
framework to determine the appropriate level of tax reserves to maintain for uncertain tax positions. 

The Company recognizes interest and penalties on income taxes as a component of income tax expense. 

Revenue Recognition 

The Company recognizes revenue in the consolidated statements of income as it is earned and when collectability is reasonably 
assured. The primary source of revenue is interest income from interest-earning assets, which is recognized on the accrual basis 
of accounting using the effective interest method. The recognition of revenues from interest-earning assets is based upon formulas 
from underlying loan agreements, securities contracts, or other similar contracts. Noninterest income is recognized on the accrual 
basis of accounting as services are provided or as transactions occur. Noninterest income includes fees from deposit accounts, 
merchant  services,  automated  teller  machine  (“ATM”)  and  debit  card  fees,  servicing  fees,  interchange  fees,  and  other 
miscellaneous services and transactions. 

Earnings Per Share 

Basic earnings per share is calculated using the two-class method. The two-class method is an earnings allocation formula that 
determines  earnings  per  share  separately  for  common  stock  and  participating  securities  according  to  dividends  declared  and 
participation  rights  in  undistributed  earnings.  Under  this  method,  all  earnings  distributed  and  undistributed,  are  allocated  to 
participating securities and common shares based on their respective rights to receive dividends. Unvested share-based payment 
awards that contain nonforfeitable rights to dividends are considered participating securities (i.e. unvested time-vested restricted 
stock), not subject to performance based measures. 

Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing net income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number 
of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share is calculated in a manner similar to that of basic 
earnings per share except that the weighted average number of common shares outstanding is increased to include the number of 
additional common shares that would have been outstanding if all potentially dilutive common shares (such as those resulting 
from the exercise of stock options and warrants) were issued during the period, computed using the treasury stock method. 

Statements of Cash Flows 

For purposes of the statements of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash and amounts due from banks and federal 
funds sold due to the short-term nature of these items. 

Comprehensive Income  

Comprehensive income includes net income and other comprehensive income or loss, which in the case of the Company includes 
unrealized gains and losses on securities, changes in the fair value of interest rate swaps, and the reclassification of realized gains 
on AFS securities and interest rate swap terminations to net income, net of related income taxes. 

85 

 
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Acquisition Accounting 

The  Company  follows the  FASB  ASC Topic 805, “Business  Combinations” (“ASC 805”) to  determine  the  appropriate 
accounting treatment for an acquisition. ASC 805 prescribes an initial fair value screen to determine if substantially all of the fair 
value of the assets acquired is concentrated in a single asset or group of similar assets. If the initial screen test is met, the assets 
acquired represent an asset acquisition rather than a business combination. 

Loans acquired in an asset acquisitions are recorded using the cost accumulation and allocation model whereby the cost of the 
acquisition is allocated on a relative fair value basis to the assets acquired.  

Business combinations are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting. Purchased assets and assumed liabilities 
are recorded at their respective acquisition date fair values, and identifiable intangible assets are recorded at fair value. If the 
consideration given exceeds the fair value of the net assets received, goodwill is recognized. If the fair value of the net assets 
received exceeds the consideration given, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Fair values are subject to refinement for up 
to one year after the closing date of an acquisition as information relative to closing date fair values becomes available. 

Loans acquired in a business combination are recorded at their estimated fair value as of the acquisition date. The fair value of 
loans acquired is determined using a discounted cash flow model based on assumptions regarding the amount and timing of 
principal and interest prepayments, estimated payments, estimated default rates, estimated loss severity in the event of defaults, 
and current market rates. The fair value adjustment for performing acquired loans is accreted over the life of the loan using the 
effective interest method. Estimated credit losses are included in the determination of  fair value; therefore, an allowance for 
credit losses is not recorded on the acquisition date. Subsequent to acquisition, acquired performing loans are evaluated using a 
similar allowance methodology as the legacy portfolio. An allowance for credit losses is only recorded to the extent that the 
required reserves exceed the unaccreted fair value adjustment. 

The Company accounts for purchased credit deteriorated (“PCD”) assets under ASC Topic 326. The CECL estimate for PCD 
assets is recognized through the allowance for credit losses with an offset to the amortized cost basis of the PCD asset at the date 
of acquisition. Subsequent changes in the allowance for credit losses for PCD assets are recognized through a provision for credit 
losses on loans. 

Share Repurchases 

The Louisiana Business Corporation Act does not include the concept of treasury stock. Rather, shares purchased by the Company 
constitute authorized but unissued shares. Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America state that 
accounting for treasury stock shall conform to state law. The Company’s consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 
2023, 2022 and 2021 reflect this principle. The cost of shares purchased by the Company has been allocated to common stock 
and surplus balances. 

Reclassifications 

Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2022 and 2021 financial statements to conform to the 2023 presentation. 

Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023 

FASB  ASC  Topic 326 “Financial 
Instruments – Credit  Losses:  Measurement  of  Credit  Losses  on  Financial 
Instruments” Update No. 2016-13  (“ASU  2016-13”). ASU  2016-13 became  effective  for  the  Company  as  a  smaller  reporting 
company on January 1, 2023. ASU 2016-13, also referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss (“CECL”) standard, requires 
financial assets measured on an amortized cost basis, including loans and HTM debt securities, to be presented at an amount net 
of  an  allowance  for  credit  losses,  which  reflects  expected  losses  for  the  full  life  of  the  financial  asset.  Unfunded  lending 
commitments are also within the scope of this topic. See “Allowance for Credit Losses” above for additional information on the 
calculation of the allowance for credit losses under ASU 2016-13. 

The  Company  adopted  ASU  2016-13  using  the  modified  retrospective  approach  for  all loans  and off-balance  sheet  credit 
exposures measured at amortized cost, other than PCD financial assets. Results for reporting periods beginning after December 
31, 2022 are presented in accordance with ASU 2016-13 while prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with 
previously applicable GAAP.  

86 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

CECL requires the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical 
experience,  current  conditions,  and  reasonable  and  supportable  forecasts  and  requires  enhanced  disclosures  related  to  the 
significant estimates and judgments used in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of 
an organization’s portfolio. Under prior GAAP, credit losses were not recognized until the occurrence of the loss was probable, 
and entities, in general, did not attempt to estimate credit losses for the full life of financial assets. ASU 2016-13 does not specify 
the method for measuring expected credit losses, and an entity is allowed to apply methods that reasonably reflect its expectations 
of the lifetime credit loss estimate. 

ASU 2016-13 also amended the accounting model for purchased financial assets and replaced the guidance for purchased credit 
impaired (“PCI”) financial assets with the concept of PCDs. The Company used the prospective transition approach for PCD 
loans that were previously classified as PCI and accounted for under ASC 310-30, “Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with 
Deteriorated Credit Quality” (“ASC 310-30”). As permitted under ASU 2016-13, the Company did not reassess whether PCI 
assets meet the criteria of PCD assets as of the date of adoption. 

The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023, and recorded a one-time, cumulative effect adjustment as shown in the 
table below (dollars in thousands). 

Assets: 

Allowance for credit losses 
Deferred tax asset 
Remaining purchase discount on loans(1) 

Liabilities: 

Reserve for unfunded loan commitments(2) 

Stockholders’ Equity 
Retained earnings 

December 31, 
2022 

Impact of ASU 
2016-13 
Adoption 

January 1, 
2023 

  $ 

(24,364)   $ 
16,438      
(818)     

(5,865)   $ 
1,142      
422      

(30,229) 
17,580  
(396) 

372      

(6)     

366  

108,206      

(4,295)     

103,911  

(1)  For  PCD  loans,  formerly  classified  as  PCI,  the  Company  applied  the  guidance  under  CECL  using  the  prospective
transition  approach.  As  a  result,  the  Company  adjusted  the  amortized  cost  basis of  the PCD  loans  to reclassify  the
purchase discount to the allowance for credit losses on January 1, 2023. 

(2)  The allowance for credit losses on unfunded loan commitments is included in “Accrued taxes and other liabilities” in 
the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The related provision for credit losses on unfunded loan commitments
is included in “Provision for credit losses” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for the year ended 
December 31, 2023. 

In addition, ASU 2016-13 amends the accounting for credit losses on available for sale (“AFS”) securities, requiring expected 
credit losses on AFS securities to be recorded in an allowance for credit losses rather than as a write-down of the securities’ 
amortized cost basis when management does not intend to sell or believes that it is not more likely than not that they will be 
required to sell the securities prior to recovery of the securities’ amortized cost basis. The Company’s AFS and HTM securities 
portfolios were not materially impacted by the adoption of ASU 2016-13 due to the composition of the portfolios, which consists 
primarily of U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations securities and mortgage-backed securities. Due to the 
nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current interest rate environment, the Company determined that the 
declines in the fair values of the HTM and AFS securities portfolio were not attributable to credit losses. The Company will 
apply the provisions of ASU 2016-13 to debt securities that have an other-than-temporary impairment on a prospective basis. 
Accordingly, there was no adjustment made to the amortized cost basis upon adoption. The adoption of ASU 2016-13 did not 
have a significant impact on the Company’s regulatory capital ratios.  

FASB ASC Topic 326 “Financial Instruments – Credit Losses, Troubled Debt Restructurings and Vintage Disclosures” Update 
No. 2022-02 (“ASU 2022-02”). ASU 2022-02 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2023 and is applied prospectively. 
ASU 2022-02 amends Topic 326 to eliminate the accounting guidance for troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) by creditors 
that have adopted ASU 2016-13 and, instead, requires that an entity evaluate whether the modification represents a new loan or 
a continuation of an existing loan. The amendment also requires that public business entities disclose current-period gross charge-
offs by year of origination for financing receivables and net investments in leases. The adoption of ASU 2022-02 did not have a 
material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 

87 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
      
        
        
  
    
      
        
        
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

FASB  ASC  Topic 848 “Reference  Rate  Reform:  Facilitation  of  the  Effects  of  Reference  Rate  Reform  on  Financial 
Reporting” Update No. 2020-04 (“ASU 2020-04”) and  FASB  ASC Topic 848 “Reference  Rate  Reform:  Deferral of  the Sunset 
Date” Update No. 2022-06  (“ASU  2022-06”). In March  2020, the  FASB  issued  ASU 2020-04, which  is  intended  to  provide 
temporary optional expedients and exceptions to the GAAP guidance on contract modifications and hedge accounting to ease the 
financial reporting burdens related to the expected market transition from the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) and 
other interbank offered rates to alternative reference rates. ASU 2020-04 became effective as of March 12, 2020 and could be 
adopted  any  time  during  the  period  of  January  1,  2020  through  December  31,  2022.  In December  2022, the  FASB  issued 
ASU 2022-06, which deferred the sunset date of ASU 2020-04 from December 31, 2022 to December 31, 2024. The Company 
implemented a plan to transition all loans and other financial instruments, including certain indebtedness, with attributes that are 
either  directly  or  indirectly  influenced  by  LIBOR  to  its  preferred  replacement  index, the  Secured  Overnight  Financing  Rate 
(“SOFR”). The  Company  has  transitioned  all  loans  and  certain  indebtedness. The  adoption  of  ASU 2022-06 did  not  have  a 
material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 

Recent Accounting Pronouncements 

This  section  briefly  describes  accounting  standards  that  have  been  issued,  but  are  not  yet  adopted,  that  could  impact  the 
Company’s financial statements. 

FASB “Disclosure Improvements” Update No. 2023-06 (“ASU 2023-06”). In October 2023, the FASB issued ASU 2023-06, 
which amends the disclosure or presentation requirements related to various topics. The amendment is intended to align U.S. 
GAAP with the SEC’s regulations. ASU 2023-06 is required to be applied prospectively, and early adoption is prohibited. For 
reporting entities subject to the SEC’s existing disclosure requirements, the effective dates of ASU 2023-06 will be the date on 
which the SEC’s removal of that related disclosure requirement from Regulation S-X or Regulation S-K becomes effective. If 
by June 30, 2027, the SEC has not removed the applicable requirement from Regulation S-X or Regulation S-K, the pending 
content of the related amendment will be removed and will not become effective for any entities. ASU 2023-06 is not expected 
to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 

FASB ASC Topic 740 “Income Taxes - Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures” Update No. 2023-09 (“ASU 2023-09”). In 
December  2023,  the  FASB  issued ASU  2023-09,  which  enhances  the  transparency  and  decision  usefulness  of  income  tax 
disclosures. ASU 2023-09 requires disclosure of additional categories of information about federal, state and foreign income 
taxes in the rate reconciliation table and requires companies to provide more information about the reconciling items in some 
categories if a quantitative threshold is met. The adoption of ASU 2023-09 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 
15, 2024 and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 

88 

 
 
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 2. INVESTMENT SECURITIES 

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities classified as AFS are summarized below as of the dates 
presented (dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies 

and corporations 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

December 31, 2022 
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies 

and corporations 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

Amortized 
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 

     Fair Value   

  $ 

  $ 

20,383    $ 
18,768      
30,097      
274,950      
75,085      
419,283    $ 

100    $ 
11      
—      
14      
208      
333    $ 

(440)   $ 
(2,076)     
(3,741)     
(42,919)     
(8,522)     
(57,698)   $ 

20,043  
16,703  
26,356  
232,045  
66,771  
361,918  

Amortized 
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 

     Fair Value   

  $ 

  $ 

30,370    $ 
21,098      
33,477      
298,867      
83,504      
467,316    $ 

134    $ 
7      
—      
10      
179      
330    $ 

(699)   $ 
(2,727)     
(3,535)     
(47,026)     
(8,492)     
(62,479)   $ 

29,805  
18,378  
29,942  
251,851  
75,191  
405,167  

The Company calculates realized gains and losses on sales of debt securities under the specific identification method. Proceeds 
from sales of investment securities classified as AFS and gross gains and losses are summarized below for the periods presented 
(dollars in thousands). 

Proceeds from sales 
Gross gains 
Gross losses 

  $ 
  $ 
  $ 

14,974    $ 
2    $ 
(325)   $ 

—    $ 
—    $ 
—    $ 

137,803  
2,323  
(2) 

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities classified as HTM are summarized below as of the dates 
presented (dollars in thousands). 

Twelve months ended December 31, 
2022 

2021 

2023 

December 31, 2023 
Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

December 31, 2022 
Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

Amortized 
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

  $ 

18,163    $ 
2,309      
20,472    $ 

314    $ 
—      
314    $ 

     Fair Value   
18,395  
2,118  
20,513  

(82)   $ 
(191)     
(273)   $ 

Amortized 
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

  $ 

5,538    $ 
2,767      
8,305    $ 

1    $ 
—      
1    $ 

89 

     Fair Value   
5,412  
2,510  
7,922  

(127)   $ 
(257)     
(384)   $ 

 
 
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
  
  
    
    
    
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Securities are classified in the consolidated balance sheets according to management’s intent. The Company had no securities 
classified as trading as of December 31, 2023 or December 31, 2022. 

The approximate fair value of AFS securities and unrealized losses, aggregated by investment category and length of time that 
the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, are summarized below as of the dates presented 
(dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. 
government agencies and corporations 

Obligations of state and political 

subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

  $ 

   Less than 12 Months       12 Months or More 

Total 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

1,268    $ 

(7)   $ 

9,284    $ 

(433)   $ 

10,552    $ 

(440) 

—      
468      
2,705      
1,085      
5,526    $ 

15,425      
—      
(28)     
25,888      
(421)      228,415      
50,271      
(35)     
(491)   $  329,283    $ 

(2,076)     
(3,713)     

15,425      
26,356      
(42,498)      231,120      
51,356      
(57,207)   $  334,809    $ 

(8,487)     

(2,076) 
(3,741) 
(42,919) 
(8,522) 
(57,698) 

December 31, 2022 
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. 
government agencies and corporations 

Obligations of state and political 

subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

   Less than 12 Months       12 Months or More 

Total 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

16,017    $ 

(688)   $ 

1,013    $ 

(11)   $ 

17,030    $ 

(699) 

13,695      
19,606      
     134,419      
27,181      
  $  210,918    $ 

(1,427)     
(1,170)     

4,524      
10,085      
(18,122)      116,132      
32,432      
(24,039)   $  164,186    $ 

(2,632)     

(1,300)     
(2,365)     

18,219      
29,691      
(28,904)      250,551      
59,613      
(38,440)   $  375,104    $ 

(5,860)     

(2,727) 
(3,535) 
(47,026) 
(8,492) 
(62,479) 

At December  31,  2023,  698 of  the  Company’s  AFS  debt  securities  had  unrealized  losses  totaling  14.7%  of  the  individual 
securities’ amortized cost basis and 13.8% of the Company’s total amortized cost basis of the AFS investment securities portfolio. 
At such date, 682 of the 698 securities had been in a continuous loss position for over 12 months. 

The approximate fair value of HTM securities, and unrealized losses, aggregated by investment category and length of time that 
the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, are summarized below as of the dates presented 
(dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 
Obligations of state and political 

subdivisions 

Residential mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

   Less than 12 Months       12 Months or More 

Total 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

  $ 

—     $ 
—       
—     $ 

—    $ 
—      
—    $ 

3,064    $ 
2,118      
5,182    $ 

(82)   $ 
(191)     
(273)   $ 

3,064    $ 
2,118      
5,182    $ 

(82) 
(191) 
(273) 

December 31, 2022 
Obligations of state and political 

subdivisions 

Residential mortgage-backed securities 

Total 

   Less than 12 Months       12 Months or More 

Total 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

Unrealized 
Losses 

  $ 

  $ 

3,536    $ 
2,510      
6,046    $ 

(127)   $ 
(257)     
(384)   $ 

—     $ 
—       
—     $ 

—    $ 
—      
—    $ 

3,536    $ 
2,510      
6,046    $ 

(127) 
(257) 
(384) 

90 

 
 
   
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Unrealized losses are generally due to changes in market interest rates. The Company has the intent to hold these securities either 
until maturity or a forecasted recovery, and it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell the securities before 
the recovery of their amortized cost basis. Due to the nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current interest 
rate environment, the Company determined that these declines were not attributable to credit losses at December 31, 2023 and 
2022. 

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment debt securities, by contractual maturity, are shown below as of the 
dates presented (dollars in thousands). Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities due to mortgage-backed securities 
whereby borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties and certain 
callable bonds whereby the issuer has the option to call the bonds prior to contractual maturity. 

Securities Available  
For Sale 

Securities Held to 
Maturity 

December 31, 2023 
Due within one year 
Due after one year through five years 
Due after five years through ten years 
Due after ten years 

Total debt securities 

December 31, 2022 
Due within one year 
Due after one year through five years 
Due after five years through ten years 
Due after ten years 

Total debt securities 

Amortized 
Cost 

     Fair Value     

Amortized 
Cost 

  $ 

  $ 

1,034    $ 
28,620      
43,634      
345,995      
419,283    $ 

1,027    $ 
27,623      
39,971      
293,297      
361,918    $ 

     Fair Value   
961  
2,582  
4,621  
12,349  
20,513  

960    $ 
2,556      
4,647      
12,309      
20,472    $ 

Securities Available  
For Sale 

Securities Held to 
Maturity 

Amortized 
Cost 

     Fair Value     

Amortized 
Cost 

  $ 

  $ 

1,082    $ 
32,452      
52,093      
381,689      
467,316    $ 

1,072    $ 
31,394      
48,229      
324,472      
405,167    $ 

     Fair Value   
915  
961  
3,536  
2,510  
7,922  

915    $ 
960      
3,663      
2,767      
8,305    $ 

Accrued interest receivable on the Company’s investment securities was $1.7 million at both December 31, 2023 and December 
31, 2022, and is included in “Accrued interest receivable” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. 

At December 31, 2023, securities with a carrying value of $296.2 million were pledged to secure certain deposits, borrowings, 
and other liabilities, compared to $165.7 million in pledged securities at December 31, 2022. 

NOTE 3. LOANS AND ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES 

The Company’s loan portfolio consists of the following categories of loans as of the dates presented (dollars in thousands). 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

91 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

190,371    $ 
413,786      
105,946      
7,651      
937,708      
1,655,462      
543,421      
11,736      
2,210,619    $ 

201,633  
401,377  
81,812  
12,877  
958,243  
1,655,942  
435,093  
13,732  
2,104,767  

  $ 

  $ 

 
 
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Unamortized premiums and discounts on loans, included in the total loans balances above, were $0.2 million and $0.8 million at 
December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively. Unearned income, or deferred fees, on loans was $1.1 million and 
$1.3 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, and is also included in the total loans balance in the 
table above.  

The table below provides an analysis of the aging of loans as of December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands). 

30 - 59 
Days Past 
Due 

December 31, 2023 
60 - 89 
Days Past 
Due 

90 Days or 
More Past 
Due 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real 

estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

   Current 
  $ 

189,746    $ 
406,014      
105,946      
7,651      
937,272      

     1,646,629      
542,206      
11,552      
  $  2,200,387    $ 

—    $ 
3,031      
—      
—      
48      

3,079      
259      
57      
3,395    $ 

55    $ 
1,720      
—      
—      
359      

2,134      
488      
82      
2,704    $ 

> 90 Days 
and 
Accruing    
—  
—  
—  
—  
—  

Total 
190,371    $ 
413,786      
105,946      
7,651      
937,708      

570    $ 
3,021      
—      
—      
29      

3,620       1,655,462      
543,421      
11,736      
4,133    $  2,210,619    $ 

468      
45      

—  
—  
—  
—  

The table below provides an analysis of nonaccrual loans as of December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 (dollars in 
thousands). 

December 31, 2023 

Nonaccrual 
with No 
Allowance 
for Credit 
Loss 

Nonaccrual 
with an 
Allowance 
for Credit 
Loss 

Total 
Nonaccrual 
Loans 

December 
31, 2022(1)    

Total 
Nonaccrual 
Loans 

Interest 
Income 
Recognized 
on 
Nonaccrual 
Loans 

  $ 

  $ 

577    $ 
2,937      
—      
—      
216      
3,730      
59      
74      
3,863    $ 

212    $ 
1,241      
—      
—      
—      
1,453      
409      
45      
1,907    $ 

789    $ 
4,178      
—      
—      
216      
5,183      
468      
119      
5,770    $ 

42    $ 
26      
—      
10      
416      
494      
997      
15      
1,506    $ 

372  
1,207  
—  
62  
6,032  
7,673  
2,183  
130  
9,986  

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

(1)  Nonaccrual loans previously reported as of December 31, 2022 excluded $0.5 million of nonaccrual acquired impaired

loans being accounted for under ASC 310-30. 

92 

 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The table below provides an analysis of the aging of loans as of December 31, 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Accruing 

December 31, 2022 

30-59 
Days Past 
Due 

60-89 
Days Past 
Due 

90 Days 
or More 
Past Due     Nonaccrual    

Total Past 
Due & 
Nonaccrual    

Acquired 
Impaired 
Loans 

Total 
Loans 

   Current      

  $  201,048    $ 
     394,846      
81,812      
12,601      
     951,908      

101    $ 
2,614      
—      
152      
181      

—    $ 
1,220      
—      
62      
22      

112    $ 
1,188      
—      
—      
—      

372    $ 
1,207      
—      
62      
5,523      

585     $ 
6,229       
—       
276       
5,726       

—    $  201,633  
302       401,377  
81,812  
—      
—      
12,877  
609       958,243  

Construction and 
development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 
Total mortgage 
loans on real 
estate 

    1,642,215      
Commercial and industrial       432,438      
13,347      
Consumer 
  $ 2,088,000    $ 

Total loans 

3,048      
406      
171      
3,625    $ 

1,304      
15      
27      
1,346    $ 

1,300      
51      
—      
1,351    $ 

7,164      
2,183      
130      
9,477    $ 

12,816       
2,655       
328       
15,799     $ 

911      1,655,942  
—       435,093  
13,732  
57      
968    $ 2,104,767  

Nonaccrual and Past Due Loans  

Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments 
were due. Loans are placed on nonaccrual status when, in management’s opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment 
obligations  as  they  become  due,  as  well  as  when  required  by  regulatory  provisions.  In  determining  whether  or not a 
borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations for each class of loans, the borrower’s debt service capacity is considered 
through the analysis of current financial information, if available, and/or current information with regard to the collateral position. 
Regulatory provisions would typically require the placement of a loan on nonaccrual status if (i) principal or interest has been in 
default for a period of 90 days or more unless the loan is both well secured and in the process of collection or (ii) full payment 
of principal and interest is not expected. Loans may be placed on nonaccrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are 
considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income on nonaccrual 
loans is recognized only to the extent that cash payments are received in excess of principal due. A loan may be returned to 
accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and payment of future principal 
and  interest  amounts  contractually  due  are  reasonably  assured,  which  is  typically  evidenced  by  a  sustained  period  (at 
least six months) of repayment performance by the borrower. Interest income recognized on nonaccrual loans shown in the table 
above for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily attributable to the resolution of one oil and gas loan relationship.  

Collateral Dependent Loans 

Collateral dependent loans are loans for which the repayments, on the basis of the Company’s assessment at the reporting date, 
are expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral and the borrower is experiencing financial 
difficulty. Loans that do not share risk characteristics are excluded from the loan pools and evaluated on an individual basis, and 
the Company has determined to evaluate collateral dependent loans individually for impairment. The allowance for credit losses 
for collateral dependent loans is measured based on the difference between the fair value of the collateral and the amortized cost 
basis of the asset as of the measurement date. When repayment is expected to be from the operation of the collateral, expected 
credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized cost basis of the financial asset exceeds the present value of 
expected  cash  flows  from  the  operation  of  the  collateral.  When  repayment  is  expected  to  be  from  the  sale  of  the  collateral, 
expected credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized costs basis of the financial asset exceeds the fair value 
of the underlying collateral less estimated cost to sell. The Company’s collateral dependent loans include all nonaccrual loans 
shown in the table above at December 31, 2023. The types of collateral that secure collateral dependent loans are discussed under 
“Portfolio Segment Risk Factors” below.  

93 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
      
  
      
  
      
  
  
  
    
    
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Portfolio Segment Risk Factors 

The following describes the risk characteristics relevant to each of the Company’s loan portfolio segments. 

Construction and Development - Construction and development loans are generally made for the purpose of acquisition and 
development of land to be improved through the construction of commercial and residential buildings. The successful repayment 
of these types of loans is generally dependent upon a commitment for permanent financing from the Company, or from the sale 
of the constructed property. These loans carry more risk than commercial or residential real estate loans due to the dynamics of 
construction projects, changes in interest rates, the long-term financing market, and state and local government regulations. One 
such risk is that loan funds are advanced upon the security of the property under construction, which is of uncertain value prior 
to the completion of construction. Thus, it is more difficult to evaluate accurately the total loan funds required to complete a 
project and to calculate related loan-to-value ratios. The Company attempts to minimize the risks associated with construction 
lending  by  limiting  loan-to-value  ratios  as  described  above.  In  addition,  as  to  speculative  development  loans,  the  Company 
generally makes such loans only to borrowers that have a positive pre-existing relationship with us. The Company manages risk 
by  using  specific  underwriting  policies  and  procedures  for  these  types  of  loans  and  by  avoiding  excessive  concentrations  in 
any one business  or  industry.  Construction  and  development  loans  are  primarily  secured  by  residential  and  commercial 
properties, which are under construction and/or redevelopment. 

1-4 Family - The 1-4 family portfolio mainly consists of residential mortgage loans to consumers to finance a primary residence. 
The majority of these loans are secured by first liens on residential properties located in the Company’s market areas and carry 
risks associated with the creditworthiness of the borrower and changes in the value of the collateral and loan-to-value-ratios. The 
Company manages these risks through policies and procedures such as limiting loan-to-value ratios at origination, employing 
experienced underwriting personnel, requiring standards for appraisers, and not making subprime loans. In the third quarter of 
2023, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business. 

Multifamily -  Multifamily  loans  are  normally  made  to  real  estate  investors  to  support  permanent  financing  for  multifamily 
residential income producing properties that rely on the successful operation of the property for repayment. This management 
mainly involves property maintenance and collection of rents due from tenants. This type of lending carries a lower level of risk, 
as compared to other commercial lending. In addition, underwriting requirements for multifamily properties are stricter than for 
other  nonowner-occupied  property  types.  The  Company  manages  this  risk  by  avoiding  concentrations  with  any  particular 
customer. Multifamily loans are primarily secured by first liens on multifamily real estate. 

Farmland - Farmland loans are often for land improvements related to agricultural endeavors and may include construction of 
new specialized facilities. These loans are usually repaid through the conversion to permanent financing, or if scheduled loan 
amortization begins, for the long-term benefit of the borrower’s ongoing operations. Underwriting generally involves intensive 
analysis  of  the  financial  strength  of  the  borrower  and  guarantor,  liquidation  value  of  the  subject  collateral,  the  associated 
unguaranteed exposure, and any available secondary sources of repayment, with the greatest emphasis given to a borrower’s 
capacity to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by Bank policies. Farmland loans are primarily secured by raw 
land. 

Commercial  Real  Estate -  Commercial  real  estate  loans  are  extensions  of  credit  secured  by  owner  occupied  and  nonowner-
occupied collateral. Underwriting generally involves intensive analysis of the financial strength of the borrower and guarantor, 
liquidation  value  of  the  subject  collateral,  the  associated  unguaranteed  exposure,  and  any  available  secondary  sources  of 
repayment, with the greatest emphasis given to a borrower’s capacity to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by 
Bank policies. Commercial real estate loans typically depend on the successful operation and management of the businesses that 
occupy these properties or the financial stability of tenants occupying the properties. Nonowner-occupied commercial real estate 
loans typically are dependent, in large part, on the owner’s ability to rent the property and the ability of the tenants to pay rent, 
whereas  owner-occupied  commercial  real  estate  loans  typically  are  dependent,  in  large  part,  on  the  success  of  the  owner’s 
business. General  market  conditions  and  economic  activity may impact  the  performance  of  these  types  of  loans,  including 
fluctuations in the value of real estate, new job creation trends, and tenant vacancy rates. The Company attempts to limit risk by 
analyzing  a  borrower’s  cash  flow  and  collateral  value  on  an  ongoing  basis.  The  Company  also  typically  requires  personal 
guarantees from the principal owners of the property, supported by a review of their personal financial statements, as an additional 
means  of  mitigating  our  risk.  The  Company  manages  risk  by  avoiding  concentrations 
in  any one business  or 
industry. Commercial  real  estate  loans  are  primarily  secured  by  office  and  industrial  buildings,  warehouses,  retail  shopping 
facilities and various special purpose commercial properties. 

94 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Commercial and Industrial - Commercial and industrial loans receive similar underwriting treatment as commercial real estate 
loans in that the repayment source is analyzed to determine its ability to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by 
Bank policies. Repayment of these loans generally comes from the generation of cash flow as the result of the borrower’s business 
operations. Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those associated with commercial real estate lending or 
construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by equipment or other business assets (including real 
estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness and projected 
cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the general business conditions of the local economy and the borrower’s 
ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to repay us under the agreed upon terms 
and conditions, are the chief considerations when assessing the risk of a commercial loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is 
considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment and other business assets may, among other things, be obsolete 
or of limited resale value. The Company actively monitors certain financial measures of the borrower, including advance rate, 
cash  flow,  collateral  value  and  other  appropriate  credit  factors. Commercial  and  industrial  loans  also  include  public  finance 
loans made to governmental entities, which can be taxable or tax-exempt, and are generally repaid using pledged revenue sources 
including  income  tax,  property  tax,  sales  tax,  and  utility  revenue,  among  other  sources. Commercial  and  industrial  loans are 
primarily secured by accounts receivable, inventory and equipment. 

Consumer -  Consumer  loans  are  offered  by  the  Company  in  order  to  provide  a  full  range  of  retail  financial  services  to  its 
customers  and  include  auto  loans,  credit  cards,  and  other  consumer  installment  loans.  Typically,  the  Company  evaluates  the 
borrower’s repayment ability through a review of credit scores and an evaluation of debt to income ratios. Repayment of consumer 
loans  depends  upon  key  consumer  economic  measures  and  upon  the  borrower’s  financial  stability  and  is  more  likely  to  be 
adversely affected by divorce, job loss, illness and personal hardships than repayment of other loans. A shortfall in the value of 
any  collateral also may pose a  risk of  loss  to  the  Company for  these  types of  loans.  Consumer  loans  include  loans primarily 
secured by vehicles and unsecured loans. 

Refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023 for loan pools used for 
modeling purposes, which are aggregated into the portfolio segments shown above. 

Concentrations of Credit 

Substantially all of the Company’s loans and commitments have been granted to customers in the Company’s market areas in 
south Louisiana, southeast Texas and Alabama. The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution 
of loans outstanding. 

95 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Credit Quality Indicators 

Loans are categorized into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt, such 
as current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic 
trends, among other factors. The following definitions are utilized for risk ratings, which are consistent with the definitions used 
in supervisory guidance: 

Pass -  Loans not meeting  the  criteria  below  are  considered  pass.  These  loans  have  high  credit  characteristics  and  financial 
strength. The borrowers at least generate profits and cash flow that are in line with peer and industry standards and have debt 
service coverage ratios above loan covenants and our policy guidelines. For some of these loans, a guaranty from a financially 
capable party mitigates characteristics of the borrower that might otherwise result in a lower grade. 

Special Mention - Loans classified as special mention possess some credit deficiencies that need to be corrected to avoid a greater 
risk of default in the future. For example, financial ratios relating to the borrower may have deteriorated. Often, a special mention 
categorization is temporary while certain factors are analyzed or matters addressed before the loan is re-categorized as either pass 
or substandard. 

Substandard - Loans classified as substandard are inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the 
borrower or the liquidation value of any collateral. If deficiencies are not addressed, it is likely that this category of loan will 
result in the Bank incurring a loss. Where a borrower has been unable to adjust to industry or general economic conditions, the 
borrower’s loan is often categorized as substandard. 

Doubtful -  Loans  classified  as  doubtful  have  all  the  weaknesses  inherent  in  those  classified  as  substandard,  with  the  added 
characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and 
values, highly questionable and improbable. 

Loss -  Loans  classified  as  loss  are  considered  uncollectible  and  of  such  little  value  that  their  continuance  as  recorded  assets 
is not warranted.  This  classification  does not mean  that  the  assets  have  absolutely no recovery  or  salvage  value,  but  rather  it 
is not practical or desirable to defer writing off these assets. 

96 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The  table  below  presents  the  Company’s  loan  portfolio  by  year  of  origination,  category,  and  credit  quality  indicator  as  of 
December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands). Loans acquired are shown in the table by origination year. The Company had an 
immaterial amount of revolving loans converted to term loans at December 31, 2023. 

Construction and development 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total construction and development 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

1-4 Family 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total 1-4 family 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Multifamily 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total multifamily 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Farmland 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total farmland 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Commercial real estate 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total commercial real estate 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Commercial and industrial 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total commercial and industrial 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Consumer 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total consumer 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

Total loans 
Pass 
Special Mention 
Substandard 
Total loans 

Current-period gross charge-offs 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

2023 

2022 

2021 

2020 

2019 

Prior 

Revolving 
Loans 

Total 

December 31, 2023 

51,811    $ 
3,063      
—      
54,874    $ 

83,668    $ 
—      
293      
83,961    $ 

25,169    $ 
767      
489      
26,425    $ 

2,661    $ 
—      
—      
2,661    $ 

935    $ 
—      
—      
935    $ 

4,012    $ 
—      
7      
4,019    $ 

17,496    $ 
—      
—      
17,496    $ 

185,752  
3,830  
789  
190,371  

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—  

43,047    $ 
—      
179      
43,226    $ 

101,479    $ 
—      
1,949      
103,428    $ 

85,340    $ 
477      
257      
86,074    $ 

58,926    $ 
—      
162      
59,088    $ 

26,836    $ 
—      
963      
27,799    $ 

59,115    $ 
—      
1,510      
60,625    $ 

33,454    $ 
—      
92      
33,546    $ 

408,197  
477  
5,112  
413,786  

(22)   $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

(21)   $ 

(3)   $ 

—    $ 

(46) 

7,839    $ 
—      
—      
7,839    $ 

64,932    $ 
—      
—      
64,932    $ 

16,300    $ 
—      
—      
16,300    $ 

5,045    $ 
—      
—      
5,045    $ 

633    $ 
—      
—      
633    $ 

6,969    $ 
4,068      
—      
11,037    $ 

160    $ 
—      
—      
160    $ 

101,878  
4,068  
—  
105,946  

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—  

1,762    $ 
—      
—      
1,762    $ 

1,347    $ 
—      
—      
1,347    $ 

727    $ 
—      
—      
727    $ 

936    $ 
—      
—      
936    $ 

775    $ 
—      
—      
775    $ 

1,013    $ 
—      
76      
1,089    $ 

1,015    $ 
—      
—      
1,015    $ 

7,575  
—  
76  
7,651  

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—  

76,043    $ 
—      
—      
76,043    $ 

269,311    $ 
—      
—      
269,311    $ 

218,780    $ 
181      
—      
218,961    $ 

175,604    $ 
—      
1,474      
177,078    $ 

82,909    $ 
—      
172      
83,081    $ 

105,083    $ 
—      
3,233      
108,316    $ 

4,731    $ 
—      
187      
4,918    $ 

932,461  
181  
5,066  
937,708  

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

—    $ 

(2)   $ 

(25)   $ 

—    $ 

(27) 

60,123    $ 
—      
49      
60,172    $ 

139,543    $ 
—      
78      
139,621    $ 

31,459    $ 
—      
154      
31,613    $ 

14,244    $ 
—      
7      
14,251    $ 

7,439    $ 
—      
416      
7,855    $ 

14,290    $ 
—      
8      
14,298    $ 

273,208    $ 
2,289      
114      
275,611    $ 

540,306  
2,289  
826  
543,421  

—    $ 

—    $ 

(190)   $ 

—    $ 

(7)   $ 

(31)   $ 

(193)   $ 

(421) 

4,881    $ 
—      
4      
4,885    $ 

2,303    $ 
—      
7      
2,310    $ 

1,611    $ 
—      
1      
1,612    $ 

734    $ 
—      
14      
748    $ 

250    $ 
—      
4      
254    $ 

1,130    $ 
—      
139      
1,269    $ 

658    $ 
—      
—      
658    $ 

11,567  
—  
169  
11,736  

(119)   $ 

(22)   $ 

(10)   $ 

(12)   $ 

(5)   $ 

(58)   $ 

(22)   $ 

(248) 

245,506    $ 
3,063      
232      
248,801    $ 

662,583    $ 
—      
2,327      
664,910    $ 

379,386    $ 
1,425      
901      
381,712    $ 

258,150    $ 
—      
1,657      
259,807    $ 

119,777    $ 
—      
1,555      
121,332    $ 

191,612    $ 
4,068      
4,973      
200,653    $ 

330,722    $ 
2,289      
393      
333,404    $ 

2,187,736  
10,845  
12,038  
2,210,619  

(141)   $ 

(22)   $ 

(200)   $ 

(12)   $ 

(35)   $ 

(117)   $ 

(215)   $ 

(742) 

97 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
  
       
          
          
         
         
         
          
          
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
    
    
  
       
         
         
         
         
         
         
         
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The table below presents the Company’s loan portfolio by category and credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2022 (dollars 
in thousands) under the previous incurred loss methodology. 

December 31, 2022 

Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Multifamily 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 

Total loans 

Special 
Mention      Substandard      Doubtful      

  $

Pass 
198,967    $ 
399,143      
81,812      
12,815      
942,927      
     1,635,664      
427,430      
13,636      
  $ 2,076,730    $ 

1,593    $ 
—      
—      
—      
6,101      
7,694      
5,140      
—      
12,834    $ 

1,073    $ 
2,234      
—      
62      
9,215      
12,584      
2,336      
96      
15,016    $ 

Total 
201,633  
—    $ 
401,377  
—      
81,812  
—      
12,877  
—      
—      
958,243  
—       1,655,942  
435,093  
187      
—      
13,732  
187    $  2,104,767  

The Company had no loans that were classified as doubtful or loss at December 31, 2023. The Company had no loans that were 
classified as loss at December 31, 2022. 

Loan Participations and Sold Loans 

Loan participations and whole loans sold to and serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated balance 
sheets. The balances of the participations and whole loans sold were $25.9 million and $16.9 million as of December 31, 2023 
and  2022,  respectively.  The  unpaid  principal  balances  of  these  loans  were  approximately  $99.8 million  and  $92.9 million  at 
December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively. 

Loans to Related Parties 

In  the  ordinary  course  of  business,  the  Company  makes  loans  to  related  parties  including  its  executive  officers,  principal 
shareholders, directors and their immediate family members, as well as to companies in which these individuals are principal 
owners. Loans outstanding to such related party borrowers amounted to approximately $46.0 million and $97.0 million as of 
December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively. No related party loans were classified as nonperforming or nonaccrual 
at December 31, 2023 or December 31, 2022. 

The table below shows the aggregate principal balance of loans to such related parties for the years ended December 31, 2023 
and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Balance, beginning of period 
New loans/changes in relationship 
Repayments/changes in relationship 
Balance, end of period 

Allowance for Credit Losses 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

  $ 

  $ 

96,977    $ 
2,570      
(53,547)     
46,000    $ 

97,606  
14,570  
(15,199) 
96,977  

The Company made the accounting policy election to exclude accrued interest receivable from the amortized cost of loans and 
the  estimate  of 
loans  was 
$12.7 million and $10.8 million at December  31,  2023 and December  31,  2022,  respectively,  and  is included in  “Accrued 
interest receivable” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. 

the  allowance  for  credit 

interest  receivable  on 

losses.  Accrued 

the  Company’s 

Refer  to Note  1.  Summary  of  Significant  Accounting  Policies  –  Allowance  for  Credit  Losses  and  –  Accounting  Standards 
Adopted in 2023 for more information on the adoption of ASU 2016-13. 

98 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
   
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The table below shows a summary of the activity in the allowance for credit losses for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 
and 2021 (dollars in thousands). 

Balance, beginning of period 
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact(1) 
Provision for credit losses on loans(2)(3) 
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Balance, end of period 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

  $ 

  $ 

24,364    $ 
5,865      
(1,964)     
(742)     
3,017      
30,540    $ 

20,859    $ 
—      
2,922      
(633)     
1,216      
24,364    $ 

20,363  
—  
22,885  
(22,636) 
247  
20,859  

(1)  On January 1, 2023, the  Company  adopted  ASU 2016-13, which  introduced  a  new  model  known  as  CECL.  Refer
to Note  1. Summary  of  Significant  Accounting  Policies for  more  information  on  the  adoption  of  ASU 2016-
13. Amounts as of December 31, 2023 reflect the impact of adopting the CECL accounting standard and the Company’s
transition from a probable incurred loss methodology to the current expected credit loss methodology. Prior period
amounts represent the allowance for loan losses under the probable incurred loss methodology. 

(2)  For  the  year ended December  31,  2023,  the $2.0 million negative provision  for  credit  losses  on  the  consolidated
statement of income includes a $2.0 million negative provision for loan losses and a $36,000 negative provision for 
unfunded loan commitments. 

(3)  For  the year ended December  31, 2021, the  provision  for loan  losses  includes  a $21.6 million  impairment  recorded 
for one of the Company’s loan relationships as a result of Hurricane Ida. The corresponding loan balances in the same 
amount were then charged off. 

The following tables outline the activity in the allowance for credit losses by collateral type for the years ended December 31, 
2023, 2022 and 2021, and show both the allowance and portfolio balances for loans individually and collectively evaluated for 
impairment as of December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands). Amounts as of December 31, 2023 reflect the impact 
of  adopting  the  CECL  accounting  standard  and  the  Company’s  transition  from  a  probable  incurred  loss  methodology  to  the 
current  expected  credit  loss  methodology.  Prior  period  amounts  represent  the  allowance  for  loan  losses  under  the  probable 
incurred loss methodology. 

December 31, 2023 

Construction 
& 
Development    

1-4 

Commercial
& 

Commercial 
Real Estate     

Family     Multifamily   Farmland    

Industrial      Consumer     Total 

Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact 
Provision for credit losses on 

loans 
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Ending balance 
Ending allowance balance for 

 $ 

 $ 

loans individually evaluated for 
impairment 

Ending allowance balance for 

loans collectively evaluated for 
impairment 
Loans receivable: 
Balance of loans individually 
evaluated for impairment 
Balance of loans collectively 
evaluated for impairment 

Total period-end balance 

 $ 

2,555   $
(75)   

3,917   $ 
4,712     

999   $ 
(84)   

113   $ 
(99)   

10,718    $ 
676      

(84)   
—     
75     
2,471   $

524     
(46)   
22     
9,129   $ 

209     
—     
—     
1,124   $ 

(12)   
—     
—     
2   $ 

(2,922)    
(27)    
2,246      
10,691    $ 

5,743    $ 
793      

213      
(421)    
592      
6,920    $ 

319    $
(58)    

24,364  
5,865  

108      
(248)    
82      
203    $

(1,964)
(742)
3,017  
30,540  

212     

187     

—     

—     

—      

114      

25      

538  

2,259     

8,942     

1,124     

2     

10,691      

6,806      

178      

30,002  

789     

4,178     

—     

—     

216      

468      

119      

5,770  

189,582     409,608     
190,371   $413,786   $ 

105,946     
105,946   $ 

7,651     
7,651   $ 

937,492      
937,708    $ 

542,953      
11,617      2,204,849  
543,421    $  11,736    $2,210,619  

99 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
      
       
        
        
        
         
         
        
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
      
       
        
        
        
         
         
        
  
   
   
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

December 31, 2022 

Construction 
& 
Development    

1-4 

Commercial
& 

Commercial 
Real Estate    

Family     Multifamily   Farmland    

Industrial      Consumer     Total 

Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
  $ 
Provision for credit losses on loans     
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Ending balance 
Ending allowance balance for 

  $ 

loans individually evaluated for 
impairment 

Ending allowance balance for 

loans acquired with deteriorated 
credit quality 

Ending allowance balance for 

loans collectively evaluated for 
impairment 
Loans receivable: 
Balance of loans individually 
evaluated for impairment 
Balance of loans acquired with 
deteriorated credit quality 
Balance of loans collectively 
evaluated for impairment 

Total period-end balance 

  $ 

2,347   $
160     
—     
48     
2,555   $

3,337   $ 
477     
(11)   
114     
3,917   $ 

673   $ 
326     
—     
—     
999   $ 

383    $ 
(283)    
(54)    
67      
113    $ 

9,354    $ 
1,331      
29      
4      
10,718    $ 

4,411    $ 
797      
(397)    
932      
5,743    $ 

354    $
114      
(200)    
51      
319    $

20,859  
2,922  
(633)
1,216  
24,364  

26     

46     

—     

—      

36      

112      

63      

283  

—     

—     

—     

—      

—      

—      

—      

—  

2,529     

3,871     

999     

113      

10,682      

5,631      

256      

24,081  

591     

1,479     

—     

302     

—     

—     

62      

5,936      

2,241      

130      

10,439  

—      

609      

—      

57      

968  

201,042     399,596     
201,633   $401,377   $ 

81,812     
12,815      
81,812   $  12,877    $ 

951,698      
958,243    $ 

432,852      
13,545      2,093,360  
435,093    $  13,732    $2,104,767  

December 31, 2021 

Construction 
& 
Development    

1-4 

Commercial
& 

Commercial 
Real Estate     

Family      Multifamily   Farmland    

Industrial      Consumer     Total 

Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
Provision for credit losses on 

loans 
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Ending balance 
Ending allowance balance for 

  $ 

2,375    $

3,370    $ 

589   $ 

435   $ 

8,496    $ 

4,558    $ 

540    $

20,363  

219      
(283)    
36      
2,347    $

123      
(188)    
32      
3,337    $ 

84     
—     
—     
673   $ 

(39)   
(13)   
—     
383   $ 

11,132      
(10,280)    
6      
9,354    $ 

11,494      
(11,713)    
72      
4,411    $ 

(128)    
(159)    
101      
354    $

22,885  
(22,636)
247  
20,859  

  $ 

loans individually evaluated for 
impairment 

Ending allowance balance for 

loans acquired with deteriorated 
credit quality 

Ending allowance balance for 

loans collectively evaluated for 
impairment 
Loans receivable: 
Balance of loans individually 
evaluated for impairment 
Balance of loans acquired with 
deteriorated credit quality 
Balance of loans collectively 
evaluated for impairment 

Total period-end balance 

  $ 

—      

—      

—     

—     

—      

468      

96      

564  

—      

—      

—     

210     

—      

—      

—      

210  

2,347      

3,337      

673     

173     

9,354      

3,943      

258      

20,085  

529      

1,995      

—     

79     

16,685      

13,321      

182      

32,791  

—      

348      

—     

1,701     

636      

—      

64      

2,749  

202,675      361,964      
203,204    $364,307    $ 

59,570     
18,348     
59,570   $  20,128   $ 

879,056      
896,377    $ 

297,510      
17,349      1,836,472  
310,831    $  17,595    $1,872,012  

100 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
       
        
        
         
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
       
       
        
        
         
        
         
        
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
        
         
        
        
         
         
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
       
        
         
        
        
         
         
        
  
    
    
    
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Loan Modifications to Borrowers Experiencing Financial Difficulty 

In January  2023, the  Company  adopted  ASU 2022-02, which  eliminated  the  accounting  guidance  for  TDRs while  enhancing 
disclosure requirements for certain loan refinancings and restructurings by creditors when a borrower is experiencing financial 
difficulty. ASU 2022-02 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2023. See Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting 
Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023. 

Occasionally, the Company modifies loans to borrowers in financial distress by providing certain concessions, such as principal 
forgiveness,  term  extension,  an  other-than-insignificant  payment  delay,  an  interest  rate  reduction,  or  a  combination  of  such 
concessions. When principal forgiveness is provided, the amount of forgiveness is charged-off against the allowance for credit 
losses.  Upon  the  Company’s  determination  that  a  modified  loan  (or  portion  of  a  loan)  has  subsequently  been  deemed 
uncollectible, the loan (or portion of the loan) is written off. During the year ended December 31, 2023, the amount of loans that 
were modified to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty was immaterial.  

The following disclosures are presented under GAAP in effect prior to the adoption of CECL that are no longer applicable or 
required. The Company has included these disclosures to address the applicable prior periods. 

Pre-Adoption of CECL - Impaired Loans 

The Company considered a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, the Company determined that it 
was probable that it would not be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan agreement, including scheduled interest 
payments. Determination of impairment was treated the same across all classes of loans. When the Company identified a loan as 
impaired, it measured the impairment based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective 
interest rate, except when the sole (remaining) source of repayment for the loans was the operation or liquidation of the collateral. 
In those cases when foreclosure was probable, the Company used the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs, instead 
of discounted cash flows. If the Company determined that the value of the impaired loan was less than the recorded investment 
in  the  loan  (net  of  previous  charge-offs,  deferred  loan  fees  or  costs,  and  unamortized  premium  or  discount),  the  Company 
recognized impairment through an allowance estimate or a charge-off to the allowance. 

When  the  ultimate  collectability  of  the  total  principal  of  an  impaired  loan  was in  doubt  and  the  loan  was on  nonaccrual,  all 
payments were applied to principal, under the cost recovery method. When the ultimate collectability of the total principal of an 
impaired  loan  was not in  doubt  and  the  loan  was on  nonaccrual,  contractual  interest  was credited  to  interest  income  when 
received, under the cash basis method. 

101 

 
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The  following  tables  contain information  on  the  Company’s  impaired  loans  at December  31,  2022  and  2021.  The  average 
recorded  investment  was calculated  based  on  the  month-end  balances  of  the  loans  during  the  period  reported  (dollars  in 
thousands). 

With no related allowance recorded: 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

With related allowance recorded: 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

Total loans: 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

As of and for the year ended December 31, 2022 

Recorded 
Investment     

Unpaid 
Principal 
Balance 

Related 

Allowance     

Average 
Recorded 
Investment     

Interest 
Income 
Recognized   

  $ 

366    $ 
1,005      
62      
5,746      
7,179      
1,996      
34      
9,209      

225      
474      
190      
889      
245      
96      
1,230      

375    $ 
1,082      
70      
21,016      
22,543      
2,530      
45      
25,118      

498      
484      
190      
1,172      
292      
123      
1,587      

591      
1,479      
62      
5,936      
8,068      
2,241      
130      
10,439    $ 

873      
1,566      
70      
21,206      
23,715      
2,822      
168      
26,705    $ 

  $ 

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      

26      
46      
36      
108      
112      
63      
283      

26      
46      
—      
36      
108      
112      
63      
283    $ 

300    $ 
821      
68      
10,515      
11,704      
6,868      
56      
18,628      

225      
205      
32      
462      
421      
96      
979      

525      
1,026      
68      
10,547      
12,166      
7,289      
152      
19,607    $ 

15  
17  
—  
28  
60  
70  
—  
130  

—  
—  
—  
—  
—  
—  
—  

15  
17  
—  
28  
60  
70  
—  
130  

102 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

As of and for the year ended December 31, 2021 

Recorded 
Investment     

Unpaid 
Principal 
Balance 

Related 

Allowance     

Average 
Recorded 
Investment     

Interest 
Income 
Recognized   

  $ 

529    $ 
1,995      
79      
16,685      
19,288      
9,395      
55      
28,738      

812    $ 
2,081      
81      
27,139      
30,113      
10,941      
69      
41,123      

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      

731    $ 
1,965      
193      
10,790      
13,679      
9,166      
96      
22,941      

3,926      
127      
4,053      

9,618      
164      
9,782      

468      
96      
564      

1,311      
146      
1,457      

529      
1,995      
79      
16,685      
19,288      
13,321      
182      
32,791    $ 

812      
2,081      
81      
27,139      
30,113      
20,559      
233      
50,905    $ 

  $ 

—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
468      
96      
564    $ 

731      
1,965      
193      
10,790      
13,679      
10,477      
242      
24,398    $ 

17  
30  
—  
181  
228  
152  
—  
380  

24  
—  
24  

17  
30  
—  
181  
228  
176  
—  
404  

With no related allowance recorded: 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

With related allowance recorded: 
Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

Total loans: 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Farmland 
Commercial real estate 

Total mortgage loans on real estate 

Commercial and industrial 
Consumer 
Total 

Pre-Adoption of CECL - Troubled Debt Restructurings 

In situations where, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, the Company granted a concession 
for other than an insignificant period of time to the borrower that the Company would not otherwise consider, the related loan 
was classified as a TDR. The Company strived to identify borrowers in financial difficulty early and work with them to modify 
their loans to more affordable terms before such loans reach nonaccrual status. These modified terms included rate reductions, 
principal forgiveness, payment forbearance and other actions intended to minimize the economic loss and to avoid foreclosure or 
repossession of the collateral. In cases in which the Company granted the borrower new terms that provided for a reduction of 
either interest or principal, or otherwise included a concession, the Company identified the loan as a TDR and measured any 
impairment on the restructuring as previously noted for impaired loans. 

During  the  year ended December  31,  2022, three loans  were  modified  as TDRs  through adjustments  to  maturity.  There 
were no loans  modified  as  TDRs  during  the  previous twelve month  period  that  subsequently  defaulted during  the year 
ended December 31, 2022. 

At December 31, 2022, there were no available balances on loans classified as TDRs that the Company was committed to lend. 

103 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The  table  below  presents  the  TDR  pre-  and  post-modification  outstanding  recorded  investments  by  loan  category for  loans 
modified during the year ended December 31, 2022 (amounts in thousands, except number of loans). 

Troubled debt restructurings 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 

   Number of 
   Contracts 

December 31, 2022 
Pre- 

Post- 

     Modification       Modification    
     Outstanding       Outstanding    
     Recorded 
Investment 

     Recorded 
Investment 

1    $ 
2      
     $ 

186    $ 
58      
244    $ 

186  
58  
244  

The following is a summary of accruing and nonaccrual TDRs and the related allowance by portfolio type at December 31, 2022 
(dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2022 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 

Total 

   Accruing      Nonaccrual     

Total 

     Related 
     Allowance   

TDRs 

  $ 

  $ 

219    $ 
271      
413      
58      
961    $ 

—    $ 
127      
804      
1,092      
2,023    $ 

219    $ 
398      
1,217      
1,150      
2,984    $ 

—  
—  
—  
—  
—  

The  table  below  includes  the  average  recorded  investment  and  interest  income  recognized  for  TDRs  for  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2022 and 2021. The average recorded investment was calculated based on the month-end balances of the loans 
during the period reported (dollars in thousands). 

TDRs 

Average 
Recorded 
Investment 

Interest 
Income 
Recognized 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

230    $ 
489      
1,249      
3,511      
5,479    $ 

251    $ 
775      
5,358      
6,698      
13,082    $ 

15  
16  
28  
70  
129  

17  
28  
174  
149  
368  

December 31, 2022 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 

Total 

December 31, 2021 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family 
Commercial real estate 
Commercial and industrial 

Total 

104 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
  
      
  
  
  
      
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 4. OTHER REAL ESTATE OWNED 

The  table  below  shows  the  activity  in  other  real  estate  owned  for  the  years  ended  December  31,  2023  and  2022  (dollars  in 
thousands). 

Balance, beginning of period 

Additions 
Transfers from bank premises and equipment 
Sales of other real estate owned 

Balance, end of period 

   Year ended 
December 31, 
2023 

     Year ended 
December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

  $ 

682    $ 
3,930      
1,425      
(1,599)     
4,438    $ 

2,653  
3,327  
525  
(5,823) 
682  

For  the  years  ended  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  additions  to  other  real  estate  owned  of  $2.7  million  and  $1.6 million, 
respectively, were related to transfers of properties related to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 
2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. For the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, additions to other real estate owned of 
$0.3 million and  $1.7 million,  respectively,  were  related  to  acquired  loans.  During  the year  ended December  31,  2023,  the 
Company closed one branch and one stand-alone ATM and transferred the associated land and buildings from “Bank premises 
and equipment, net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, as the Company did not 
intend to use the properties for banking operations. In 2022, the Company closed two branches, and transferred the land and 
building associated with one of the closed branches from “Bank premises and equipment, net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in 
the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, as the Company did not intend to use the properties for banking operations; the 
property was sold later in the year. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, approximately $0.5 million and $0.6 million, respectively, 
of loans secured by 1-4 family residential property were in the process of foreclosure. 

NOTE 5. BANK PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT 

Bank premises and equipment consisted of the following as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands). 

Land 
Buildings and improvements 
Furniture and equipment 
Software 
Construction-in-progress 
Right-of-use asset 
Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization 

Bank premises and equipment, net 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

10,206    $ 
39,198      
10,317      
1,668      
158      
2,112      
(19,476)     
44,183    $ 

11,490  
40,799  
13,569  
2,334  
575  
2,845  
(22,025) 
49,587  

  $ 

  $ 

Depreciation  and  amortization related  to  Bank  premises  and  equipment  charged  to  noninterest  expense was  approximately 
$3.0 million, $3.5 million and $4.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively.  

During the year ended December 31, 2023, the Company completed the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations. The 
Company  also closed  one  branch  and  one  stand-alone  ATM in  Louisiana  and  transferred  the  associated  land  and  buildings, 
totaling  $1.4  million,  from “Bank  premises  and  equipment,  net”  to  “Other  real  estate  owned,  net”  in  the  accompanying 
consolidated balance sheets. The Company also ceased operation of 13 additional ATMs during the third quarter of 2023. During 
the year ended December 31, 2023, the Company recognized a loss of $1.3 million included in “Loss on sale or disposition of 
fixed  assets,  net”  in  the  accompanying  consolidated  statements  of  income.  During  the  year  ended December  31,  2022,  the 
Company closed two branch locations and sold three tracts of land being held for future branch locations. The land and building 
associated with one of the closed branch locations, totaling $0.5 million, was reclassified from “Bank premises and equipment, 
net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. During the year ended December 31, 
2022,  the  Company  recognized  a  loss  of  $0.3 million  included  in “Loss  on sale  or  disposition  of  fixed  assets,  net”  in  the 
accompanying consolidated statements of income. 

105 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 6. LEASES 

The Company’s primary leasing activities relate to certain real estate leases entered into in support of the Company’s branch 
operations. The Company’s lease agreements under which its branch locations are operated have all been designated as operating 
leases. The Company does not lease equipment under operating leases, nor does it have leases designated as finance leases. 

The Company determines if an arrangement is a lease at inception. Operating leases, with the exception of short-term leases, are 
included in operating lease right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and operating lease liabilities in “Bank premises and equipment, net” 
and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Operating lease ROU 
assets represent the right to use an underlying asset for the lease term and operating lease liabilities represent the obligation to 
make lease payments arising from the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at the commencement 
date based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term. As the Company’s leases do not provide an implicit rate, 
the Company uses its incremental borrowing rate based on the information available at the commencement date in determining 
the present value of lease payments. The operating lease ROU asset also includes any lease pre-payments made and excludes 
lease incentives. The Company’s lease terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease. When it is reasonably certain 
that the Company will exercise an option to extend a lease, the extension is included in the lease term when calculating the 
present value of lease payments. 

Lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term. The Company has lease agreements 
with lease and non-lease components, which the Company has elected to account for separately, as the non-lease component 
amounts are readily determinable. 

Quantitative information regarding the Company’s operating leases is presented below as of and for the years ended December 
31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Total operating lease cost 
Weighted average remaining lease term (in years) 
Weighted average discount rate 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

  $ 

441     $ 
6.8       
3.2%    

610  
7.0  
2.9%

At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the Company’s operating lease ROU assets were $2.1 million and $2.8 million, respectively, 
and the Company’s related operating lease liabilities were $2.2 million and $2.9 million, respectively. The Company’s operating 
leases have remaining terms ranging from 2 to 8 years, including extension options if the Company is reasonably certain they 
will be exercised. 

Future minimum lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases at December 31, 2023 are presented below (dollars 
in thousands). 

2024 
2025 
2026 
2027 
2028 
Thereafter 
Total 

  $ 

  $ 

381  
388  
339  
341  
341  
671  
2,461  

At December 31, 2023, the Company had not entered into any material leases that have not yet commenced. 

The Bank owns its corporate headquarters building, the first floor of which is occupied by multiple tenants. The Bank, as lessor, 
also leases a portion of one of its branch locations. All tenant leases are operating leases. The Bank, as lessor, recognized rental 
income of $0.4 million, $0.3 million and $0.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively. 

On January 27, 2023, the Bank completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with the Alice and 
Victoria, Texas branch locations to First Community Bank. Upon the completion of the sale, the Bank recorded $0.3 million of 
occupancy expense to terminate the remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases. 

106 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
    
   
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 7. GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS 

The Company’s intangible assets consist of goodwill, core deposit intangible assets arising from acquisitions, and a trademark 
intangible.  At  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  “Goodwill  and  other  intangible  assets,  net”  in  the  accompanying  consolidated 
balance sheets totaled $42.3 million and $43.1 million, respectively, and included no accumulated impairment losses. 

The carrying amount of goodwill at December 31, 2023 and 2022 was $40.1 million. The trademark intangible had a carrying 
value of $0.1 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022. 

In accordance with ASC Topic 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other,” the Company reviews the carrying value of indefinite-
lived intangible assets at least annually, or more frequently if certain impairment indicators exist. The Company performed its 
annual  impairment  testing  on  October  31, 2023 and  determined  that  there  was  no  impairment  to  its  goodwill  or  trademark 
intangible asset. 

Core deposit intangibles have finite lives and are being amortized on an accelerated basis over their estimated useful lives, which 
range from 10 to 15 years. The table below shows a summary of the core deposit intangible assets as of the dates presented 
(dollars in thousands). 

Core deposit intangibles 
Gross carrying amount 
Accumulated amortization 
Net carrying amount 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

  $ 

  $ 

7,486    $ 
(5,354)     
2,132    $ 

7,486  
(4,527) 
2,959  

Amortization expense for the core deposit intangible assets recorded in “Depreciation and amortization” in the accompanying 
consolidated  statements  of  income  totaled  approximately  $0.8 million,  $0.9 million,  and  $1.0 million  for  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively. 

The future amortization schedule for the Company’s core deposit intangible assets is displayed in the table below (dollars in 
thousands). The weighted average amortization period remaining for core deposit intangibles is 5.4 years. 

2024 
2025 
2026 
2027 
2028 
Thereafter 

NOTE 8. DEPOSITS 

Deposits consisted of the following as of the dates presented (dollars in thousands). 

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits 
Interest-bearing demand deposits 
Money market deposit accounts 
Savings accounts 
Brokered time deposits 
Time deposits 

Total deposits 

107 

624  
512  
398  
278  
161  
159  
2,132  

  $ 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

448,752    $ 
489,604      
179,366      
137,606      
269,102      
731,297      
2,255,727    $ 

580,741  
565,598  
208,596  
155,176  
9,990  
562,264  
2,082,365  

  $ 

  $ 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The  approximate  scheduled maturities  of  time  deposits,  including brokered  time  deposits, for  each of  the next five years  are 
shown below (dollars in thousands). 

2024 
2025 
2026 
2027 
2028 

  $ 

  $ 

762,456  
197,355  
29,803  
2,374  
8,411  
1,000,399  

At December 31, 2023 and 2022, time deposits greater than $250,000 were approximately $178.1 million, and $155.8 million, 
respectively. 

Public fund deposits as of December 31, 2023 and 2022 totaled approximately $134.8 million and $167.5 million, respectively. 
The funds were secured by securities with a fair value of approximately $110.1 million and $165.5 million as of December 31, 
2023 and 2022, respectively. 

As of December 31, 2023 and 2022, total deposits outstanding to executive officers, principal shareholders, directors and to 
companies in which they are principal owners amounted to approximately $20.1 million and $29.9 million, respectively. 

NOTE 9. SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE 

The Company utilizes securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) to facilitate the needs of our 
customers and to facilitate secured short-term funding needs. Repurchase agreements are stated at the amount of cash received 
in connection with the transaction. The Company monitors collateral levels on a continuous basis and may be required to provide 
additional  collateral  based  on  the  fair  value  of  the  underlying  securities.  Securities  pledged  as  collateral  under  repurchase 
agreements are maintained with the Company’s safekeeping agents. 

Repurchase  agreements  mature  on  a  daily  basis.  At December  31,  2023, the  total  balance  of  repurchase  agreements 
was $8.6 million, and were secured by investment securities with a fair value of approximately $9.0 million. At December 31, 
2022,  the  Company had  no  repurchase  agreements. The  weighted  average  interest  rate  on  repurchase  agreements  was 0.13% 
at December 31, 2023. The weighted average rate paid for repurchase agreements during the years ended December 31, 2023, 
2022 and 2021 was 0.13%, 0.15% and 0.21%, respectively. 

NOTE 10. SUBORDINATED DEBT SECURITIES 

On April  6,  2022,  the  Company entered  into  a  Subordinated  Note  Purchase  Agreement with  certain  institutional  accredited 
investors  and  qualified  institutional  buyers  (the  “Purchasers”)  under  which  the  Company issued $20.0 million  in  aggregate 
principal amount of its 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032 (the “2032 Notes”) to the Purchasers at a 
price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the 2032 Notes. The 2032 Notes were issued under an indenture, dated 
April 6, 2022 (the “Indenture”), by and among the Company and UMB Bank, National Association, as trustee. 

The 2032 Notes have a stated maturity date of April 15, 2032 and will bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.125% per year from and 
including April 6, 2022 to but excluding April 15, 2027 or earlier redemption date. From April 15, 2027 to but excluding the 
stated maturity date or earlier redemption date, the 2032 Notes will bear interest a floating rate equal to the then current three-
month term secured overnight financing rate (“SOFR”), plus 277 basis points. As provided in the 2032 Notes, the interest rate on 
the  2032  Notes  during  the  applicable  floating  rate  period may be  determined  based  on  a  rate  other  than three-month  term 
SOFR. The 2032 Notes may be redeemed, in whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2027 or, in whole but not in part, under certain 
other limited circumstances set forth in the Indenture. Any redemption we made would be at a redemption price equal to 100% 
of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.  

Principal and interest on the 2032 Notes are subject to acceleration only in limited circumstances in the case of certain bankruptcy 
and insolvency-related events. The 2032 Notes are the unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in 
right of payment to our current and future senior indebtedness and to our obligations to our general creditors. The 2032 Notes are 
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes.  

108 

 
 
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The Company used the majority of the net proceeds to redeem its 6.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2027 
(the “2027 Notes”) in June 2022 and utilized the remaining proceeds for share repurchases and for general corporate purposes. 

On  November  12,  2019,  the  Company  issued  and  sold  $25.0  million  in  aggregate  principal  amount  of  its  5.125%  Fixed-to-
Floating Rate Subordinated Notes (the “2029 Notes”) due December 30, 2029. Beginning on December 30, 2024, the Company 
may redeem the 2029 Notes, in whole or in part, at their principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The 2029 Notes 
bear an interest rate of 5.125% per annum until December 30, 2024, on which date the interest rate will reset quarterly to an 
annual interest rate equal to the then-current three-month LIBOR as calculated on each applicable date of determination, or an 
alternative rate determined in accordance with the terms of the 2029 Notes if the three-month LIBOR cannot be determined, plus 
349.0 basis points. 

On March 24, 2017, the Company issued and sold $18.6 million in aggregate principal amount of its 2027 Notes due March 30, 
2027. Beginning on March 30, 2022, the Company could redeem the 2027 Notes, in whole or in part, at their principal amount 
plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The 2027 Notes had an interest rate of 6.00% per annum until March 30, 2022, on which 
date the interest rate reset quarterly to an annual interest rate equal to the then-current LIBOR plus 394.5 basis points. In June 
2022, the Company redeemed the 2027 Notes in full in accordance with their terms at a redemption price equal to 100% of the 
outstanding  principal  balance  plus  accrued  and  unpaid  interest  up  to  but  excluding  the  June  30,  2022  redemption  date 
(“Redemption Date”). The aggregate redemption price, excluding accrued interest, totaled $18.6 million. Interest on the 2027 
Notes no longer accrued on or after the Redemption Date. 

The carrying value of subordinated debt was $44.3 million and $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively. The 
subordinated debt securities were recorded net of issuance costs of $0.7 million and $0.8 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, 
respectively, which are being amortized using the straight-line method over the lives of the respective securities. 

NOTE 11. OTHER BORROWED FUNDS 

Federal Home Loan Bank Advances 

FHLB advances and weighted average interest rates at the end of the period by contractual maturity are summarized as of the 
dates presented (dollars in thousands). 

Fixed rate advances maturing: 
2023 
2024 
2033 

Amount 

     Weighted Average Rate 

December 31, 
2023 

December 31, 
2022 

December 31, 
2023 

December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

  $ 

—     $ 
23,500       
—       
23,500     $ 

333,500      
23,500      
30,000      
387,000      

—%    
1.81       
—       
1.81%    

4.55%
1.81  
1.88  
4.18%

As  of  December  31,  2023,  these  advances  are  collateralized  by  a  blanket  pledge  of  certain  loans  totaling  approximately 
$975.4 million in accordance with the Advance Security and Collateral Agreement with the FHLB. As of December 31, 2023, 
the Company had an additional $919.5 million available under its line of credit with the FHLB. 

At December 31, 2022, the FHLB advances contractually maturing in 2033 were fixed rate, nonamortizing puttable advances. 
Under the terms of these advances, the Bank sold the FHLB options to terminate the fixed rate advances at specified points in 
time prior to the stated maturity dates. These advances were terminated during the year ended December 31, 2023. 

Borrowings Under Bank Term Funding Program 

On March  12,  2023, the  Federal  Reserve  established  the  Bank  Term  Funding  Program (“BTFP”).  The BTFP is  a one-year 
program which provides additional liquidity through borrowings with a term of up to one year secured by the pledging of certain 
qualifying  securities  and  other  assets,  valued  at  par  value. At December  31,  2023,  outstanding  borrowings  under  the  BTFP 
were $212.5  million,  with  a  weighted  average  rate  of  4.83%.  At December  31,  2023,  the  Company’s remaining  borrowing 
capacity under the BTFP was $58.5 million based on the value of securities available to be used as collateral, valued at par value 

109 

 
 
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
     
  
      
        
        
         
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

as permitted under the program. During the fourth quarter of 2023, the Company refinanced all of its borrowings under the BTFP 
with new loans under the BTFP with a one-year term due to more favorable rates. 

Lines of Credit 

The Company has outstanding unsecured lines of credit with its correspondent banks available to assist in the management of 
short-term liquidity. Any balances drawn on these lines of credit mature daily. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the available 
balance  on  the  unsecured  lines  of  credit  totaled  approximately  $60.0  million,  with  no  outstanding  balance  reflected  on  the 
consolidated balance sheets. 

Junior Subordinated Debt 

The following table provides a summary of the Company’s junior subordinated debentures (dollars in thousands). 

First Community 

Louisiana Statutory 
Trust I 

   Face Value     

Carrying 
Value 

Maturity 
Date 

Variable Interest Rate 

3-month SOFR + Spread 

  $ 

3,609    $ 

3,609     June 2036   

Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of 
1.77% 

3-month SOFR + Spread 

BOJ Bancshares 

Statutory Trust I 

3,093      

2,504    

December 
2034 

Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of 
1.90% 

Cheaha Statutory Trust I     
  $ 

3,093      
9,795    $ 

September 
2035 

2,517    
8,630      

3-month SOFR + Spread 

Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of 
1.70% 

Interest Rate at 
December 31, 
2023 

7.42%

7.55%

7.35%

These debentures are unsecured obligations due to trusts that are unconsolidated subsidiaries. The debentures were issued in 
conjunction with the trusts’ issuances of obligated capital securities. The trusts used the proceeds from the issuances of their 
capital securities to buy floating rate junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures that bear the same interest rate and terms 
as the capital securities. These debentures are the trusts’ only assets and the interest payments from the debentures finance the 
distributions paid on the capital securities. These debentures rank junior and are subordinate in the right of payment to all other 
debt of the Company. 

As part of the purchase accounting adjustments made with the BOJ Bancshares Inc. acquisition on December 1, 2017, and with 
the  Cheaha  Financial  Group,  Inc. acquisition  on  April  1,  2021,  the  Company  adjusted  the  carrying  value  of  the  junior 
subordinated debentures to fair value as of the respective acquisition date. The discounts on the debentures will continue to be 
amortized through maturity and recognized as a component of interest expense. 

The debentures may be called by the Company at par plus any accrued interest. Interest on the debentures is calculated quarterly. 
The distribution rate payable on the capital securities is cumulative and payable quarterly in arrears. The Company has the right 
to defer payments of interest on the debentures at any time by extending the interest payment period for a period not exceeding 
20 consecutive quarters with respect to each deferral period, provided that no extension period may extend beyond the redemption 
or maturity date of the debentures. 

The debentures  are  included on  the  consolidated balance sheets  as  liabilities;  however,  for regulatory  purposes,  the carrying 
values of these obligations are eligible for inclusion in Tier I regulatory capital, subject to certain limitations. The total carrying 
values  of $8.6 million  and $8.5 million  were allowed  in  the  calculation  of  Tier  I  regulatory  capital  at December  31, 
2023 and 2022, respectively.  

110 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 12. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 

As  part  of  its  liability  management,  the  Company  has  historically  utilized pay-fixed  interest  rate  swaps  to  manage  exposure 
against the variability in the expected future cash flows (future interest payments) attributable to changes in the 1-month LIBOR 
associated  with  the  forecasted  issuances  of 1-month  fixed  rate  debt  arising  from  a  rollover  strategy.  To  mitigate  credit  risk, 
securities  were pledged  to  the  Company  by  the  counterparties in  an  amount  greater  than  or  equal  to  the  gain  position  of  the 
derivative contracts. Conversely, securities were pledged to the counterparties by the Company in an amount greater than or equal 
to  the  loss  position  of  the  derivative  contracts,  if  applicable.  The  derivative  contracts  were between  the  Company 
and two counterparties. At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, the Company had no current or forward starting interest 
rate swap agreements, other than interest rate swaps related to customer loans, described below. The interest rate swaps were 
determined to be fully effective during the periods presented, and therefore, no amount of ineffectiveness has been included in 
net income. 

During  the  year  ended December  31,  2022, the  Company  voluntarily  terminated  interest  rate  swap  agreements with  a  total 
notional amount of $115.0 million in response to market conditions. During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company 
voluntarily  terminated  interest  rate  swap  agreements with  a  total  notional  amount  of  $150.0 million  in  response  to  market 
conditions  and  as  a  result  of  excess  liquidity.  For  years  ended December  31,  2022 and December  31,  2021 unrealized  gains 
of $6.4 million and $1.4 million, respectively, net of tax expenses of $1.7 million and $0.4 million, respectively, were reclassified 
from “Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income” and recorded as “Swap termination fee income” in noninterest income 
in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. 

For the years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021 gains of $4.3 million and $5.3 million, respectively, net of tax 
expenses  of $1.2 million  and $1.4 million,  respectively,  were recognized  in  “Other  comprehensive  income  (loss)” in  the 
accompanying  consolidated  statements  of comprehensive income  (loss)  for  the  change  in  fair  value  of  the  interest  rate  swap 
contracts. 

There were no assets or liabilities recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2023 or December 
31, 2022 associated with the swap contracts, other than interest rate swaps related to customer loans, described below. 

Customer Derivatives – Interest Rate Swaps  

The  Company  enters  into  interest  rate  swaps  that  allow  commercial  loan  customers  to  effectively  convert  a  variable-rate 
commercial  loan  agreement  to  a  fixed-rate  commercial  loan  agreement.  Under  these  agreements,  the  Company  enters  into  a 
variable-rate loan agreement with a customer in addition to an interest rate swap agreement, which serves to effectively swap the 
customer’s  variable-rate  loan  into  a  fixed-rate  loan.  The  Company  then  enters  into  a  corresponding  swap  agreement  with 
a third party in order to economically hedge its exposure through the customer agreement. The interest rate swaps with both the 
customers  and third parties  are not designated  as  hedges  under  FASB  ASC  Topic 815, “Derivatives  and  Hedging,” and  are 
marked  to  market  through  earnings.  As  the  interest  rate  swaps are  structured  to  offset  each  other,  changes  to  the underlying 
benchmark  interest  rates  considered  in  the  valuation  of  these  instruments  do not result  in  an  impact  to  earnings;  however, 
there may be fair value adjustments related to credit quality variations between counterparties, which may impact earnings as 
required  by  FASB  ASC  Topic 820, “Fair  Value  Measurement” (“ASC 820”).  The  Company  did not recognize  any  gains  or 
losses in other operating income resulting from fair value adjustments of these swap agreements during the years ended December 
31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. At December 31, 2023, the Company had notional amounts of $174.9 million in interest rate swap 
contracts with customers and $174.9 million in offsetting interest rate swap contracts with other financial institutions. The fair 
value of the swap contracts consisted of gross assets of $17.3 million and gross liabilities of $17.3 million recorded in “Other 
assets” and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 
2023. 

NOTE 13. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY 

Preferred Stock 

The Company’s Articles of Incorporation give the Company’s board of directors the authority to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of 
preferred stock. At December 31, 2023, there were no preferred shares outstanding. The preferred shares are considered “blank 
check” preferred stock. This type of preferred stock allows the board of directors to fix the designations, preferences and relative, 
participating, optional or other special rights, and qualifications and limitations or restrictions of any series of preferred stock 
without further shareholder approval. 

111 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Common Stock 

The Company’s Articles of Incorporation give the Company’s board of directors the authority to issue up to 40,000,000 shares 
of  common  stock.  At  December  31,  2023,  there  were  9,748,067  common  shares  outstanding  compared  to  9,901,847  and 
10,343,494 at December 31, 2022 and 2021, respectively. 

In addition, the Company repurchased 222,448, 518,978, and 359,138 shares of its common stock through its stock repurchase 
program at an average price of $13.47, $20.27, and $19.24 per share during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, 
respectively. 

Dividend Restrictions. In the ordinary course of business, the Company is dependent upon dividends from the Bank to provide 
funds for the payment of dividends to shareholders and to provide for other cash requirements. Banking regulations may limit 
the amount of dividends that may be paid to the Company. Approval by regulatory authorities is required if the effect of the 
dividend would cause the regulatory capital of the Bank to fall below specified minimum levels. Approval is also required if 
dividends declared exceed the net profits for that year combined with the retained net profits for the preceding two years. Further, 
a national bank may not pay a dividend in excess of its undivided profits. 

Under  the  terms of  the  junior  subordinated debentures, assumed  through  acquisition,  the  Company  has  the right at  any  time 
during the term of the debentures to defer the payment of interest. In the event that the Company elects to defer interest on the 
debentures, it may not, with certain exceptions, declare or pay any dividends or distributions on its common stock or purchase 
or acquire any of its common stock. 

Under the terms of the Company’s 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, the Company may not pay a 
dividend if either the parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after giving 
effect  to  the  payment  of  the  dividend,  would  not  maintain  regulatory  capital  ratios  that  are  at  “well  capitalized”  levels  for 
regulatory  purposes  (but  with  respect  to  the  parent  company,  only  if  it  is  required  to  measure  and  report  such  ratios  on  a 
consolidated  basis  under  applicable  law).  The  Company  is  also  prohibited  from  paying  dividends  upon  and  during  the 
continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. 

Under the terms of the Company’s 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, the Company is prohibited 
from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. 

These restrictions do not, and are not expected in the future to, materially limit the Company’s ability to pay dividends to its 
shareholders in an amount consistent with the Company’s history of paying dividends. 

112 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Loss) Income 

Activity within the balances in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income, net is shown in the tables below (dollars in 
thousands). 

Beginning 
of Period     

2023 
Net 
Change     

For the years ended December 31, 
2022 
Net 
Change     

Beginning 
of Period     

End of 
Period      

End of 
Period      

Beginning 
of Period     

2021 
Net 
Change     

End of 
Period    

  $  (43,137 )   $  3,510    $ (39,627)   $ 

4,882    $ (48,019)   $ (43,137)   $ 

7,493     $ (2,611)   $  4,882  

(5,777 )     

256      

(5,521)     

(5,772)     

(5)     

(5,777)     

(3,939 )      (1,833)     

(5,772) 

1        —      

1      

2      

(1)     

1      

3       

(1)     

2  

7,830        —      

7,830      

3,501       4,329      

7,830      

(1,752 )      5,253      

3,501  

(7,830 )      —      

(7,830)     

(1,450)      (6,380)     

(7,830)     

—        (1,450)     

(1,450) 

Unrealized (loss) gain, 
available for sale, net 

Reclassification of 

realized (gain) loss, 
available for sale, net 

Unrealized gain (loss), transfer 
from available for sale to 
held to maturity, net 

Change in fair value of interest 
rate swaps designated as 
cash flow hedges, net 
Reclassification of realized 
gain, interest rate swap 
termination, net 
Accumulated other 

comprehensive (loss) 
income 

  $  (48,913 )   $  3,766    $ (45,147)   $ 

1,163    $ (50,076)   $ (48,913)   $ 

1,805     $ 

(642)   $  1,163  

NOTE 14. STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION 

Equity  Incentive  Plan.  The  Company’s  Amended  and  Restated  2017  Long-Term  Incentive  Compensation  Plan  (the  “Plan”) 
authorizes the grant of various types of equity awards, such as restricted stock, restricted stock units, stock options and stock 
appreciation  rights  to  eligible  participants,  which  include  all  of  the  Company’s  employees,  non-employee  directors,  and 
consultants. The Plan has reserved a total of 1,200,000 shares of common stock, 600,000 of which were authorized in 2021, for 
issuance  to  eligible  participants  pursuant  to  equity  awards  under  the  Plan.  The  Plan  is  administered  by  the  Compensation 
Committee of the Company’s board of directors, which determines, within the provisions of the Plan, those eligible employees 
to whom, and the times at which, equity awards will be granted. The Compensation Committee, in its discretion, may delegate 
its authority and duties under the Plan to specified officers; however, only the Compensation Committee may approve the terms 
of equity awards to the Company’s executive officers and directors. At December 31, 2023, approximately 450,058 shares remain 
available for grant. 

Stock Options 

During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the Company granted 34,497, 34,379, and 38,450 stock options, 
respectively, to key personnel that vest in one-fifth increments on each of the first five anniversaries of the grant date. 

113 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The table below summarizes the Company’s stock option activity for the periods indicated. 

Shares 

Average Price     

Weighted 

Outstanding at December 31, 2020 
Granted 
Forfeited 
Exercised 
Outstanding at December 31, 2021 
Granted 
Forfeited 
Exercised 
Outstanding at December 31, 2022 
Granted 
Forfeited 
Exercised 
Outstanding at December 31, 2023 
Exercisable at December 31, 2023 

408,288    $ 
38,450      
(30,869)     
(47,388)     
368,481      
34,379      
(42,930)     
(9,500)     
350,430      
34,497      
(50,822)     
(7,500)     
326,605      
244,847    $ 

17.66      
20.72      
19.56      
15.44      
18.10      
18.92      
21.36      
14.00      
17.89      
13.96      
19.47      
14.00      
17.32      
17.17      

Weighted 
Average 
Remaining 
Contractual 
Term (Years)    
5.57  

5.05  

4.19  

3.84  
2.44  

The aggregate intrinsic value of stock options is calculated as the aggregate difference between the exercise price of the stock 
options and the fair market value of the Company’s common stock for those stock options having an exercise price lower than 
the fair market value of the Company’s common stock. At December 31, 2023, the shares underlying outstanding and exercisable 
stock options both had an intrinsic value of $0.1 million. 

The Company uses a Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock-based awards. The Black-Scholes 
option pricing model incorporates various subjective assumptions, including expected term and expected volatility. Expected 
volatility was determined based on the historical volatilities of the Company. Stock option expense of $0.2 million is included 
in “Salaries  and  employee  benefits”  in  the  accompanying  consolidated  statements  of  income  for  each  of  the  years 
ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. At December 31, 2023, there was $0.3 million of unrecognized compensation cost 
related to stock options that is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 3.2 years. 

The table below shows the assumptions used for the stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022. 

Dividend yield 
Expected volatility 
Risk-free interest rate 
Expected term (in years) 
Weighted average grant date fair value 

Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Units 

2023 

2022 

2.72%    
38.31%    
3.56%    
6.5       
4.58     $ 

1.70%
38.74%
2.50%
6.5  
6.69  

  $ 

Under the Plan, the Company may grant restricted stock, restricted stock units, and other stock-based awards to Plan participants, 
subject to forfeiture upon the occurrence of certain events until the dates specified in the participant’s award agreement. While 
restricted stock is subject to forfeiture, holders of restricted stock may exercise full voting rights and will receive all dividends 
paid with respect to the restricted shares. Restricted stock units (“RSUs”) do not have voting rights and do not receive dividends 
or  dividend  equivalents.  The  restricted  stock  and  RSUs  granted  under  the  Plan  are  typically  subject  to  a  vesting  period. 
Compensation expense for restricted stock and RSUs is determined based on the market price of the Company’s common stock 
at the grant date and is applied to the total number of shares or units granted and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the 
requisite  service  period  of  generally  five  years  for  employees  and  two  years  for  non-employee  directors.  Upon  vesting  of 
restricted stock and RSUs, the benefit of tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation expense is reflected as an income 
tax benefit in the consolidated statements of income. 

114 

 
 
  
  
  
    
    
    
   
    
   
    
   
    
    
   
    
   
    
   
    
    
   
    
   
    
   
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Historically, the Company has granted restricted stock awards to Plan participants. Beginning in 2019, the Company granted 
time vested RSUs to its non-employee directors and certain officers of the Company with vesting terms ranging from two years 
to five years. 

The Company granted a total of 172,736 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2023. Of the RSUs 
granted in 2023, 153,467 shares vest over five years and 19,269 shares vest over two years. 

The Company granted a total of 134,524 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2022. Of the RSUs 
granted in 2022, 114,554 shares vest over five years and 19,970 shares vest over two years. 

The Company granted a total of 129,082 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2021. Of the RSUs 
granted in 2021, 105,294 shares vest over five years and 23,788 shares vest over two years. 

Compensation expense related to restricted stock and RSUs included in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for 
the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 was $1.8 million, $2.0 million and $1.6 million, respectively. The unearned 
compensation related to these awards is amortized to compensation expense over the vesting period. As of December 31, 2023, 
unearned stock-based compensation cost associated with these awards totaled approximately $4.3 million and is expected to be 
recognized over a weighted average period of 3.2 years. 

The following table summarizes the restricted stock and RSU activity for the years ended December 31, 2023 and December 31, 
2022. 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

Balance, beginning of period 

Granted 
Forfeited 
Earned and issued 
Balance, end of period 

NOTE 15. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS 

253,488    $ 
172,736      
(7,008)     
(82,467)     
336,749    $ 

20.19      
14.82      
20.53      
20.42      
17.37      

Weighted 
Average 
Grant Date 
Fair Value     

Shares 

Shares 

Weighted 
Average 
Grant Date 
Fair Value   
21.16  
19.09  
20.34  
21.14  
20.19  

241,070    $ 
134,524      
(30,169)     
(91,937)     
253,488    $ 

The Company maintains a 401(k) defined contribution plan (the “401(k) Plan”), which covers employees over the age of 21 who 
have completed three months of credited service, as defined by the 401(k) Plan. The 401(k) Plan allows employees to defer a 
percentage of their salaries subject to certain limits based on federal tax laws. The Company makes matching contributions up 
to 4% of the employee’s annual salary (subject to certain maximum compensation amounts as prescribed in Internal Revenue 
Service guidance). Contributions by the Company and participants are immediately vested. Employer matching contributions to 
the 401(k) Plan for each of the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 were approximately $1.0 million, and are included 
in “Salaries and employee benefits” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. 

The 401(k) Plan also allows for discretionary Company contributions in the form of cash or Company stock. Contributions in 
the form of Company stock are held in a portion of the 401(k) Plan that qualifies as an employee stock ownership plan. The 
Company  made Company  stock  contributions  of  $0.1  million in the  year ended  December  31,  2022.  The  discretionary 
components vest in increments of 20% annually over a period of five years based on the employees’ years of service, beginning 
upon completion of two years of service (such that an employee with six years of service will be 100% vested). 

The Bank has entered into Salary Continuation Agreements (“SCA”) with certain officers of the Company. The SCAs represent 
unfunded, non-qualified deferred compensation arrangements under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. The SCAs 
between the Bank and each officer, as supplemented if applicable, provide that the officer shall receive annual payments of a 
fixed amount upon attaining the age of 65, with such payments payable monthly over a period of 120 months (10 years). Each 
officer is also entitled to certain reduced payments following a termination of employment prior to attaining age 65 (other than 
a termination due to death or with cause), which payments shall be made on the same schedule mentioned above. 

115 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
 
  
  
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The Company maintains a deferred compensation plan for a former employee of Citizens Bank (“Citizens”), a liability assumed 
in  the  Citizens  acquisition  in  2017.  Under  the  deferred  compensation  agreement,  the  former  employee  will  receive  monthly 
payments  of  $2,000  through  May  of  2030.  The  Company  also  maintains  a  deferred  compensation  plan  for  certain  former 
employees of Cheaha, and associated liabilities of $1.7 million were assumed in the acquisition on April 1, 2021. The deferred 
compensation plan provides for payments for a period of 15 years following specified retirement dates, which range from 2018 
through 2032. On November 4, 2022, the Company’s then-current Chief Financial Officer separated from the Company, and the 
Company’s board of directors approved the continuation of his Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement following his separation 
date. Accordingly, in the fourth quarter of 2022, the Company recorded deferred compensation expense and associated liability of 
$0.2 million.  At  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  the  Company  had  a  liability  of  $5.3 million  and  $5.2 million,  respectively, 
included  in  “Accrued  taxes  and  other  liabilities”  on  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance  sheets  related  to  these  deferred 
compensation plans. Deferred compensation expenses related to these plans recognized for the years ended December 31, 2023, 
2022, and 2021 were approximately $0.2 million, $1.0 million and $0.7 million, respectively, and are included in “Salaries and 
employee benefits” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. 

NOTE 16. INCOME TAXES 

Income tax expense is displayed in the table below for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands). 

Current federal income tax expense 
Current state income tax expense 
Deferred federal income tax expense 

Total income tax expense 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

  $ 

  $ 

3,971    $ 
129      
(350)     
3,750    $ 

9,075    $ 
219      
(655)     
8,639    $ 

2,315  
141  
(547) 
1,909  

The provision for federal income taxes differs from that computed by applying the federal statutory rate of 21% as indicated in 
the following analysis for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands). 

Tax based on statutory rate 
(Decrease) increase resulting from: 
Effect of tax-exempt income 
Acquisition costs 
Historical tax credits 
State taxes 
Other 

Total income tax expense 
Effective rate 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

  $ 

4,290     $

9,313     $

2,081  

(830)      
—       
—       
129       
161       
3,750     $
18.4%     

(873)      
—       
—       
219       
(20)      
8,639     $
19.5%    

(348) 
72  
(54) 
141  
17  
1,909  
19.3%

  $ 

The Company records deferred income tax on the tax effect of changes in timing differences. 

116 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
      
         
         
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The net deferred tax asset was comprised of the following items as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands). 

Deferred tax liabilities: 

Depreciation 
FHLB stock dividend 
Basis difference in acquired assets and liabilities 
Operating lease right-of-use asset 
Other 

Gross deferred tax liability 

Deferred tax assets: 

Allowance for credit losses 
Unrealized loss on available for sale securities 
Net operating loss carryforward 
Deferred compensation 
Basis difference in acquired assets and liabilities 
Employee and director stock awards 
Operating lease liability 
Unearned loan fees 
Other 

Gross deferred tax asset 
Net deferred tax asset 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

  $ 

  $ 

(3,072)   $ 
(88)     
(1,018)     
(443)     
(55)     
(4,676)     

6,474      
12,216      
69      
1,117      
270      
580      
463      
227      
170      
21,586      
16,910    $ 

(3,441) 
(103) 
(1,129) 
(598) 
(46) 
(5,317) 

5,180  
13,235  
193  
1,099  
440  
576  
619  
269  
144  
21,755  
16,438  

The Company acquired net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforwards through tax free acquisitions. As of December 31, 2023 and 
December 31, 2022, the Company’s gross NOL carryforwards were approximately $0.3 million and $0.9 million, respectively. 
As  of  December  31,  2023,  approximately $4,000 and  $0.3 million  of  the  NOL  carryforwards  expire  in  2033  and  2039, 
respectively. All available NOL carryforwards are expected to be fully utilized by 2024, therefore the Company did not record 
a valuation allowance against the NOL carryforwards for the year ended December 31, 2023. 

The Company files income tax returns under U.S. federal jurisdiction and the states of Alabama, Florida, Texas and Louisiana, 
although the state of Louisiana does not assess an income tax on income resulting from banking operations. The Company is 
open to examination in the U.S. and the states of Louisiana, Alabama, and Florida for tax years ended December 31, 2020 through 
December 31, 2023; and Texas for tax years ended December 31, 2019 through December 31, 2023. 

NOTE 17. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 

In accordance with ASC 820, disclosure of fair value information about financial instruments, whether or not recognized in the 
balance sheet, is required. The fair value of a financial instrument is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to 
transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. 
Fair  value  is  best  determined  based  upon  quoted  market  prices  or  exit  prices.  In  cases  where  quoted  market  prices 
are not available,  fair  values  are  based  on  estimates  using  present  value  or  other  valuation  techniques.  Those  techniques  are 
significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows, and the fair value 
estimates may not be  realized  in  an  immediate  settlement  of  the  instruments.  Accordingly,  the  aggregate  fair  value  amounts 
presented do not represent the underlying value of the Company. 

If there has been a significant decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset or liability, a change in valuation technique 
or the use of multiple valuation techniques may be appropriate. In such instances, determining the price at which willing market 
participants would transact at the measurement date under current market conditions depends on the facts and circumstances and 
requires use of significant judgment. The fair value is a reasonable point within the range that is most representative of fair value 
under current market conditions. 

117 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The Company also holds Small Business Investment Company qualified funds and other investment funds that do not have a 
readily determinable fair value. In accordance with ASC 820, these investments are measured at fair value using the net asset 
value practical expedient and are not required to be classified in the fair value hierarchy. At December 31, 2023 and December 
31, 2022, the fair values of these investments were $3.4 million and $2.8 million, respectively, and are included in “Other assets” 
in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. 

Fair Value Hierarchy 

In  accordance  with  ASC 820, the  Company  groups  its  financial  assets  and  financial  liabilities  measured  at  fair  value 
in three levels, based on the markets in which the assets and liabilities are traded, and the reliability of the assumptions used to 
determine fair value. 

Level 1 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets. 

Level 2 – Valuation is based upon observable inputs other than quoted prices included in level 1, such as quoted prices for similar 
assets and liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or 
other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data. 

Level 3 – Valuation is based upon unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant 
to the fair value of the assets or liabilities. This includes certain pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies, and similar 
techniques that use significant unobservable inputs. 

A financial instrument’s categorization within the valuation hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant 
to the fair value measurement. 

Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Recurring Basis 

The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating the fair value of assets and liabilities valued 
on a recurring basis: 

AFS Investment Securities and Exchange-Traded Equity Securities – Where quoted prices are available in an active market, the 
Company classifies the securities within level 1 of the valuation hierarchy. Securities are defined as both long and short positions. 
Level 1 securities include exchange-traded equity securities. 

If quoted market prices are not available, the Company estimates fair values using pricing models and discounted cash flows that 
consider standard input factors such as observable market data, benchmark yields, interest rate volatilities, broker/dealer quotes, 
and credit spreads. Examples of such instruments, which would generally be classified within level 2 of the valuation hierarchy 
if  observable  inputs  are  available,  include  obligations  of  the  U.S.  Treasury  and  U.S.  government  agencies  and  corporations, 
obligations  of  state  and  political  subdivisions,  corporate  bonds,  residential  mortgage-backed  securities,  and  commercial 
mortgage-backed securities. In certain cases where there is limited activity or less transparency around inputs to the valuation, 
the Company classifies those securities in level 3. 

Management monitors the current placement of securities in the fair value hierarchy to determine whether transfers between 
levels may be warranted based on market reference data, which may include reported trades; bids, offers or broker/dealer quotes; 
benchmark yields and spreads; as well as other reference data. At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, the majority of 
the Company’s level 3 investments were obligations of state and political subdivisions. The Company estimated the fair value of 
these level 3 investments using discounted cash flow models, the key inputs of which are the coupon rate, current spreads to the 
yield curves, and expected repayment dates, adjusted for illiquidity of the local municipal market and sinking funds, if applicable. 
Option-adjusted models may be used for structured or callable notes, as appropriate. 

Derivative Financial Instruments – The fair value for interest rate swap agreements is based upon the amounts required to settle 
the contracts. These derivative instruments are classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. 

118 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are summarized in the table below as of the dates indicated 
(dollars in thousands). 

    Quoted Prices       
in Active 

Markets for      

   Fair Value     

Identical 
Assets 
(Level 1) 

Significant 
Other 
Observable 
Inputs 
(Level 2) 

     Significant    
Unobservable 
Inputs 
(Level 3) 

December 31, 2023 
Assets: 

Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government 

agencies and corporations 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 
Equity securities 
Interest rate swaps - gross assets 

Total assets 

Liabilities: 

Interest rate swaps - gross liabilities 

December 31, 2022 
Assets: 

Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government 

agencies and corporations 

Obligations of state and political subdivisions 
Corporate bonds 
Residential mortgage-backed securities 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 
Equity securities 
Total assets 

  $

  $

  $

  $

20,043     $ 
16,703       
26,356       
232,045       
66,771       
1,180       
17,325       
380,423     $ 

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
1,180      
—      
1,180    $ 

20,043     $ 
11,453       
25,893       
232,045       
66,771       
—       
17,325       
373,530     $ 

—  
5,250  
463  
—  
—  
—  
—  
5,713  

17,325     $ 

—    $ 

17,325     $ 

—  

29,805     $ 
18,378       
29,942       
251,851       
75,191       
1,245       
406,412     $ 

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
1,245      
1,245    $ 

29,805     $ 
12,413       
29,463       
251,851       
75,191       
—       
398,723     $ 

—  
5,965  
479  
—  
—  
—  
6,444  

119 

 
 
  
  
    
  
  
    
 
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
      
        
        
        
  
    
  
      
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The Company reviews fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. Changes in the Company’s ability to observe 
inputs to the valuation may cause reclassification of certain assets or liabilities within the fair value hierarchy. The table below 
provides a reconciliation for assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs, or level 3 
inputs (dollars in thousands). 

Obligations of 
State and 
Political 

Subdivisions      

Corporate 
Bonds 

Total 

Balance at December 31, 2021 
Realized gains (losses) included in net income 
Unrealized losses included in other comprehensive loss 
Purchases 
Sales 
Maturities, prepayments, and calls 
Transfers into Level 3 
Transfers out of Level 3 
Balance at December 31, 2022 
Realized gains (losses) included in net income 
Unrealized losses included in other comprehensive income 
Purchases 
Sales 
Maturities, prepayments, and calls 
Transfers into Level 3 
Transfers out of Level 3 
Balance at December 31, 2023 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

22,114    $ 
—      
(1,474)     
—      
—      
(4,840)     
—      
(9,835)     
5,965    $ 
—      
(689)     
—      
—      
(26)     
—      
—      
5,250    $ 

488    $ 
—      
(9)     
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
479    $ 
—      
(16)     
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
463    $ 

22,602  
—  
(1,483) 
—  
—  
(4,840) 
—  
(9,835) 
6,444  
—  
(705) 
—  
—  
(26) 
—  
—  
5,713  

There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using level 3 inputs at December 31, 2023 and 2022. For the 
years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, there were no gains or losses included in earnings related to the change in fair 
value of the assets measured on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs held at the end of the period. 

The following table provides quantitative information about significant unobservable inputs used in fair value measurements of 
level 3 assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Estimated 
Fair Value    

Valuation Technique 

Unobservable 
Inputs 

Range of 
Discounts 

December 31, 2023 

Obligations of state and 
political subdivisions 

  $ 

Corporate bonds 

December 31, 2022 

Obligations of state and 
political subdivisions 

  $ 

Corporate bonds 

Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model; 
present value of expected future cash flow 
model 

5,250   

Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model; 
present value of expected future cash flow 
model 

463  

Bond appraisal 
adjustment(1) 

Bond appraisal 
adjustment(1) 

     0% - 11%    

8% 

Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model; 
present value of expected future cash flow 
model 

5,965  

Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model; 
present value of expected future cash flow 
model 

479  

Bond appraisal 
adjustment(1) 

Bond appraisal 
adjustment(1) 

     0% - 12%    

4% 

(1)   Fair  values  determined  through  valuation  analysis  using  coupon,  yield  (discount  margin),  liquidity  and  expected

repayment dates. 

120 

 
 
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
    
    
      
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
    
     
    
    
   
       
    
    
      
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Nonrecurring Basis 

Certain  financial  assets  and  financial  liabilities  are  measured  at  fair  value  on  a  nonrecurring  basis;  that  is,  the  instruments 
are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, 
when there is evidence of impairment). 

The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating the fair value of assets and liabilities valued 
on a nonrecurring basis: 

Loans  Individually  Evaluated –  For collateral  dependent  loans  where  the  borrower  is  experiencing  financial  difficulty,  the 
expected credit loss is measured as the difference between the amortized cost basis of the loan and the fair value of the collateral, 
which is based on third-party appraisals. Individually evaluated loans that are not collateral dependent are evaluated based on a 
discounted cash flow methodology. Credits deemed uncollectible  are charged to the allowance for credit losses. Since not all 
valuation inputs are observable, these nonrecurring fair value determinations are classified as level 3. 

Quantitative information about assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis based on significant unobservable inputs 
(level 3) are summarized below as of the dates indicated; there were no liabilities measured on a nonrecurring basis at December 
31, 2023 or 2022 (dollars in thousands). 

Estimated 
Fair Value     Valuation Technique 

   Unobservable Inputs 

Range of 
Discounts     

Weighted 
Average 
Discount(2)   

Discounted cash flows, 
underlying collateral 
value 

  $ 

1,293  

Collateral discounts and 
estimated costs to sell 

6% - 
100% 

29% 

December 31, 2023 
Loans individually 
evaluated for 
impairment(1) 

December 31, 2022 

Impaired loans 

  $ 

4,033  

Discounted cash flows, 
underlying collateral 
value 

Collateral discounts and 
estimated costs to sell 

4% - 
100% 

53% 

(1)  Loans  individually  evaluated  that  were  re-measured  during  the  period  had  a  carrying  value  of  $1.8  million  and 
$4.2 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, with related allowance for credit losses of 
$0.5 million and $0.2 million as of such dates. 

(2)  Weighted by relative fair value. 

Financial Instruments 

Accounting guidance requires the disclosure of estimated fair value information about certain on- and off-balance sheet financial 
instruments, including those financial instruments that are not measured and reported at fair value on a recurring or nonrecurring 
basis.  The  significant  methods  and  assumptions used by  the  Company  to  estimate  the fair  value of financial  instruments  are 
discussed below. 

Cash  and  Due  from  Banks –  For  these  short-term  instruments,  fair  value  is  the  carrying  value.  Cash  and  due  from  banks  is 
classified in level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. 

Federal  Funds  Sold –  The  fair  value  is  the  carrying  value.  The  Company  classifies  these  assets  in  level 1 of  the  fair  value 
hierarchy. 

Investment Securities and Equity Securities – The fair value measurement techniques and assumptions for AFS securities and 
exchange-traded  equity  securities  is  discussed  earlier  in  the  note.  The  same  measurement  techniques  and  assumptions  were 
applied to the valuation of HTM securities and other equity securities including equity in correspondent banks.  

121 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
    
    
      
        
  
  
    
      
  
  
      
    
    
      
        
  
      
    
    
      
        
  
  
    
      
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Loans – The fair value of portfolio loans, net is determined using an exit price methodology. The exit price methodology is based 
on a discounted cash flow analysis, in which projected cash flows are based on contractual cash flows adjusted for prepayments 
for certain loan types (e.g. residential mortgage loans and multifamily loans) and the use of a discount rate based on expected 
relative risk of the cash flows. The discount rate selected considers loan type, maturity date, a liquidity premium, cost to service, 
and cost of capital, which is a level 3 fair value estimate. 

Loans  held  for  sale  are  measured  using  quoted  market  prices  when  available.  If  quoted  market  prices  are not available, 
comparable market values or discounted cash flow analyses may be utilized. The Company classifies these assets in level 3 of 
the fair value hierarchy. 

Deposit Liabilities – The fair values disclosed for noninterest-bearing demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount 
payable on demand at the reporting date (that is, their carrying amounts). These noninterest-bearing deposits are classified in 
level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. All interest-bearing deposits are classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The carrying 
amounts  of  variable-rate  accounts  (for  example  interest-bearing  checking,  savings,  and  money  market  accounts),  fixed-term 
money market accounts, and certificates of deposit approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate 
certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies market interest rates on comparable 
instruments to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits. 

Short-Term Borrowings – The carrying amounts of federal funds purchased, borrowings under repurchase agreements, and other 
short-term  borrowings  approximate  their  fair  values.  The  Company  classifies  these  borrowings  in  level 2 of  the  fair  value 
hierarchy. 

Long-Term Borrowings, including Junior Subordinated Debt Securities – The fair values of long-term borrowings are estimated 
using discounted cash flow analyses based on the Company’s current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing 
arrangements. The fair value of the Company’s long-term debt is therefore classified in level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. 

Subordinated Debt Securities – The fair value of subordinated debt is estimated based on current market rates on similar debt in 
the market. The Company classifies this debt in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. 

Derivative Financial Instruments – The fair value measurement techniques and assumptions for derivative financial instruments 
is discussed earlier in the note. 

The estimated fair values of the Company’s financial instruments at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 are shown 
below (dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 

Carrying 
Amount 

Estimated 
Fair Value      Level 1 

     Level 2 

     Level 3 

Financial assets: 
Cash and due from banks 
Investment securities 
Equity securities 
Loans, net of allowance 
Interest rate swaps - gross assets 

Financial liabilities: 
Deposits, noninterest-bearing 
Deposits, interest-bearing 
Borrowings under BTFP and repurchase 

agreements 

FHLB long-term advances 
Junior subordinated debt 
Subordinated debt 
Interest rate swaps - gross liabilities 

  $ 

32,009    $ 
382,390      
14,597      

32,009    $ 
382,431      
14,597      
     2,180,079       2,020,924      
17,325      

17,325      

32,009    $ 
—      
1,180      
—      
—      

—    $ 
358,323      
13,417      

—  
24,108  
—  
—       2,020,924  
—  

17,325      

448,752    $ 

448,752    $ 
  $ 
     1,806,975       1,735,562      

—    $ 
—      

448,752    $ 

—  
—       1,735,562  

221,133      
23,500      
8,630      
45,000      
17,325      

221,133      
22,945      
8,630      
44,544      
17,325      

—      
—      
—      
—      
—      

221,133      
—      
—      
44,544      
17,325      

—  
22,945  
8,630  
—  
—  

122 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

December 31, 2022 

Carrying 
Amount 

Estimated 
Fair Value      Level 1 

     Level 2 

     Level 3 

  $ 

40,066    $ 
193      
413,472      
27,254      

40,066    $ 
193      
413,089      
27,254      
     2,080,403       1,997,287      

40,066    $ 
193      
—      
1,245      
—      

—    $ 
—      
401,233      
26,009      

—  
—  
11,856  
—  
—       1,997,287  

580,741    $ 

580,741    $ 
  $ 
     1,501,624       1,314,407      
333,500      
52,147      
8,515      
42,980      

333,500      
53,500      
8,515      
45,000      

—    $ 
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      

580,741    $ 

—  
—       1,314,407  
—  
52,147  
8,515  
—  

333,500      
—      
—      
42,980      

Financial assets: 
Cash and due from banks 
Federal funds sold 
Investment securities 
Equity securities 
Loans, net of allowance 

Financial liabilities: 
Deposits, noninterest-bearing 
Deposits, interest-bearing 
FHLB short-term advances 
FHLB long-term advances 
Junior subordinated debt 
Subordinated debt 

NOTE 18. REGULATORY MATTERS 

The Company and Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies. 
Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by 
regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines, 
the Company and Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities, and certain 
off-balance  sheet  items  as  calculated  under  regulatory  accounting  practices.  The  capital  amounts  and  classification  are  also 
subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors. 

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and Bank to maintain minimum 
amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total, Common Equity Tier 1, and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) 
to risk-weighted assets (as defined) and Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined). 

As  of  December  31,  2023  and  2022,  the  Bank  was  considered  well  capitalized  under  the  regulatory  framework  for  prompt 
corrective action. To be categorized as well capitalized, the Bank must maintain minimum risk-based and Tier 1 leverage capital 
ratios as set forth in the table below and not be subject to a written agreement or order with regulators to maintain a specific 
capital level for any capital measure. There are no conditions or events since the regulatory framework for prompt corrective 
action was issued that management believes have changed the Bank’s category. 

123 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
      
        
        
        
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

The Company’s and the Bank’s actual capital amounts and ratios as of December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 are presented 
in the tables below (dollars in thousands). 

December 31, 2023 
Tier 1 leverage capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

Actual 

   Amount      Ratio 

      Capital Adequacy*        Well Capitalized 
      Amount      Ratio 
      Amount      Ratio 

  $ 239,095      
     280,687      

8.35%  $ 114,563       
9.81        114,468       

NA    
4.00%  
4.00        143,085      

NA  
5.00  

Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

     229,595      
     280,687      

9.51        169,031       
11.64        168,867       

NA    
7.00     
7.00        156,805      

NA  
6.50  

Tier 1 risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

Total risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

December 31, 2022 
Tier 1 leverage capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

     239,095      
     280,687      

9.90        205,251       
11.64        205,052       

8.50     
NA    
8.50        192,990      

NA  
8.00  

     313,574      
     310,846      

12.99        253,546       
12.89        253,300       

10.50     
NA    
10.50        241,238      

NA  
10.00  

  $ 231,048      
     267,603      

8.53%  $ 108,405       
9.89        108,275       

NA    
4.00%  
4.00        135,344      

NA  
5.00  

Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

     221,548      
     267,603      

9.79        158,457       
11.83        158,355       

7.00     
NA    
7.00        147,044      

NA  
6.50  

Tier 1 risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

Total risk-based capital 
Investar Holding Corporation 
Investar Bank 

     231,048      
     267,603      

10.21        192,412       
11.83        192,288       

8.50     
NA    
8.50        180,977      

NA  
8.00  

     300,009      
     292,339      

13.25        237,685       
12.92        237,532       

10.50     
NA    
10.50        226,221      

NA  
10.00  

*The minimum ratios and amounts under the column for Capital Adequacy for December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 
reflect the minimum regulatory capital ratios imposed under Basel III plus the fully phased-in capital conservation buffer of 
2.5%. 

Applicable Federal statutes, regulations, and guidance impose restrictions on the amounts of dividends that may be declared by 
the Company and the Bank. In addition to the formal statutes, regulations, and guidance, regulatory authorities also consider the 
adequacy of the Company’s and the Bank’s total capital in relation to its assets, deposits, risk profile, and other such items and, 
as a result, capital adequacy considerations could further limit the availability of dividends from the Company and the Bank. The 
Company  is  also  subject  to  dividend  restrictions  under  the  terms  of  its  2029  Notes, 2032  Notes, and  junior  subordinated 
debentures. See “Common Stock – Dividend Restrictions” in Note 13. Stockholders’ Equity, for more information. 

124 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
      
        
         
        
         
        
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 19. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES 

Unfunded Commitments 

The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk entered into in the normal course of business to meet 
the  financing  needs  of  its  customers.  These  financial  instruments  include  commitments  to  extend  credit  consisting  of  loan 
commitments and  standby  letters  of  credit, which  are not included  in  the  accompanying  financial  statements.  Such  financial 
instruments  are  recorded  in  the  financial  statements  when  they  become  payable.  The  credit  risk  associated  with  these 
commitments is evaluated in a manner similar to the allowance for credit losses on loans. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the 
reserve for unfunded loan commitments was $0.3 million and $0.4 million, respectively, and is included in “Accrued taxes and 
other liabilities” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. 

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend money with fixed expiration dates or termination clauses. The Company 
applies the same credit standards used in the lending process when extending these commitments, and periodically reassesses the 
customer’s  creditworthiness  through  ongoing  credit  reviews.  Since  some  commitments  are  expected  to  expire  without  being 
drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Collateral is obtained based 
on the Company’s assessment of the transaction. Substantially all standby letters of credit issued have expiration dates within 
one year. 

The  table  below  shows  the amounts  of  the  Company’s  commitments  to  extend  credit  as  of  the  dates  presented  (dollars  in 
thousands). 

Loan commitments 
Standby letters of credit 

December 31, 
2023 

December 31, 
2022 

  $ 

413,019    $ 
17,844      

333,040  
11,379  

Additionally,  at  December  31,  2023,  the  Company  had  unfunded  commitments  of  $1.3 million  for  its  investment  in  Small 
Business Investment Company qualified funds. 

Insurance 

The Company is obligated for certain costs associated with its insurance program for employee health. The Company is self-
insured for a substantial portion of its potential claims. The Company recognizes its obligation associated with these costs, up to 
specified deductible limits, in the period in which a claim is incurred, including with respect to both reported claims and claims 
incurred but not reported. The claims costs are estimated based on historical claims experience. The reserves for insurance claims 
are reviewed and updated by management on a quarterly basis. 

Employment Agreements 

the  Company  entered 

On  August  1,  2020, 
its Chief  Executive  Officer. 
The agreement provides that the executive shall receive a minimum annual base salary $510,000, shall be eligible for annual 
incentive compensation up to a certain percentage of the base salary, subject to the discretion and approval of the Company’s 
board  of  directors,  and  shall  be  entitled  to  the  payment  of  severance  benefits  upon  termination  under  specified 
circumstances. The employment agreement automatically renews for successive one-year periods unless written notice of non-
renewal is given by either party to the other at least ninety (90) days prior to the expiration of the then-current term. 

into  an  employment  agreement with 

On  August  1,  2020,  the  Company  entered  into  an  employment  agreement with  its  then-current Chief  Financial  Officer. 
The agreement provided that  the  executive  would  receive  a  minimum  annual  base  salary  $285,000,  be  eligible  for  annual 
incentive compensation up to a certain percentage of the base salary, subject to the discretion and approval of the Company’s 
board of directors and would be entitled to the payment of severance benefits upon termination under specified circumstances. On 
November 4, 2022, the Company’s then-current Chief Financial Officer separated from the Company. The Company entered 
into  a  separation  and  release  agreement  with  him,  which  provided that  he would  receive  compensation  and  benefits  due in 
connection with a termination due to “Disability” under the employment agreement and released the Company from any and all 
claims arising on or before November 4, 2022.  

125 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

Legal Proceedings  

The nature of the business of the Company’s banking and other subsidiaries ordinarily results in a certain amount of claims, 
litigation,  investigations,  and  legal  and  administrative  cases  and  proceedings,  which  are  considered  incidental  to  the  normal 
conduct  of  business.  Some  of  these  claims  are  against  entities  which  the  Company  acquired  in  business  acquisitions.  The 
Company has asserted defenses to these claims and, with respect to such legal proceedings, intends to continue to defend itself, 
litigating  or  settling  cases  according  to  management’s  judgment  as  to  what  is  in  the  best  interest  of  the  Company  and  its 
shareholders. 

The  Company  assesses  its  liabilities  and  contingencies  in  connection  with  outstanding  legal  proceedings  utilizing  the  latest 
information available. Where it is probable that the Company will incur a loss and the amount of the loss can be reasonably 
estimated, the Company records a liability in its consolidated financial statements. These legal reserves may be increased or 
decreased to reflect any relevant developments on a quarterly basis. Where a loss is not probable or the amount of loss is not 
estimable, the Company does not accrue legal reserves. While the outcome of legal proceedings is inherently uncertain, based 
on information currently available and available insurance coverage, the Company’s management believes that it has established 
appropriate legal reserves. If an accrual is not made, and there is at least a reasonable possibility that a loss or additional loss may 
have been incurred, the Company discloses the nature of the contingency and an estimate of the possible loss or range of loss or 
a statement that such an estimate cannot be made. Any incremental liabilities arising from pending legal proceedings are not 
expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position, consolidated results of operations, 
or consolidated cash flows. However, it is possible that the ultimate resolution of these matters, if unfavorable, may be material 
to the Company’s consolidated financial position, consolidated results of operations, or consolidated cash flows. 

As of the date of this filing, the Company believes the amount of losses associated with legal proceedings that it is reasonably 
possible to incur is not material. 

NOTE 20. TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES 

The Bank has made and expects in the future to continue to make in the ordinary course of business, loans to directors and 
executive officers of the Company and the Bank, their affiliated companies, and other related persons. In management’s opinion, 
these  loans  were  made  in  the  ordinary  course  of  business  at  normal  credit  terms,  including  interest  rate  and  collateral 
requirements, and do not represent more than normal credit risk. See Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses, for more 
information regarding lending transactions between the Bank and these related parties. 

During 2023 and 2022, certain executive officers and directors of the Company and the Bank, including companies with which 
they are affiliated and other related persons, were deposit customers of the Bank. See Note 8. Deposits, regarding total deposits 
outstanding to these related parties. 

The Company has participated in transactions with related parties for which the Company believes the terms and conditions are 
comparable to terms that would have been available from a third party that was unaffiliated with the Company. The following 
describes  transactions since January 1, 2021,  in  addition  to  the ordinary banking  relationships described  above,  in  which  the 
Company has participated in which one or more of its directors, executive officers, their affiliated companies, or other related 
persons had or will have a direct or indirect material interest. 

The  Company  has  engaged  in  a  number  of  transactions  with  Joffrion  Commercial  Division,  LLC  (“JCD”),  a  commercial 
construction company owned and managed by Gordon H. Joffrion, one of the Company’s directors. For each transaction, the 
Company selected JCD through its public bidding process. The Company did not make any payments to JCD during the years 
ended December  31,  2023 or December 31, 2022.  The  Company  paid  JCD  approximately $0.1 million during  the  year ended 
December 31, 2021. 

126 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 21. PARENT COMPANY ONLY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

BALANCE SHEETS 

(dollars in thousands) 
ASSETS 
Cash and due from banks 
Equity securities 
Due from bank subsidiary 
Investment in bank subsidiary 
Investment in trust 
Trademark intangible 
Other assets 

Total assets 

LIABILITIES 
Subordinated debt, net of unamortized issuance costs 
Junior subordinated debt 
Accounts payable 
Accrued interest payable 
Dividend payable 
Deferred tax liability 
Total liabilities 

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
Common stock 
Surplus 
Retained earnings 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss 

Total stockholders’ equity 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity 

STATEMENTS OF INCOME 

(dollars in thousands) 
REVENUE 
Dividends received from bank subsidiary 
Dividends on corporate stock 
Change in the fair value of equity securities 
Interest income from investment in trust 
Other operating income 

Total revenue 

EXPENSE 
Interest on borrowings 
Management fees to bank subsidiary 
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt 
Other expense 

Total expense 

(Loss) income before income tax expense and equity in undistributed income of 

bank subsidiary 

Equity in undistributed income of bank subsidiary 
Income tax benefit 
Net income 

127 

December 31, 

2023 

2022 

840    $ 
752      
1,141      
277,760      
295      
100      
864      
281,752    $ 

44,320    $ 
8,630      
228      
571      
975      
260      
54,984      

9,748      
145,456      
116,711      
(45,147)     
226,768      
281,752    $ 

6,153  
823  
937  
261,737  
295  
100  
518  
270,563  

44,225  
8,515  
253  
567  
941  
280  
54,781  

9,902  
146,587  
108,206  
(48,913) 
215,782  
270,563  

For the years ended  
December 31, 

2023 

2022 

3,300    $ 
—      
(71)     
22      
138      
3,389      

3,216      
360      
—      
519      
4,095      

(706)     
16,552      
832      
16,678    $ 

17,000  
19  
(35) 
11  
—  
16,995  

3,137  
360  
222  
666  
4,385  

12,610  
22,172  
927  
35,709  

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

 
 
  
      
        
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
  
      
        
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 

(dollars in thousands) 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES 

For the years ended  
December 31, 

2023 

2022 

Net income 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: 

Equity in undistributed earnings of bank subsidiary 
Change in the fair value of equity securities 
Amortization of subordinated debt issuance costs and purchase accounting 

  $ 

16,678    $ 

35,709  

(16,552)     
71      

(22,172) 
35  

adjustments 

Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt 

Net change in: 

Due from bank subsidiary 
Other assets 
Deferred tax liability 
Accrued other liabilities 

Net cash provided by operating activities 

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES 

Purchases of equity securities 
Proceeds from the sale of equity securities 
Purchases of other investments 

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities 

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES 

Cash dividends paid on common stock 
Payments to repurchase common stock 
Proceeds from stock options exercised 
Proceeds from subordinated debt, net of issuance costs 
Extinguishment of subordinated debt 

Net cash used in financing activities 

Net (decrease) increase in cash 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period 

210      
—      

(204)     
(84)     
(20)     
1,638      
1,737      

—      
—      
(285)     
(285)     

(3,844)     
(3,026)     
105      
—      
—      
(6,765)     
(5,313)     
6,153      
840    $ 

197  
222  

31  
5  
(52) 
1,746  
15,721  

(750) 
1,225  
(225) 
250  

(3,552) 
(10,540) 
133  
19,548  
(18,600) 
(13,011) 
2,960  
3,193  
6,153  

  $ 

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION: 
Cash payments for: 

Interest on borrowings 

  $ 

3,212    $ 

3,179  

128 

 
 
      
        
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
    
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
      
        
  
  
  
 
 
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

NOTE 22. EARNINGS PER SHARE 

The following is a summary of the information used in the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share for the 
years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (in thousands, except share data). 

Earnings per common share - basic 

Net income 
Less: income allocated to participating securities 

Net income allocated to common shareholders 
Weighted average basic shares outstanding 

Basic earnings per common share 

Earnings per common share - diluted 
Net income allocated to common shareholders 
Weighted average basic shares outstanding 
Dilutive effect of securities 

Total weighted average diluted shares outstanding 

Diluted earnings per common share 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

2021 

16,678    $ 
(1)     
16,677      
9,839,258      
1.69    $ 

35,709    $ 
(33)     
35,676      
10,085,758      
3.54    $ 

8,000  
(21) 
7,979  
10,416,145  
0.77  

16,677    $ 
9,839,258      
2,583      
9,841,841      
1.69    $ 

35,676    $ 
10,085,758      
94,951      
10,180,709      
3.50    $ 

7,979  
10,416,145  
84,157  
10,500,302  
0.76  

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

The weighted average number of shares that have an antidilutive effect in the calculation of diluted earnings per common share 
and have been excluded from the computations above are shown below. 

Stock options 
Restricted stock awards 
Restricted stock units 

2023 

December 31, 
2022 

—      
—      
71,711      

15,361      
135      
15,176      

2021 

869  
431  
20,828  

129 

 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
      
        
        
  
      
        
        
  
    
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
    
  
  
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure 

None. 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures 

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures 

As of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, the Company carried out an evaluation under the 
supervision and with the participation of its management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer (the 
Company’s  principal  executive  and  financial  officers),  of  the  effectiveness  of  the  design  and  operation  of  the  Company’s 
disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e). Based upon that evaluation, the 
Chief Executive  Officer  and Chief Financial  Officer  concluded  that  the Company’s disclosure  controls  and procedures  were 
effective for ensuring that information the Company is required to disclose in reports that it files or submits under the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the 
Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms. 

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

There were no changes to internal control over financial reporting during the fourth quarter of 2023 that have materially affected, 
or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting and the report thereon of Horne LLP are included herein 
under Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data. 

Item 9B. Other Information 

Pursuant to Item 408(a) of Regulation S-K, none of our directors or executive officers adopted, terminated, or modified a Rule 
10b5-1 trading arrangement or a non-Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangement during the quarter ended December 31, 2023. 

Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections 

Not applicable. 

130 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance 

PART III 

Except as provided below, the information required by Item 10 is incorporated by reference to the Company’s Definitive Proxy 
Statement for its 2024 Annual Meeting of Shareholders (the “2024 Proxy Statement”). 

Code of Conduct and Ethics 

The Company has adopted a Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers that applies to its Chief 
Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Accounting Officer and any other senior financial officers, and the Company 
has also adopted a Code of Conduct that applies to all of the Company’s directors, officers and employees. The full text of the 
Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers and the Code of Conduct can be found by clicking 
on “Corporate Governance” under the “Investor Relations” tab on the Company’s website, www.investarbank.com, and then by 
clicking  on  “Code  of  Ethics  for  the  Chief  Executive  Officer  and  Senior  Financial  Officers”  or  “Code  of  Conduct,”  as 
applicable. The Company intends to satisfy the disclosure requirement under Item 5.05(c) of Form 8-K regarding an amendment 
to, or waiver from, a provision of the Company’s Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers 
by posting such information on its website, at the address specified above. 

Item 11. Executive Compensation 

The information required by Item 11 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement. 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters 

Stock Ownership 

Except as provided below, the information required by Item 12 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement. 

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans 

The following table presents certain information regarding our equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2023. 

Plan category 
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders(1)     
Equity compensation plans not approved by security 

holders(2) 

Total 

Number of 
securities to be 
issued upon 
exercise of 
outstanding 
options, warrants 
and rights(3) 

Number of 
securities 
remaining 
available for 
future issuance 
under equity 
compensation 
plans 

Weighted-average 
exercise price of 
outstanding 
options, warrants 
and rights 

484,340    $ 

19.94       

450,058  

179,014      
663,354    $ 

15.16       
17.32       

—  
450,058  

(1)  Represents  shares  available  for  issuance  under  the  Company’s  Amended  and  Restated 2017  Long-Term  Incentive 
Compensation Plan (the “Plan”). The Plan authorizes the grant of various types of equity grants and awards, such as 
restricted stock, stock options and stock appreciation rights to eligible participants, which include all of the Company’s 
employees, non-employee directors, and consultants. 

(2)  The Investar Holding Corporation 2014 Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the “2014 Plan”) was adopted by 
the Company’s board of directors on January 15, 2014 and was amended on March 13, 2014. Because the Company 
was a private corporation at the time of the adoption of the 2014 Plan, shareholder approval of the 2014 Plan was not 
required,  nor  was  such  approval  obtained.  A  total  of  600,000  shares  of  common  stock  was  reserved  for  issuance 
pursuant to awards under the 2014 Plan. Effective May 24, 2017, no future awards will be granted under the 2014 Plan, 
although the terms and conditions of the 2014 Plan will continue to govern any outstanding awards thereunder. 

(3) 

Includes 336,749 shares issuable pursuant to outstanding restricted stock units, which do not have an exercise price. 

131 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Directors Independence 

The information required by Item 13 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement. 

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services 

The information required by Item 14 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement. 

Item 15. Exhibit and Financial Statement Schedules 

(a)  Documents Filed as Part of this Report. 

PART IV 

(1)  The  following  financial  statements  are  incorporated  by  reference  from  Item  8.  Financial  Statements  and

Supplementary Data hereof: 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms (PCAOB ID: 171) 
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2023 and 2022 
Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive (Loss) Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 

2021 

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 

2021 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements  

(2)  All schedules for which provision is made in the applicable accounting regulations of the SEC are omitted because
of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the required information is included in the
consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto. 

(3)  The following exhibits are filed as part of this Form 10-K, and this list includes the Exhibit Index. 

Description 

Location 

Exhibit 
Number 
2.1 

3.1 

3.2 

Agreement and Plan of Reorganization 
dated January 21, 2021 by and among 
Investar Holding Corporation, Cheaha Financial 
Group, Inc. and High Point Acquisition, Inc. 

Restated Articles of Incorporation of Investar 
Holding Corporation 

Amended and Restated By-laws of Investar Holding 
Corporation 

4.1 

Specimen Common Stock Certificate 

Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed January 25, 2021 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 3.1 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 3.2 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-4 of the Company filed October 10, 2017 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 4.1 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

4.2 

Description of Registrant’s Securities Registered 
under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934 

Exhibit 4.2 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of 
the Company filed March 9, 2022 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

132 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
4.3 

4.4 

4.5 

10.1 

10.2* 

10.3* 

10.4* 

10.5* 

10.6* 

10.7* 

10.8* 

10.9* 

10.10* 

10.11* 

Form of 5.125% Fixed to Floating Rate 
Subordinated Note due 2029 

Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed 
November 14, 2019 and incorporated herein by 
reference 

Indenture, dated April 6, 2022, by and among 
Investar Holding Corporation and UMB Bank, 
National Association, as trustee 

Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed 
with the SEC on April 7, 2022 and incorporated 
herein by reference. 

Form of 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate 
Subordinated Note due 2032 

Form of the Director Support Agreement, dated 
October 10, 2018, among Investar Holding 
Corporation, Mainland Bank and all of the directors 
of Mainland Bank parties thereto 

Exhibit 4.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed 
with the SEC on April 7, 2022 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.3 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-4 of the Company filed November 30, 2018 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Employment Agreement, dated August 1, 2020 by 
and among Investar Holding Corporation, Investar 
Bank, National Association, and John J. D’Angelo 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K 
filed August 6, 2020 and incorporated herein by 
reference 

Employment Agreement, dated August 1, 2020 by 
and among Investar Holding Corporation, Investar 
Bank, National Association, and Christopher L. 
Hufft 

Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K 
filed August 6, 2020 and incorporated herein by 
reference 

Amended and Restated Investar Holding 
Corporation 2017 Long-Term Incentive 
Compensation Plan 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K 
filed May 20, 2021 and incorporated herein by 
reference 

Salary Continuation Agreement, dated as of 
February 28, 2018, by and between Investar Bank 
and John D’Angelo 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Supplemental Salary Continuation Agreement, 
dated May 22, 2019, by and between Investar Bank 
and John D’Angelo 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Salary Continuation Agreement, dated as of 
February 28, 2018, by and between Investar Bank 
and Christopher Hufft 

Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Supplemental Salary Continuation Agreement, 
dated May 22, 2019, by and between Investar Bank 
and Christopher Hufft 

Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Separation Agreement & Release with Christopher 
Hufft, dated November 4, 2022 

Exhibit 10.10 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K 
of the Company filed March 8, 2023 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Form of Split Dollar Agreement by and between 
Investar Bank and each executive entering into a 
Salary Continuation Agreement 

Exhibit 10.4 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of 
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated 
herein by reference 

Form of First Amendment to Split Dollar 
Agreement by and between Investar Bank and each 
executive entering into a Supplemental Salary 
Continuation Agreement 

Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K 
filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated herein by 
reference 

133 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
10.12* 

Investar Holding Corporation 2014 Long-Term 
Incentive Compensation Plan, as amended by 
Amendment No. 1 to Investar Holding Corporation 
2014 Long Term Incentive Plan 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and, as to 
Amendment No.1, Exhibit 99.2 to the Registration 
Statement on Form S-8 of the Company filed 
October 30, 2014, each of which is incorporated 
herein by reference 

10.13* 

Amendment to the Split Dollar Agreement between 
Investar Bank and Christopher Hufft, dated 
November 1, 2022 

Exhibit 10.13 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K 
of the Company filed March 8, 2023 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

10.14* 

Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement 

10.15* 

Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for 
Employees 

10.16* 

Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for 
Non-Employee Directors 

10.17* 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for 
Employees 

10.18* 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Non-
Employee Directors 

10.19* 

Investar Holding Corporation 401(k) Plan, as 
restated effective January 1, 2021 

21.1 

Subsidiaries of the Registrant 

23.1 

   Consent of Horne LLP 

Exhibit 10.2 to the Registration Statement on Form 
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.3 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of 
the Company filed March 11, 2016 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.4 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of 
the Company filed March 11, 2016 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.15 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K 
of the Company filed March 15, 2019 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.16 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K 
of the Company filed March 15, 2019 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 10.20 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K 
of the Company filed March 10, 2021 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

Exhibit 21 to the Registration Statement on Form S-
1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and 
incorporated herein by reference 

   Filed herewith 

Filed herewith 

31.1 

31.2 

32.1 

32.2 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Principal Executive 
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section 
302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Principal Financial 
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section 
302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

Filed herewith 

Section 1350 Certification of Principal Executive 
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section 
906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

Filed herewith 

Section 1350 Certification of Principal Financial 
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section 
906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

Filed herewith 

97.1 

Investar Holding Corporation Clawback Policy 

   Filed herewith 

134 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
101.INS 

101.SCH 

101.CAL 

Inline XBRL Instance Document - the instance 
document does not appear in the Interactive Data 
File because its XBRL tags are embedded within 
the Inline XBRL document 

Filed herewith 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema 
Document 

Filed herewith 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation 
Linkbase Document 

Filed herewith 

101.DEF 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition 
Linkbase Document 

Filed herewith 

101.LAB 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase 
Document 

Filed herewith 

101.PRE 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation 
Linkbase Document 

Filed herewith 

104 

Cover Page Interactive Data File (embedded within 
the Inline XBRL Document and include in Exhibit 
101) 

Filed herewith 

* Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement. 

Item 16. Form 10-K Summary 

Not applicable. 

135 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this 
report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. 

SIGNATURES 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION 

by:  /s/ John J. D’Angelo 
John J. D’Angelo 
President and 
Chief Executive Officer 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons 
on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated. 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

by:  /s/ John J. D’Angelo 
John J. D’Angelo 
President, Chief Executive 
Officer and Director 
(Principal Executive Officer) 

by:  /s/ John R. Campbell 
John R. Campbell 
Executive Vice President and 
Chief Financial Officer 
(Principal Financial Officer) 

by:  /s/ Corey E. Moore 
Corey E. Moore 
Senior Vice President and 
Chief Accounting Officer 
(Principal Accounting Officer) 

by:  /s/ Anita M. Fontenot 
Anita M. Fontenot 
Director 

136 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

Date: 

March 7, 2024 

by:  /s/ William H. Hidalgo, Sr. 
   William H. Hidalgo, Sr. 
Chairman of the Board 

by:  /s/ Rose J. Hudson 
Rose J. Hudson 
Director 

by:  /s/ Gordon H. Joffrion, III 
Gordon H. Joffrion, III 
Director 

by:  /s/ Robert C. Jordan 
Robert C. Jordan 
Director 

by:  /s/ Julio A. Melara 
Julio A. Melara 
Director 

by:  /s/ Suzanne O. Middleton 
Suzanne O. Middleton 
Director 

by:  /s/ Andrew C. Nelson, M.D. 
Andrew C. Nelson, M.D. 
Director 

by:  /s/ Frank L. Walker 
Frank L. Walker 
Director 

by:  /s/ James E. Yegge, M.D. 
James E. Yegge, M.D. 
Director 

137 

 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
This page intentionally left blank

Investar Holding Corporation
10500 Coursey Boulevard
Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70816
(225) 227-2222
www.investarbank.com